texlive[47494] Master/texmf-dist: glossaries-extra (25apr18)

commits+karl at tug.org commits+karl at tug.org
Mon Apr 30 01:02:26 CEST 2018


Revision: 47494
          http://tug.org/svn/texlive?view=revision&revision=47494
Author:   karl
Date:     2018-04-30 01:02:25 +0200 (Mon, 30 Apr 2018)
Log Message:
-----------
glossaries-extra (25apr18)

Modified Paths:
--------------
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/CHANGES
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/README
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-code.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.html
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.tex
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-abbr-styles.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-abbrv.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-accsupp.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-acronym-desc.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-acronym.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-alias.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-altmodifier.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-alttree-marginpar.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-alttree-sym.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-alttree.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-autoindex-hyp.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-autoindex.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-crossref.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-crossref2.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-docdef.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-entrycount.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-external.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-fmt.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-footnote.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-header.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-indexhook.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-initialisms.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-linkcount.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-mixed-abbrv-styles.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-mixedsort.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-mixture.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-name-font.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-nested.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-noidx-restricteddocdefs.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-onelink.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-onthefly-utf8.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-onthefly-xetex.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-onthefly.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-pages.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-postdot.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-postlink.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-prefix.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-record.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-restricteddocdefs.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-suppl-hyp.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-suppl-main-hyp.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-suppl-main.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-suppl.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-trans.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-undef.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample-unitentrycount.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/sample.pdf
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra.dtx
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/source/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra.ins
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-bib2gls.sty
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-stylemods.sty
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra.sty
    trunk/Master/texmf-dist/tex/latex/glossaries-extra/glossary-bookindex.sty

Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/CHANGES
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/CHANGES	2018-04-29 23:01:57 UTC (rev 47493)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/CHANGES	2018-04-29 23:02:25 UTC (rev 47494)
@@ -1,3 +1,34 @@
+1.30 (2018-04-25):
+
+ * glossaries-extra.sty:
+
+  - added \glsuserdescription (now used by long-short-user
+    and short-long-user abbreviation styles)
+
+  - added \glsaddpresetkeys and \glsaddpostsetkeys
+
+  - added \GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering and
+    \GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering
+
+  - added \GlsXtrExpandedFmt
+
+  - added \glsxtrabbreviationfont
+
+  - added textformat key for commands like \glslink, \gls etc
+
+  - bug fix: added \@glsxtr at record to \glsxtrfull, 
+    \glsxtrshort, \glsxtrlong and variants
+
+  - bug fix: added check for counter=wrglossary 
+    in \glsxtr at inc@wrglossaryctr
+
+ * glossaries-extra-bib2gls.sty:
+
+  - new commands:
+
+    \GlsXtrDualField
+    \GlsXtrDualBackLink
+
 1.29 (2018-04-09):
 
  * glossaries-extra-bib2gls.sty:

Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/README
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/README	2018-04-29 23:01:57 UTC (rev 47493)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/README	2018-04-29 23:02:25 UTC (rev 47494)
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
-LaTeX Package : glossaries-extra v1.29
+LaTeX Package : glossaries-extra v1.30
 
-Last Modified : 2018-04-09
+Last Modified : 2018-04-25
 
 Author        : Nicola Talbot
 

Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-code.pdf
===================================================================
(Binary files differ)

Modified: trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.html
===================================================================
--- trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.html	2018-04-29 23:01:57 UTC (rev 47493)
+++ trunk/Master/texmf-dist/doc/latex/glossaries-extra/glossaries-extra-manual.html	2018-04-29 23:02:25 UTC (rev 47494)
@@ -217,7 +217,7 @@
 >
 <!--l. 236--><p class="noindent" >
 </p><!--l. 236--><p class="noindent" ><span 
-class="cmr-17">glossaries-extra.sty v1.29: an extension to the</span>
+class="cmr-17">glossaries-extra.sty v1.30: an extension to the</span>
 <span 
 class="cmr-17">glossaries package</span>
 </p>
@@ -241,7 +241,7 @@
 class="cmtt-12">http://www.dickimaw-books.com/</span></a></td></tr></table>
 </div>
 <!--l. 236--><p class="noindent" ><span 
-class="cmr-12">2018-04-09</span></p></div>
+class="cmr-12">2018-04-25</span></p></div>
    <div 
 class="abstract" 
 >
@@ -361,89 +361,91 @@
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.4 <a 
 href="#sec:entrycountmods" id="QQ2-1-9">Entry Counting Modifications</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.5 <a 
-href="#plurals" id="QQ2-1-10">Plurals</a></span>
+href="#sec:glsunset" id="QQ2-1-10">Unsetting the First Use Flag</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.6 <a 
-href="#sec:nested" id="QQ2-1-11">Nested Links</a></span>
+href="#plurals" id="QQ2-1-11">Plurals</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.7 <a 
-href="#sec:acronymmods" id="QQ2-1-12">Acronym Style Modifications</a></span>
+href="#sec:nested" id="QQ2-1-12">Nested Links</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.8 <a 
-href="#x1-130002.8" id="QQ2-1-14"><span 
+href="#sec:acronymmods" id="QQ2-1-13">Acronym Style Modifications</a></span>
+<br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.9 <a 
+href="#x1-140002.9" id="QQ2-1-15"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-bookindex </span>package</a></span>
-<br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.9 <a 
-href="#sec:glosstylemods" id="QQ2-1-15">Glossary Style Modifications</a></span>
-<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.9.1 <a 
-href="#sec:stylehooks" id="QQ2-1-16">Style Hooks</a></span>
-<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.9.2 <a 
-href="#sec:glosstylenumlist" id="QQ2-1-17">Number List</a></span>
-<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.9.3 <a 
-href="#x1-170002.9.3" id="QQ2-1-18">The <span 
+<br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >2.10 <a 
+href="#sec:glosstylemods" id="QQ2-1-16">Glossary Style Modifications</a></span>
+<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.10.1 <a 
+href="#sec:stylehooks" id="QQ2-1-17">Style Hooks</a></span>
+<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.10.2 <a 
+href="#sec:glosstylenumlist" id="QQ2-1-18">Number List</a></span>
+<br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >2.10.3 <a 
+href="#x1-180002.10.3" id="QQ2-1-19">The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods </span>Package</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >3 <a 
-href="#sec:abbreviations" id="QQ2-1-19">Abbreviations</a></span>
+href="#sec:abbreviations" id="QQ2-1-20">Abbreviations</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >3.1 <a 
-href="#sec:tagging" id="QQ2-1-20">Tagging Initials</a></span>
+href="#sec:tagging" id="QQ2-1-21">Tagging Initials</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >3.2 <a 
-href="#sec:abbrstyle" id="QQ2-1-21">Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
+href="#sec:abbrstyle" id="QQ2-1-22">Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >3.3 <a 
-href="#sec:abbrshortcuts" id="QQ2-1-22">Shortcut Commands</a></span>
+href="#sec:abbrshortcuts" id="QQ2-1-23">Shortcut Commands</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >3.4 <a 
-href="#sec:predefabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-24">Predefined Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
+href="#sec:predefabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-25">Predefined Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >3.4.1 <a 
-href="#sec:predefregabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-25">Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Set the Regular Attribute</a></span>
+href="#sec:predefregabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-26">Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Set the Regular Attribute</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;&#x00A0;<span class="subsectionToc" >3.4.2 <a 
-href="#sec:predefnonregabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-26">Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Don’t Set the Regular Attribute</a></span>
+href="#sec:predefnonregabbrvstyles" id="QQ2-1-27">Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Don’t Set the Regular Attribute</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >3.5 <a 
-href="#sec:newabbrvstyle" id="QQ2-1-27">Defining New Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
+href="#sec:newabbrvstyle" id="QQ2-1-28">Defining New Abbreviation Styles</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >4 <a 
-href="#sec:headtitle" id="QQ2-1-28">Entries in Sectioning Titles, Headers, Captions and Contents</a></span>
+href="#sec:headtitle" id="QQ2-1-29">Entries in Sectioning Titles, Headers, Captions and Contents</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >5 <a 
-href="#sec:categories" id="QQ2-1-29">Categories</a></span>
+href="#sec:categories" id="QQ2-1-30">Categories</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >6 <a 
-href="#sec:countref" id="QQ2-1-30">Counting References</a></span>
+href="#sec:countref" id="QQ2-1-31">Counting References</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >6.1 <a 
-href="#sec:entrycount" id="QQ2-1-31">Entry Counting (First Use Flag)</a></span>
+href="#sec:entrycount" id="QQ2-1-32">Entry Counting (First Use Flag)</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >6.2 <a 
-href="#sec:linkcount" id="QQ2-1-32">Link Counting</a></span>
+href="#sec:linkcount" id="QQ2-1-33">Link Counting</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >7 <a 
-href="#sec:autoindex" id="QQ2-1-33">Auto-Indexing</a></span>
+href="#sec:autoindex" id="QQ2-1-34">Auto-Indexing</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >8 <a 
-href="#sec:onthefly" id="QQ2-1-34">On-the-Fly Document Definitions</a></span>
+href="#sec:onthefly" id="QQ2-1-35">On-the-Fly Document Definitions</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >9 <a 
-href="#sec:bib2gls" id="QQ2-1-35">bib2gls: Managing Reference Databases</a></span>
+href="#sec:bib2gls" id="QQ2-1-36">bib2gls: Managing Reference Databases</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.1 <a 
-href="#selection" id="QQ2-1-36">Selection</a></span>
+href="#selection" id="QQ2-1-37">Selection</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.2 <a 
-href="#sortinganddisplayingtheglossary" id="QQ2-1-37">Sorting and Displaying the Glossary</a></span>
-<br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.3 <a 
-href="#x1-360009.3" id="QQ2-1-38">The <span 
-class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-bib2gls </span>package</a></span>
+href="#sortinganddisplayingtheglossary" id="QQ2-1-38">Sorting and Displaying the Glossary</a></span>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
+<br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.3 <a 
+href="#x1-370009.3" id="QQ2-1-39">The <span 
+class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-bib2gls </span>package</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.4 <a 
-href="#supplementarycommands" id="QQ2-1-39">Supplementary Commands</a></span>
+href="#supplementarycommands" id="QQ2-1-40">Supplementary Commands</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >9.5 <a 
-href="#sec:recordcount" id="QQ2-1-40">Record Counting</a></span>
+href="#sec:recordcount" id="QQ2-1-41">Record Counting</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >10 <a 
-href="#sec:miscnew" id="QQ2-1-41">Miscellaneous New Commands</a></span>
+href="#sec:miscnew" id="QQ2-1-42">Miscellaneous New Commands</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >10.1 <a 
-href="#sec:fields" id="QQ2-1-42">Entry Fields</a></span>
+href="#sec:fields" id="QQ2-1-43">Entry Fields</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >10.2 <a 
-href="#sec:printunsrt" id="QQ2-1-43">Display All Entries Without Sorting or Indexing</a></span>
+href="#sec:printunsrt" id="QQ2-1-44">Display All Entries Without Sorting or Indexing</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >10.3 <a 
-href="#sec:glossentry" id="QQ2-1-44">Standalone Entry Items</a></span>
+href="#sec:glossentry" id="QQ2-1-45">Standalone Entry Items</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >10.4 <a 
-href="#sec:alias" id="QQ2-1-45">Entry Aliases</a></span>
+href="#sec:alias" id="QQ2-1-46">Entry Aliases</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >11 <a 
-href="#sec:supplemental" id="QQ2-1-46">Supplemental Packages</a></span>
+href="#sec:supplemental" id="QQ2-1-47">Supplemental Packages</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >11.1 <a 
-href="#sec:prefix" id="QQ2-1-47">Prefixes or Determiners</a></span>
+href="#sec:prefix" id="QQ2-1-48">Prefixes or Determiners</a></span>
 <br />   &#x00A0;<span class="sectionToc" >11.2 <a 
-href="#sec:accsupp" id="QQ2-1-48">Accessibility Support</a></span>
+href="#sec:accsupp" id="QQ2-1-49">Accessibility Support</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >12 <a 
-href="#sec:samples" id="QQ2-1-49">Sample Files</a></span>
+href="#sec:samples" id="QQ2-1-50">Sample Files</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" >13 <a 
-href="#sec:lang" id="QQ2-1-50">Multi-Lingual Support</a></span>
+href="#sec:lang" id="QQ2-1-51">Multi-Lingual Support</a></span>
 <br />   <span class="chapterToc" > <a 
 href="#glossary">Glossary</a></span>
    </div>
@@ -1098,7 +1100,7 @@
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9; if it contains any commas.) The value may
      be omitted if no options need to be passed. See <a 
 href="#sec:glosstylemods"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.9 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.10 </a><a 
 href="#sec:glosstylemods">Glossary Style
      Modifications<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:glosstylemods --></a> for further details. There are two special keyword values:
      <a 
@@ -1502,19 +1504,52 @@
 class="cmss-10">counter</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=wrglossary</span><a 
  id="dx1-4116"></a>.
-     <!--l. 799--><p class="noindent" >By default (with <span 
+     <!--l. 799--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> This option works by incrementing <span 
+class="cmss-10">wrglossary</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4117"></a> and adding <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\label</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4118"></a>. This can
+     cause a problem if the indexing occurs in an <span 
+class="cmss-10">equation</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4119"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4120"></a> environment as <span 
+class="cmss-10">amsmath</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4121"></a>
+     forbids multiple occurrences of <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\label </span>(resulting in the “Multiple <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\label</span>’s”
+     error). It’s best to change the counter to <span 
+class="cmss-10">page</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4122"></a> or <span 
+class="cmss-10">equation</span><a 
+ id="dx1-4123"></a> when in maths mode
+     with this option. For example:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-24">
+     \renewcommand{\glslinkpresetkeys}{%
+     &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glslink}{counter=equation}\fi}
+     &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand{\glsaddpresetkeys}{%
+     &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glossadd}{counter=equation}\fi}
+</div>
+     <!--l. 812--><p class="nopar" > </div>
+     </p><!--l. 813--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 815--><p class="noindent" >By default (with <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-4117"></a>), the page numbers in <a 
- id="dx1-4118"></a>number lists link back to the
+ id="dx1-4124"></a>), the page numbers in <a 
+ id="dx1-4125"></a><a 
+href="#glo:numberlist">number lists</a> link back to the
      top of the relevant page (provided the format uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glshypernumber</span>). The
      <a 
 href="#styopt.indexcounter"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexcounter</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4119"></a> option is designed to link back to the place within the page where
+ id="dx1-4126"></a> option is designed to link back to the place within the page where
      the indexing occurred. It does this by creating a new counter (called <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrglossary</span><a 
- id="dx1-4120"></a>)
+ id="dx1-4127"></a>)
      that’s incremented with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\refstepcounter </span>every time an entry is indexed (but
      not via cross-referencing commands, such as <span 
@@ -1525,70 +1560,71 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\pageref</span>. The location, as seen by the indexing application, is
      the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrglossary</span><a 
- id="dx1-4121"></a> counter but this value is substituted with the page
+ id="dx1-4128"></a> counter but this value is substituted with the page
      reference when <a 
- id="dx1-4122"></a>number list is typeset. Since the counter is used by all
+ id="dx1-4129"></a>number list is typeset. Since the counter is used by all
      entries and is incremented every time any indexing occurs, neither
      <a 
- id="dx1-4123"></a><span 
-class="cmtt-10">makeindex </span>nor <a 
- id="dx1-4124"></a><span 
-class="cmtt-10">xindy </span>can correctly collate the lists. For example, if the first
+ id="dx1-4130"></a><a 
+href="#glo:makeindex"><span 
+class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span></a> nor <a 
+ id="dx1-4131"></a><a 
+href="#glo:xindy"><span 
+class="cmtt-10">xindy</span></a> can correctly collate the lists. For example, if the first
      term to be referenced is indexed three times on page&#x00A0;5 without any
      intervening terms then the actual locations obtained from <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrglossary</span><a 
- id="dx1-4125"></a>
+ id="dx1-4132"></a>
      will be 1, 2 and 3, which <a 
- id="dx1-4126"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-4133"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">xindy </span>and <a 
- id="dx1-4127"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-4134"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex </span>will try to form into
      the range 1–3, but they should actually all simply appear as page&#x00A0;5,
      whereas it can actually end up with 5–5. Conversely, a range may not be
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
      formed where it would naturally occur if just the <span 
 class="cmss-10">page</span><a 
- id="dx1-4128"></a> counter was
+ id="dx1-4135"></a> counter was
      used.
-     </p><!--l. 823--><p class="noindent" >Since <a 
- id="dx1-4129"></a><a 
+     </p><!--l. 839--><p class="noindent" >Since <a 
+ id="dx1-4136"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-4130"></a></a> is designed specifically to work with <span 
+ id="dx1-4137"></a></a> is designed specifically to work with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>,
      <a 
- id="dx1-4131"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-4138"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-4132"></a> (v1.4+) will check for <span 
+ id="dx1-4139"></a> (v1.4+) will check for <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrglossary</span><a 
- id="dx1-4133"></a> locations. If the default
+ id="dx1-4140"></a> locations. If the default
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">--merge-wrglossary-records </span>is on, then any records for the same page
      for a given entry will be merged. In the above example with three
      references on page&#x00A0;5, only a single record for page&#x00A0;5 for that entry will be
      added to the <a 
- id="dx1-4134"></a><a 
-href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> and it will link back to the first instance on
+ id="dx1-4141"></a>number list and it will link back to the first instance on
      that page. Whereas if you use the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">--no-merge-wrglossary-records</span>
      switch, the <a 
- id="dx1-4135"></a>number list will contain three instance of page&#x00A0;5, with
+ id="dx1-4142"></a>number list will contain three instance of page&#x00A0;5, with
      each linking to the corresponding place on that page. In both cases,
      consecutive pages can form ranges, but it may look strange in the second
      case.
-     </p><!--l. 836--><p class="noindent" >See the <a 
- id="dx1-4136"></a><span 
+     </p><!--l. 852--><p class="noindent" >See the <a 
+ id="dx1-4143"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-4137"></a> documentation for the <span 
+ id="dx1-4144"></a> documentation for the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">save-index-counter </span>resource option
      for more details.
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="styopt.docdef"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">docdef</span><a 
- id="dx1-4138"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4145"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This option governs the use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span>. It was originally a
      boolean option, but as from version 1.06, it can now take one of three values (if
@@ -1597,10 +1633,10 @@
          <ul class="itemize1">
          <li class="itemize"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span><a 
- id="dx1-4140"></a> is not permitted in the <span 
+ id="dx1-4147"></a> is not permitted in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4141"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4142"></a> environment
+ id="dx1-4148"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4149"></a> environment
          (default).
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><span 
@@ -1608,8 +1644,8 @@
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package.
          That is, where its use is permitted in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4144"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4145"></a> environment, it
+ id="dx1-4151"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4152"></a> environment, it
          uses the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">.glsdefs </span>temporary file to store the entry definitions so
          that on the next <span class="LATEX">L<span class="A">A</span><span class="TEX">T<span 
@@ -1616,8 +1652,8 @@
 class="E">E</span>X</span></span>&#x00A0;run the entries are defined at the beginning
          of  the  <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4146"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4147"></a>  environment.  This  allows  the  entry  information
+ id="dx1-4153"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4154"></a>  environment.  This  allows  the  entry  information
          to be referenced in the glossary, even if the glossary occurs before
          <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span>. (For example, when the glossary is displayed in
@@ -1626,51 +1662,48 @@
 class="E">E</span>X</span></span>&#x00A0;run has drawbacks that are detailed in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>user
          manual.
-         <!--l. 860--><p class="noindent" >Remember that if  <span 
+         <!--l. 876--><p class="noindent" >Remember that if  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry </span>wouldn’t be allowed in the
          <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4148"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4149"></a> environment with the base <span 
+ id="dx1-4155"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4156"></a> environment with the base <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package, then it still
          won’t be allowed with <a 
 href="#styopt.docdefs"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdefs</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=true</span><a 
- id="dx1-4150"></a>. If your glossaries occur at the
+ id="dx1-4157"></a>. If your glossaries occur at the
          end of the document, consider using <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=restricted</span><a 
- id="dx1-4151"></a> instead.
+ id="dx1-4158"></a> instead.
          </p></li>
          <li class="itemize">(new  to  version  1.06)  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span><a 
- id="dx1-4153"></a> is  permitted  in  the
+ id="dx1-4160"></a> is  permitted  in  the
          <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4154"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4155"></a> environment without using the <span 
+ id="dx1-4161"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4162"></a> environment without using the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">.glsdefs </span>file. This means
          that all entries must be defined before the glossary is displayed, but
          it avoids the complications associated with saving the entry details
          in a temporary file. You will still need to take care about any changes
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
          made to characters that are required by the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">key</span>&#x27E9;=&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9; mechanism
          (that is, the comma and equal sign) and any <a 
- id="dx1-4156"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4163"></a><a 
 href="#glo:makeindex"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span></a> or <a 
- id="dx1-4157"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4164"></a><a 
 href="#glo:xindy"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">xindy</span></a>
          character that occurs in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-4158"></a> key or label. If any of those characters
+ id="dx1-4165"></a> key or label. If any of those characters
          are made active in the document, then it can cause problems with
          the entry definition. This option will allow <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry </span>to
@@ -1678,12 +1711,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\makenoidxglossaries</span>, but note that
          <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\longnewglossaryentry </span>remains a preamble-only command.
-         <!--l. 883--><p class="noindent" >With this option, if an entry appears in the glossary before it has been
+         <!--l. 899--><p class="noindent" >With this option, if an entry appears in the glossary before it has been
          defined, an error will occur (or a warning if the <a 
 href="#styopt.undefaction"><span 
 class="cmss-10">undefaction</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=warn</span><a 
- id="dx1-4159"></a>
+ id="dx1-4166"></a>
          option is used.) If you edit your document and either remove an entry
          or change its label, you may need to delete the document’s temporary
          files (such as the <span 
@@ -1691,19 +1724,20 @@
 class="cmtt-10">.gls </span>files).
 </p>
          </li></ul>
-     <!--l. 892--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     <!--l. 908--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package allows <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry </span>within the <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4160"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4161"></a>
+ id="dx1-4167"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4168"></a>
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
      environment (when used with <a 
- id="dx1-4162"></a><a 
-href="#glo:makeindex"><span 
-class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span></a> or <a 
- id="dx1-4163"></a><a 
-href="#glo:xindy"><span 
-class="cmtt-10">xindy</span></a>) but the user manual warns
+ id="dx1-4169"></a><span 
+class="cmtt-10">makeindex </span>or <a 
+ id="dx1-4170"></a><span 
+class="cmtt-10">xindy</span>) but the user manual warns
      against this usage. By default the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package <span 
 class="cmti-10">prohibits </span>this, only
@@ -1710,13 +1744,13 @@
      allowing definitions within the preamble. If you are really determined to define
      entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">document</span><a 
- id="dx1-4164"></a><a 
- id="dx1-4165"></a> environment, despite all the associated drawbacks, you
+ id="dx1-4171"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-4172"></a> environment, despite all the associated drawbacks, you
      can restore this with <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=true</span><a 
- id="dx1-4166"></a>. Note that this doesn’t change the
+ id="dx1-4173"></a>. Note that this doesn’t change the
      prohibitions that the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package has in certain circumstances (for
      example, when using “option&#x00A0;1”). See the <span 
@@ -1726,14 +1760,14 @@
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=restricted</span><a 
- id="dx1-4167"></a>. Only use <a 
+ id="dx1-4174"></a>. Only use <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=true</span><a 
- id="dx1-4168"></a> if document definitions
+ id="dx1-4175"></a> if document definitions
      are necessary and one or more of the glossaries occurs in the front
      matter.
-     </p><!--l. 909--><p class="noindent" >This option affects commands that internally use <span 
+     </p><!--l. 925--><p class="noindent" >This option affects commands that internally use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span>, such as
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span>, but not the “on-the-fly” commands described in <a 
@@ -1745,7 +1779,7 @@
 <a 
  id="styopt.nomissingglstext"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nomissingglstext</span><a 
- id="dx1-4169"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4176"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is a boolean option. If true, this will suppress the warning
      text that will appear in the document if the external glossary files haven’t been
      generated due to an incomplete document build. However, it’s probably simpler
@@ -1755,7 +1789,7 @@
 <a 
  id="styopt.abbreviations"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">abbreviations</span><a 
- id="dx1-4170"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4177"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This option has no value and can’t be cancelled. If used, it will
      automatically create a new glossary with the label <span 
 class="cmtt-10">abbreviations </span>and
@@ -1762,18 +1796,15 @@
      redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvtype </span>to this label. In addition, it defines a shortcut
      command
-     <!--l. 926--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 942--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\printabbreviations</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-4171"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-4178"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printabbreviations[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 928--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 944--><p class="noindent" >
      which is equivalent to </p><div class="alltt">
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
      <div class="obeylines-v">
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printglossary[type=\glsxtrabbrvtype,</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -1781,51 +1812,54 @@
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
 </div>
      </div> The title of the new glossary is given by
-     <!--l. 934--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 950--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\abbreviationsname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-4172"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-4179"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbreviationsname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 936--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 952--><p class="noindent" >
      If this command is already defined, it’s left unchanged. Otherwise it’s defined
      to “Abbreviations” if <span 
 class="cmss-10">babel</span><a 
- id="dx1-4173"></a> hasn’t been loaded or <span 
+ id="dx1-4180"></a> hasn’t been loaded or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acronymname </span>if
      <span 
 class="cmss-10">babel</span><a 
- id="dx1-4174"></a> has been loaded. However, if you’re using <span 
+ id="dx1-4181"></a> has been loaded. However, if you’re using <span 
 class="cmss-10">babel</span><a 
- id="dx1-4175"></a> it’s likely you
+ id="dx1-4182"></a> it’s likely you
      will need to change this. (See <a 
 href="#sec:lang"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>13 </a><a 
 href="#sec:lang">Multi-Lingual Support<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:lang --></a> for further
      details.)
-     </p><!--l. 943--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you don’t use the <a 
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+     </p><!--l. 959--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you don’t use the <a 
 href="#styopt.abbreviations"><span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviations</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4176"></a> package option, the <span 
+ id="dx1-4183"></a> package option, the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbreviationsname</span>
      command won’t be defined (unless it’s defined by an included language file).
      </div>
-     </p><!--l. 947--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 949--><p class="noindent" >If the <a 
+     </p><!--l. 963--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 965--><p class="noindent" >If the <a 
 href="#styopt.abbreviations"><span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviations</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4177"></a> option is used and the <a 
+ id="dx1-4184"></a> option is used and the <a 
 href="#styopt.acronym"><span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4178"></a> option provided by the
+ id="dx1-4185"></a> option provided by the
      <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package hasn’t been used, then <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acronymtype</span><a 
- id="dx1-4179"></a> will be set to
+ id="dx1-4186"></a> will be set to
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvtype</span><a 
- id="dx1-4180"></a> so that acronyms defined with <span 
+ id="dx1-4187"></a> so that acronyms defined with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-4181"></a> can be added
+ id="dx1-4188"></a> can be added
      to the list of abbreviations. If you want acronyms in the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">main </span>glossary and
      other abbreviations in the <span 
@@ -1837,15 +1871,15 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-24">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-25">
      \renewcommand*{\acronymtype}{main}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 959--><p class="nopar" >
-     </p><!--l. 961--><p class="noindent" >Note that there are no analogous options to the <span 
+     <!--l. 975--><p class="nopar" >
+     </p><!--l. 977--><p class="noindent" >Note that there are no analogous options to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package’s <a 
 href="#styopt.acronymlists"><span 
 class="cmss-10">acronymlists</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4182"></a>
+ id="dx1-4189"></a>
      option (or associated commands) as the abbreviation mechanism is handled
      differently with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>.
@@ -1853,13 +1887,13 @@
 <a 
  id="styopt.symbols"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">symbols</span><a 
- id="dx1-4183"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4190"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is passed to <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>but will additionally define
-     <!--l. 968--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 984--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrnewsymbol</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-4184"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-4191"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewsymbol[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -1868,7 +1902,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">symbol</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
      </div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 970--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 986--><p class="noindent" >
      which is equivalent to </p><div class="alltt">
      <div class="obeylines-v">
      <span 
@@ -1888,7 +1922,7 @@
 </div>
      </div> Note that the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-4185"></a> key is set to the &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-4192"></a> key is set to the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; not the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">symbol</span>&#x27E9; as the symbol will
      likely contain commands.
@@ -1896,19 +1930,19 @@
 <a 
  id="styopt.numbers"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">numbers</span><a 
- id="dx1-4186"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4193"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is passed to <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>but will additionally define
-     <!--l. 981--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 997--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrnewnumber</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-4187"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-4194"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewnumber[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">number</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 983--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 999--><p class="noindent" >
      which is equivalent to </p><div class="alltt">
      <div class="obeylines-v">
      <span 
@@ -1931,7 +1965,7 @@
 <a 
  id="styopt.shortcuts"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">shortcuts</span><a 
- id="dx1-4188"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-4195"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Unlike the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package option of the same name, this option isn’t
      boolean but has multiple values:
@@ -1943,11 +1977,11 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=acronyms</span><a 
- id="dx1-4189"></a> (or <a 
+ id="dx1-4196"></a> (or <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=acro</span><a 
- id="dx1-4190"></a>): set the shortcuts provided
+ id="dx1-4197"></a>): set the shortcuts provided
          by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package for acronyms (such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ac</span>). Note that the
@@ -1963,13 +1997,13 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-4191"></a>.
+ id="dx1-4198"></a>.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-4192"></a>: set the shortcuts provided by the <span 
+ id="dx1-4199"></a>: set the shortcuts provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package for
          acronyms (such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ac</span>) but uses the <span 
@@ -1986,11 +2020,11 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=abbreviations</span><a 
- id="dx1-4193"></a>                 (or                 <a 
+ id="dx1-4200"></a>                 (or                 <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=abbr</span><a 
- id="dx1-4194"></a>):
+ id="dx1-4201"></a>):
          set the abbreviation shortcuts provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>. (See <a 
 href="#sec:abbrshortcuts"><span 
@@ -2004,7 +2038,7 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=other</span><a 
- id="dx1-4195"></a>: set the “other” shortcut commands, but not the shortcut
+ id="dx1-4202"></a>: set the “other” shortcut commands, but not the shortcut
          commands for abbreviations or the acronym shortcuts provided by
          <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>. The “other” shortcuts are:
@@ -2011,28 +2045,28 @@
              <ul class="itemize2">
              <li class="itemize"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newentry</span><a 
- id="dx1-4196"></a> equivalent to <span 
+ id="dx1-4203"></a> equivalent to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span><a 
- id="dx1-4197"></a>
+ id="dx1-4204"></a>
              </li>
              <li class="itemize"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newsym</span><a 
- id="dx1-4198"></a> equivalent  to  <span 
+ id="dx1-4205"></a> equivalent  to  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewsymbol</span><a 
- id="dx1-4199"></a> (see  the  <a 
+ id="dx1-4206"></a> (see  the  <a 
 href="#styopt.symbols"><span 
 class="cmss-10">symbols</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4200"></a>
+ id="dx1-4207"></a>
              option).
              </li>
              <li class="itemize"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newnum</span><a 
- id="dx1-4201"></a> equivalent  to  <span 
+ id="dx1-4208"></a> equivalent  to  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewnumber</span><a 
- id="dx1-4202"></a> (see  the  <a 
+ id="dx1-4209"></a> (see  the  <a 
 href="#styopt.numbers"><span 
 class="cmss-10">numbers</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4203"></a>
+ id="dx1-4210"></a>
              option).</li></ul>
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
@@ -2039,75 +2073,75 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=all</span><a 
- id="dx1-4204"></a> (or <a 
+ id="dx1-4211"></a> (or <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=true</span><a 
- id="dx1-4205"></a>): implements <a 
+ id="dx1-4212"></a>): implements <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-4206"></a>,
+ id="dx1-4213"></a>,
          <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=abbreviations</span><a 
- id="dx1-4207"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-4214"></a> and <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=other</span><a 
- id="dx1-4208"></a>.
+ id="dx1-4215"></a>.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=none</span><a 
- id="dx1-4209"></a> (or <a 
+ id="dx1-4216"></a> (or <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=false</span><a 
- id="dx1-4210"></a>): don’t define any of the shortcut
+ id="dx1-4217"></a>): don’t define any of the shortcut
          commands (default).</li></ul>
-     <!--l. 1035--><p class="noindent" >Note that multiple invocations of the <a 
+     <!--l. 1051--><p class="noindent" >Note that multiple invocations of the <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4211"></a> option <span 
+ id="dx1-4218"></a> option <span 
 class="cmti-10">within the same option</span>
      <span 
 class="cmti-10">list </span>will override each other.</p></dd></dl>
-<!--l. 1039--><p class="indent" >   After the <span 
+<!--l. 1055--><p class="indent" >   After the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package has been loaded, you can set available options
 using
-</p><!--l. 1041--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1057--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glossariesextrasetup</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-4212"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-4219"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossariesextrasetup{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1043--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1059--><p class="noindent" >
 The <a 
 href="#styopt.abbreviations"><span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviations</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4213"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-4220"></a> and <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4214"></a> options may only be used in the preamble. Additionally,
+ id="dx1-4221"></a> options may only be used in the preamble. Additionally,
 <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-4215"></a> can’t be used after <span 
+ id="dx1-4222"></a> can’t be used after <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\makenoidxglossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-4216"></a>.
+ id="dx1-4223"></a>.
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 1048--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 1048--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 1064--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 1064--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">2. <a 
  id="sec:modifications"></a>Modifications to Existing Commands and Styles</h2>
-</p><!--l. 1051--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1067--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package provides <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\nopostdesc</span><a 
  id="dx1-5001"></a> which may be used in the <span 
@@ -2116,12 +2150,12 @@
 to suppress the post-description hook. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package provides another
 command
-</p><!--l. 1055--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1071--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrnopostpunc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5003"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnopostpunc </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1057--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1073--><p class="noindent" >
 which has a similar function but only suppresses the post-description punctuation. It
 doesn’t suppress the use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostdescription </span>which allows the use of
@@ -2133,12 +2167,12 @@
 post-description hook can counter-act the effect of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnopostpunc</span>
 using
-</p><!--l. 1066--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1082--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrrestorepostpunc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5004"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrrestorepostpunc </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1068--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1084--><p class="noindent" >
 These commands have no effect outside of the glossary (except with standalone
 entries that use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtractivatenopost </span>and <span 
@@ -2147,9 +2181,9 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>10.3
 </a><a 
 href="#sec:glossentry">Standalone Entry Items<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:glossentry --></a>).
-</p><!--l. 1073--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1089--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package provides
-</p><!--l. 1074--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1090--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsseeitemformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5005"></a> <span 
@@ -2156,7 +2190,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsseeitemformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1076--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1092--><p class="noindent" >
 to format items in a cross-reference list (identified with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">see</span><a 
  id="dx1-5006"></a> key or <span 
@@ -2190,22 +2224,22 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-25">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-26">
 \renewcommand*{\glsseeitemformat}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifglshasshort{\glslabel}{\glsaccesstext{#1}}{\glsaccessname{#1}}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1095--><p class="nopar" > If you want to restore the <span 
+<!--l. 1111--><p class="nopar" > If you want to restore the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>v3.0+ definition just do:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-26">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-27">
 \renewcommand*{\glsseeitemformat}[1]{\glsentrytext{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1099--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 1101--><p class="indent" >   The commands used by <span 
+<!--l. 1115--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1117--><p class="indent" >   The commands used by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>to automatically produce an error if an entry is
 undefined (such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsdoifexists</span><a 
@@ -2214,7 +2248,7 @@
 class="cmss-10">undefaction</span></a><a 
  id="dx1-5012"></a> option into
 account.
-</p><!--l. 1105--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1121--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newignoredglossary</span><a 
  id="dx1-5013"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -2232,8 +2266,8 @@
 check that the glossary doesn’t already exist. (The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package omits this
 check.)
-</p><!--l. 1114--><p class="indent" >   You can now provide an ignored glossary with:
-</p><!--l. 1115--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1130--><p class="indent" >   You can now provide an ignored glossary with:
+</p><!--l. 1131--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\provideignoredglossary</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5015"></a> <span 
@@ -2240,10 +2274,10 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\provideignoredglossary{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">type</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1117--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1133--><p class="noindent" >
 which will only define the glossary if it doesn’t already exist. This also has a starred
 version that doesn’t automatically switch off hyperlinks.
-</p><!--l. 1122--><p class="indent" >   The individual glossary displaying commands <span 
+</p><!--l. 1138--><p class="indent" >   The individual glossary displaying commands <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printglossary</span><a 
  id="dx1-5016"></a>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printnoidxglossary</span><a 
@@ -2271,7 +2305,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glolinkprefix</span>
      this doesn’t affect any hyperlinks (such as those created with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>).</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1140--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+<!--l. 1156--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry </span>command has three new keys: </p>
      <ul class="itemize1">
      <li class="itemize"><span 
@@ -2304,7 +2338,7 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.2 </a><a 
 href="#sec:see">Cross-References (“see” and “see also”)<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:see --></a> for
      further details.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 1152--><p class="noindent" >The test file <span 
+<!--l. 1168--><p class="noindent" >The test file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">example-glossaries-xr.tex </span>contains dummy entries with a mixture of
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">see</span><a 
@@ -2321,7 +2355,7 @@
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
  id="dx1-5028"></a></a>.
-</p><!--l. 1159--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1175--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\longnewglossaryentry </span>command now has a starred version (as from v1.12)
 that doesn’t automatically insert
                                                                   
@@ -2328,11 +2362,11 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-27">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-28">
 \leavevmode\unskip\nopostdesc
 </div>
-<!--l. 1163--><p class="nopar" > at the end of the description field.
-</p><!--l. 1165--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 1179--><p class="nopar" > at the end of the description field.
+</p><!--l. 1181--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\longnewglossaryentry</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5029"></a> <span 
@@ -2345,19 +2379,19 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">description</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1167--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1183--><p class="noindent" >
 The <span 
 class="cmss-10">descriptionplural</span><a 
  id="dx1-5030"></a> key is left unset unless explicitly set in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">options</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 1171--><p class="indent" >   The unstarred version no longer hard-codes the above code (which removes
+</p><!--l. 1187--><p class="indent" >   The unstarred version no longer hard-codes the above code (which removes
 trailing space and suppresses the post-description hook) but instead uses:
-</p><!--l. 1174--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1190--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlongdescription</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlongdescription </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1176--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1192--><p class="noindent" >
 This can be redefined to allow the post-description hook to work but retain the
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\unskip </span>part if required. For example:
@@ -2365,12 +2399,12 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-28">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-29">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrpostlongdescription}{\leavevmode\unskip}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1182--><p class="nopar" > This will discarded unwanted trailing space at the end of the description but won’t
+<!--l. 1198--><p class="nopar" > This will discarded unwanted trailing space at the end of the description but won’t
 suppress the post-description hook.
-</p><!--l. 1186--><p class="indent" >   The unstarred version also alters the base <span 
+</p><!--l. 1202--><p class="indent" >   The unstarred version also alters the base <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
  id="dx1-5032"></a> package’s treatment of the
 <span 
@@ -2389,10 +2423,10 @@
 singular.<span class="footnote-mark"><a 
 href="#fn1x2" id="fn1x2-bk"><sup class="textsuperscript">2.1</sup></a></span><a 
  id="x1-5036f1"></a>
-</p><!--l. 1201--><p class="indent" >   Note that this modified unstarred version doesn’t append <span 
+</p><!--l. 1217--><p class="indent" >   Note that this modified unstarred version doesn’t append <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlongdescription</span>
 to the description’s plural form.
-</p><!--l. 1204--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1220--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newterm</span><a 
  id="dx1-5042"></a> command (defined through the <a 
 href="#styopt.index"><span 
@@ -2409,9 +2443,9 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>3
 </a><a 
 href="#sec:abbreviations">Abbreviations<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:abbreviations --></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 1210--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1226--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\makeglossaries </span>command now has an optional argument.
-</p><!--l. 1211--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1227--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\makeglossaries</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-5046"></a> <span 
@@ -2418,7 +2452,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\makeglossaries[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1213--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1229--><p class="noindent" >
 If &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">list</span>&#x27E9; is empty, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\makeglossaries </span>behaves as per its original definition in the
@@ -2426,7 +2460,7 @@
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package, otherwise &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">list</span>&#x27E9; can be a comma-separated list of glossaries that
 need processing with an external indexing application.
-</p><!--l. 1219--><p class="indent" >   This command is not permitted with the <a 
+</p><!--l. 1235--><p class="indent" >   This command is not permitted with the <a 
 href="#styopt.record"><span 
 class="cmss-10">record</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=only</span><a 
@@ -2441,7 +2475,7 @@
 class="cmss-10">record</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=off</span><a 
  id="dx1-5049"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 1224--><p class="indent" >   It should then be possible to use <span 
+</p><!--l. 1240--><p class="indent" >   It should then be possible to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printglossary </span>for those glossaries listed in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">list</span>&#x27E9;
 and <span 
@@ -2448,14 +2482,14 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\printnoidxglossary </span>for the other glossaries. (See the accompanying file
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-mixedsort.tex </span>for an example.)
-</p><!--l. 1229--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use the optional argument &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 1245--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use the optional argument &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">list</span>&#x27E9;, you can’t define entries in the document
 (even with the <a 
 href="#styopt.docdef"><span 
 class="cmss-10">docdef</span></a><a 
  id="dx1-5050"></a> option). </div>
-</p><!--l. 1232--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1234--><p class="indent" >   You will need at least version 2.20 of <a 
+</p><!--l. 1248--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1250--><p class="indent" >   You will need at least version 2.20 of <a 
  id="dx1-5051"></a><a 
 href="#glo:makeglossaries"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeglossaries</span></a> or at least version 1.3 of
@@ -2474,10 +2508,10 @@
  id="dx1-5054"></a>
 option.
 </p>
-<!--l. 1240--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 1256--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.1   </span> <a 
  id="sec:wrglossary"></a>Entry Indexing</h3>
-<!--l. 1243--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+<!--l. 1259--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package provides extra keys for commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and
 <span 
@@ -2540,19 +2574,19 @@
      settings (such as <span 
 class="cmss-10">noindex</span><a 
  id="dx1-6010"></a>).
-     <!--l. 1273--><p class="noindent" >The default value is set up using
-     </p><!--l. 1274--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 1289--><p class="noindent" >The default value is set up using
+     </p><!--l. 1290--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrinitwrgloss</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-6011"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinitwrgloss </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 1276--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 1292--><p class="noindent" >
      which is defined as:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-29">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-30">
      \newcommand*{\glsxtrinitwrgloss}{%
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glsifattribute{\glslabel}{wrgloss}{after}%
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{%
@@ -2563,15 +2597,15 @@
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;}%
      &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 1288--><p class="nopar" > This sets the conditional
-     </p><!--l. 1290--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 1304--><p class="nopar" > This sets the conditional
+     </p><!--l. 1306--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\ifglsxtrinitwrglossbefore</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-6012"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsxtrinitwrgloss </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 1292--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 1308--><p class="noindent" >
      which is used to determine where to perform the indexing.
-     </p><!--l. 1295--><p class="noindent" >This means you can set the <a 
+     </p><!--l. 1311--><p class="noindent" >This means you can set the <a 
 href="#catattr.wrgloss"><span 
 class="cmss-10">wrgloss</span></a><a 
  id="dx1-6013"></a> attribute to <span 
@@ -2639,10 +2673,10 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-30">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-31">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{mathrelation}{hyperoutside}{false}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 1322--><p class="nopar" > will set <span 
+     <!--l. 1338--><p class="nopar" > will set <span 
 class="cmtt-10">hyperoutside=false </span>for all entries that are assigned to the category
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">mathrelation </span>and
@@ -2650,10 +2684,10 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-31">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-32">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{mathrelation}{textformat}{mathrel}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 1327--><p class="nopar" > will use <span 
+     <!--l. 1343--><p class="nopar" > will use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\mathrel </span>instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstextformat </span>resulting in: </p><div class="alltt">
      <div class="obeylines-v">
@@ -2671,42 +2705,108 @@
      </div> for entries with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">category</span><a 
  id="dx1-6019"></a> key set to <span 
-class="cmtt-10">mathrelation</span>.</dd></dl>
-<!--l. 1336--><p class="indent" >   There is a new hook that’s used each time indexing information is written to the
+class="cmtt-10">mathrelation</span>.
+     </dd><dt class="description">
+<span 
+class="cmssbx-10">textformat</span><a 
+ id="dx1-6020"></a> </dt><dd 
+class="description">This key must have a control sequence name as its value. The command
+     formed from this name must exist and must take one argument. (Use <span 
+class="cmtt-10">relax </span>for
+     default behaviour.) If set, this overrides the <a 
+href="#catattr.textformat"><span 
+class="cmss-10">textformat</span></a><a 
+ id="dx1-6021"></a> attribute and
+     <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glstextformat</span>. See the <span 
+class="cmss-10">soul</span><a 
+ id="dx1-6022"></a> example in <a 
+href="#sec:glsunset"><span 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.5 </a><a 
+href="#sec:glsunset">Unsetting the First Use
+     Flag<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:glsunset --></a>.
+     </dd></dl>
+<!--l. 1360--><p class="indent" >   There is a new hook that’s used each time indexing information is written to the
 external glossary files:
-</p><!--l. 1338--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1362--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdowrglossaryhook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-6020"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-6023"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdowrglossaryhook{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1340--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1364--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label. This does nothing by default but may be redefined.
 (See, for example, the accompanying sample file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-indexhook.tex</span>, which uses
 this hook to determine which entries haven’t been indexed.)
-</p><!--l. 1347--><p class="indent" >   There’s also a new hook (from v1.26) that’s used immediately before the options
+</p><!--l. 1371--><p class="indent" >   There’s also a new hook (from v1.26) that’s used immediately before the options
 are set by the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>-like and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>-like commands:
-</p><!--l. 1350--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1374--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslinkpresetkeys</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-6021"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-6024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpresetkeys </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1352--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1376--><p class="noindent" >
 (The base package provides <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpostsetkeys</span><a 
- id="dx1-6022"></a> that’s used immediately after the
+ id="dx1-6025"></a> that’s used immediately after the
 options are set.)
-</p><!--l. 1356--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.14, there are two new keys for <span 
+</p><!--l. 1380--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.30 there are also similar hooks for <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span>:
+</p><!--l. 1381--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\glsaddpresetkeys</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-6026"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsaddpresetkeys </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 1383--><p class="noindent" >
+and
+</p><!--l. 1385--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\glsaddpostsetkeys</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-6027"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsaddpostsetkeys </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 1387--><p class="noindent" >
+For example, to default to using the <span 
+class="cmss-10">equation</span><a 
+ id="dx1-6028"></a> counter in maths mode:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-33">
+\renewcommand{\glslinkpresetkeys}{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glslink}{counter=equation}\fi}
+&#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand{\glsaddpresetkeys}{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glossadd}{counter=equation}\fi}
+</div>
+<!--l. 1395--><p class="nopar" > (This can be overridden with an explicit use of <span 
+class="cmss-10">counter</span><a 
+ id="dx1-6029"></a> in the optional argument
+of <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>or <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span>.) Alternatively, to enforce this (overriding the option
+argument):
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-34">
+\renewcommand{\glslinkpostsetkeys}{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glslink}{counter=equation}\fi}
+&#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand{\glsaddpostsetkeys}{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifmmode&#x00A0;\setkeys{glossadd}{counter=equation}\fi}
+</div>
+<!--l. 1405--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1407--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.14, there are two new keys for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span>: <span 
 class="cmss-10">thevalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6023"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-6030"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">theHvalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6024"></a>.
+ id="dx1-6031"></a>.
 These keys are designed for manually adding explicit locations rather than obtaining
 the value from the associated counter. As from version 1.19, these two keys are also
 available for commands like <span 
@@ -2713,33 +2813,30 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslink</span>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">thevalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6025"></a> keys is intended
+ id="dx1-6032"></a> keys is intended
 primarily for adding locations in supplementary material that can’t be obtained from
 a counter.
-</p><!--l. 1365--><p class="indent" >   The principle key <span 
+</p><!--l. 1416--><p class="indent" >   The principle key <span 
 class="cmss-10">thevalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6026"></a> is for the location value. The other key <span 
+ id="dx1-6033"></a> is for the location value. The other key <span 
 class="cmss-10">theHvalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6027"></a> can
+ id="dx1-6034"></a> can
 be used to extract a prefix value for the first argument of commands like
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsnoidxdisplayloc</span><a 
- id="dx1-6028"></a>. It’s value must be in the format &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-6035"></a>. It’s value must be in the format &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">prefix</span>&#x27E9;&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">location</span>&#x27E9;. In general,
 there’s little need for this key as the prefix is typically associated with a counter that
 can be used to form hypertargets.
-</p><!--l. 1373--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use <span 
+</p><!--l. 1424--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use <span 
 class="cmss-10">thevalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6029"></a>, you must make sure that you use an indexing application
+ id="dx1-6036"></a>, you must make sure that you use an indexing application
 that will accept the given value. </div>
-</p><!--l. 1376--><p class="noindent" >
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
-</p><!--l. 1378--><p class="indent" >   For example, <span 
+</p><!--l. 1427--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1429--><p class="indent" >   For example, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-6030"></a> will only accept locations in the form [&#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-6037"></a> will only accept locations in the form [&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">num</span>&#x27E9;&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">sep</span>&#x27E9;]*&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">num</span>&#x27E9;
@@ -2752,38 +2849,38 @@
 with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsSetCompositor</span>). This means that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-6031"></a> won’t accept, for
+ id="dx1-6038"></a> won’t accept, for
 example,
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-32">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-35">
 \glsadd[thevalue={Supplementary&#x00A0;Material}]{sample}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1388--><p class="nopar" > This location value will be accepted by <a 
- id="dx1-6032"></a><a 
+<!--l. 1439--><p class="nopar" > This location value will be accepted by <a 
+ id="dx1-6039"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-6033"></a></a>, since it will allow any location and
+ id="dx1-6040"></a></a>, since it will allow any location and
 will only try forming ranges if the location matches any of its numerical patterns.
 In the case of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">xindy</span><a 
- id="dx1-6034"></a>, you’ll need to add a rule that can match the value.
+ id="dx1-6041"></a>, you’ll need to add a rule that can match the value.
 If you’re using <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-6035"></a>, you may need to use the <span 
+ id="dx1-6042"></a>, you may need to use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">format</span><a 
- id="dx1-6036"></a> key to prevent a
+ id="dx1-6043"></a> key to prevent a
 hyperlink if one can’t naturally be formed from the prefix, counter and location
 value.
-</p><!--l. 1397--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose the file <span 
+</p><!--l. 1448--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose the file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">suppl.tex </span>contains:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-33">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-36">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newglossaryentry{sample}{name={sample},description={an&#x00A0;example}}
@@ -2794,10 +2891,10 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\gls{sample}.
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1412--><p class="nopar" > This has an entry on page S.2. Suppose another document wants to include this
+<!--l. 1463--><p class="nopar" > This has an entry on page S.2. Suppose another document wants to include this
 location in the glossary. Then this can be done by setting <span 
 class="cmss-10">thevalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6037"></a> to <span 
+ id="dx1-6044"></a> to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">S.2</span>. For
 example:
                                                                   
@@ -2804,7 +2901,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-34">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-37">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -2815,38 +2912,38 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsadd[thevalue={S.2}]{sample}
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1431--><p class="nopar" > This location value will be accepted by <span 
+<!--l. 1482--><p class="nopar" > This location value will be accepted by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-6038"></a> as it’s in the form &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-6045"></a> as it’s in the form &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">num</span>&#x27E9;&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">sep</span>&#x27E9;&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">num</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 1435--><p class="indent" >   If you want hyperlinks, things are more complicated. First you need to set the
+</p><!--l. 1486--><p class="indent" >   If you want hyperlinks, things are more complicated. First you need to set the
 <a 
 href="#catattr.externallocation"><span 
 class="cmss-10">externallocation</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-6039"></a> to the location of the PDF file. For example:
+ id="dx1-6046"></a> to the location of the PDF file. For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-35">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-38">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{supplemental}{externallocation}{suppl.pdf}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newglossaryentry{sample}{category=supplemental,
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;name={sample},description={an&#x00A0;example}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1443--><p class="nopar" > Next you need to add <span 
+<!--l. 1494--><p class="nopar" > Next you need to add <span 
 class="cmtt-10">glsxtrsupphypernumber </span>as the format:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-36">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-39">
 \glsadd[thevalue={S.2},format=glsxtrsupphypernumber]{sample}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1447--><p class="nopar" > Both documents will need to use the <span 
+<!--l. 1498--><p class="nopar" > Both documents will need to use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-6040"></a> package. Remember that the counter
+ id="dx1-6047"></a> package. Remember that the counter
 used for the location also needs to match. If <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\theH</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter</span>&#x27E9; is defined in the other
@@ -2853,21 +2950,21 @@
 document and doesn’t match in the referencing document, then you need to use
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">theHvalue</span><a 
- id="dx1-6041"></a> to set the appropriate value. See the accompanying sample files
+ id="dx1-6048"></a> to set the appropriate value. See the accompanying sample files
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-suppl-hyp.tex </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-suppl-main-hyp.tex </span>for an example that uses
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-6042"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 1457--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The hyperlink for the supplementary location may or <span 
+ id="dx1-6049"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 1508--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The hyperlink for the supplementary location may or <span 
 class="cmti-10">may not </span>take you to the
 relevant place in the external PDF file <span 
 class="cmti-10">depending on your PDF viewer</span>. Some may not
 support external links, and some may take you to the first page or last visited page.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 1462--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1464--><p class="indent" >   For example, if both <span 
+</p><!--l. 1513--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1515--><p class="indent" >   For example, if both <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-suppl-hyp.pdf </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-suppl-main-hyp.pdf</span>
 are in the same directory, then viewing <span 
@@ -2875,12 +2972,12 @@
 take you to the correct location in the linked document (when you click on the S.2
 external link), but Okular will take you to the top of the first page of the linked
 document.
-</p><!--l. 1471--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1522--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 1471--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 1522--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.2   </span> <a 
  id="sec:see"></a>Cross-References (“see” and “see also”)</h3>
-<!--l. 1474--><p class="noindent" >The value of the <span 
+<!--l. 1525--><p class="noindent" >The value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">see</span><a 
  id="dx1-7001"></a> key is now saved as a field. This isn’t the case with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>,
@@ -2907,20 +3004,20 @@
  id="dx1-7008"></a><a 
  id="dx1-7009"></a> environment on the next
 run.
-</p><!--l. 1487--><p class="indent" >   This modification allows <span 
+</p><!--l. 1538--><p class="indent" >   This modification allows <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>to provide
-</p><!--l. 1488--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1539--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtraddallcrossrefs</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7010"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtraddallcrossrefs </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1490--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1541--><p class="noindent" >
 which is used at the end of the document to automatically add any unused
 cross-references unless the package option <a 
 href="#styopt.indexcrossrefs"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexcrossrefs</span></a><a 
  id="dx1-7011"></a> was set to false.
-</p><!--l. 1495--><p class="indent" >   As a by-product of this enhancement, the <span 
+</p><!--l. 1546--><p class="indent" >   As a by-product of this enhancement, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">see</span><a 
  id="dx1-7012"></a> key will now work for entries
 defined in the <span 
@@ -2952,9 +3049,9 @@
  id="dx1-7019"></a>
 value to be stored even though it may not be possible to index it at that
 point.
-</p><!--l. 1506--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.06, you can display the cross-referenced information for a given
+</p><!--l. 1557--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.06, you can display the cross-referenced information for a given
 entry using
-</p><!--l. 1508--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1559--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrusesee</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7020"></a> <span 
@@ -2961,9 +3058,9 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrusesee{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1510--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1561--><p class="noindent" >
 This internally uses
-</p><!--l. 1512--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1563--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtruseseeformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7021"></a> <span 
@@ -2972,7 +3069,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">xr list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1514--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1565--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">tag</span>&#x27E9; and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">xr list</span>&#x27E9; are obtained from the value of the entry’s <span 
@@ -2994,7 +3091,7 @@
  id="dx1-7024"></a> field hasn’t been set for the entry given by
 &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 1523--><p class="indent" >   Suppose you want to suppress the <a 
+</p><!--l. 1574--><p class="indent" >   Suppose you want to suppress the <a 
  id="dx1-7025"></a>number list using <a 
 href="#styopt.nonumberlist"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nonumberlist</span></a><a 
@@ -3010,7 +3107,7 @@
  id="dx1-7029"></a> key set, but this will also show the rest of the <a 
  id="dx1-7030"></a>number
 list.
-</p><!--l. 1530--><p class="indent" >   Another approach in this situation is to use the post description hook
+</p><!--l. 1581--><p class="indent" >   Another approach in this situation is to use the post description hook
 with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrusesee </span>to append the cross-reference after the description. For
 example:
@@ -3018,7 +3115,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-37">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-40">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrpostdescgeneral}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifglshasfield{see}{\glscurrententrylabel}
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{,&#x00A0;\glsxtrusesee{\glscurrententrylabel}}%
@@ -3025,11 +3122,11 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1539--><p class="nopar" > Now the cross-references can appear even though the <a 
+<!--l. 1590--><p class="nopar" > Now the cross-references can appear even though the <a 
  id="dx1-7031"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> has been
 suppressed.
-</p><!--l. 1543--><p class="indent" >   As from v1.16, there’s a separate <span 
+</p><!--l. 1594--><p class="indent" >   As from v1.16, there’s a separate <span 
 class="cmss-10">seealso</span><a 
  id="dx1-7032"></a> key. Unlike <span 
 class="cmss-10">see</span><a 
@@ -3049,11 +3146,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\seealsoname </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruseseealsoformat</span>, described
 below).
-</p><!--l. 1551--><p class="indent" >   You can display the formatted list of cross-references stored in the <span 
+</p><!--l. 1602--><p class="indent" >   You can display the formatted list of cross-references stored in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">seealso</span><a 
  id="dx1-7035"></a> key
 using:
-</p><!--l. 1553--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1604--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtruseseealso</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7036"></a> <span 
@@ -3060,10 +3157,10 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruseseealso{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1555--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1606--><p class="noindent" >
 This works in much the same way as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrusesee </span>but it internally uses
-</p><!--l. 1558--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1609--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtruseseeformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7037"></a> <span 
@@ -3070,13 +3167,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruseseealsoformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">xr list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1560--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1611--><p class="noindent" >
 For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-38">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-41">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrpostdescgeneral}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifglshasfield{see}{\glscurrententrylabel}
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{,&#x00A0;\glsxtrusesee{\glscurrententrylabel}}%
@@ -3086,13 +3183,13 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1571--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 1573--><p class="indent" >   The actual unformatted comma-separated list &#x27E8;<span 
+<!--l. 1622--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1624--><p class="indent" >   The actual unformatted comma-separated list &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">xr-list</span>&#x27E9; stored in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">seealso</span><a 
  id="dx1-7038"></a> field
 can be accessed with:
-</p><!--l. 1575--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1626--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrseealsolabels</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7039"></a> <span 
@@ -3099,7 +3196,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrseealsolabels{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1577--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1628--><p class="noindent" >
 This will just expand to the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">xr-labels</span>&#x27E9; provided in the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">seealso</span><a 
@@ -3114,7 +3211,7 @@
 class="cmti-10">tag</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>, so it can’t be automatically treated as a simple comma-separated
 list.
-</p><!--l. 1585--><p class="indent" >   The base <span 
+</p><!--l. 1636--><p class="indent" >   The base <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package provides <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsseelist</span><a 
  id="dx1-7042"></a>, which requires a
@@ -3125,7 +3222,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>as the
 argument. For convenience, <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>provides
-</p><!--l. 1590--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1641--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrseelist</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7043"></a> <span 
@@ -3132,13 +3229,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrseelist{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">xr list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1592--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1643--><p class="noindent" >
 which fully expands its argument and passes it to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsseelist</span>.
-</p><!--l. 1595--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1646--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">seealso</span><a 
  id="dx1-7044"></a> key implements the automatic indexing using
-</p><!--l. 1596--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1647--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrindexseealso</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-7045"></a> <span 
@@ -3147,7 +3244,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">xr list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1598--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1649--><p class="noindent" >
 which just does </p><div class="alltt">
 <div class="obeylines-v">
 <span 
@@ -3166,15 +3263,15 @@
  id="dx1-7047"></a> v4.30+, in which case a distinct
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">seealso </span>cross-reference class is used instead.
-<!--l. 1607--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 1658--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-<!--l. 1607--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 1658--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.3   </span> <a 
  id="sec:entryfmtmods"></a>Entry Display Style Modifications</h3>
-<!--l. 1610--><p class="noindent" >Recall from the <span 
+<!--l. 1661--><p class="noindent" >Recall from the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package that commands such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>display text at
 that point in the document (optionally with a hyperlink to the relevant
@@ -3185,7 +3282,7 @@
 it’s displayed depends on the command used (such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>) and the entry
 format.
-</p><!--l. 1617--><p class="indent" >   The default entry format (<span 
+</p><!--l. 1668--><p class="indent" >   The default entry format (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfmt</span><a 
  id="dx1-8002"></a>) used in the <a 
  id="dx1-8003"></a><a 
@@ -3268,15 +3365,15 @@
      </a><a 
 href="#sec:abbrstyle">Abbreviation Styles<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:abbrstyle --></a>).
      </li></ul>
-<!--l. 1648--><p class="indent" >   This means that entries with a short form can be treated as regular entries rather
+<!--l. 1699--><p class="indent" >   This means that entries with a short form can be treated as regular entries rather
 than abbreviations if it’s more appropriate for the desired style.
-</p><!--l. 1652--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.04, <span 
+</p><!--l. 1703--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.04, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfmt</span><a 
  id="dx1-8024"></a> now puts <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgenentry</span><a 
  id="dx1-8025"></a> in the argument of
 the new command
-</p><!--l. 1654--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1705--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrregularfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
  id="dx1-8026"></a> <span 
@@ -3283,7 +3380,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrregularfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1656--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1707--><p class="noindent" >
 This just does its argument &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; by default. This means that if you want regular
 entries in a different font but don’t want that font to apply to abbreviations, then
@@ -3296,15 +3393,15 @@
 href="#catattr.textformat"><span 
 class="cmss-10">textformat</span></a><a 
  id="dx1-8028"></a> attribute.
-</p><!--l. 1665--><p class="indent" >   For example:
+</p><!--l. 1716--><p class="indent" >   For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-39">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-42">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrregularfont}[1]{\textsf{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1668--><p class="nopar" > You can access the label through <span 
+<!--l. 1719--><p class="nopar" > You can access the label through <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabel</span>. For example, you can query the
 category:
                                                                   
@@ -3311,11 +3408,11 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-40">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-43">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrregularfont}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glsifcategory{\glslabel}{general}{\textsf{#1}}{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1674--><p class="nopar" > or query the category attribute, for example, provide a custom attribute called
+<!--l. 1725--><p class="nopar" > or query the category attribute, for example, provide a custom attribute called
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">font</span>:
                                                                   
@@ -3322,62 +3419,76 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-41">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-44">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{font}{sf}
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\glsxtrregularfont}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glsifattribute{\glslabel}{font}{sf}{\textsf{#1}}{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1682--><p class="nopar" > As from version 1.21, it’s simpler to just do, for example:
+<!--l. 1733--><p class="nopar" > As from version 1.21, it’s simpler to just do, for example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-42">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-45">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{textformat}{textsf}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1686--><p class="nopar" > without redefining <span 
+<!--l. 1737--><p class="nopar" > without redefining <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrregularfont</span>.
-</p><!--l. 1689--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 1740--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.30, there is also a command for abbreviations that encapsulates
+<span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrgenabbrvfmt</span>:
+</p><!--l. 1742--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrabbreviationfont</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-8029"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbreviationfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 1744--><p class="noindent" >
+This also just does its argument by default. Font changes made by abbreviation styles
+are within &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9;.
+</p><!--l. 1748--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostlinkhook </span>provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package to insert information
 after the <a 
- id="dx1-8029"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8030"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> produced by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext </span>is redefined
 to
-</p><!--l. 1692--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1751--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlinkhook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlinkhook </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1694--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1753--><p class="noindent" >
 This command will discard a following full stop (period) if the <a 
 href="#catattr.discardperiod"><span 
 class="cmss-10">discardperiod</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-8031"></a> attribute
+ id="dx1-8032"></a> attribute
 is set to “true” for the current entry’s category. It will also do
-</p><!--l. 1698--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1757--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlink</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8032"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1700--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1759--><p class="noindent" >
 if a full stop hasn’t be discarded and
-</p><!--l. 1702--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1761--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlinkendsentence</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8034"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlinkendsentence </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1704--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1763--><p class="noindent" >
 if a full stop has been discarded.
-</p><!--l. 1707--><p class="indent" >   It may be that you want to check some other setting (rather than a category
+</p><!--l. 1766--><p class="indent" >   It may be that you want to check some other setting (rather than a category
 attribute) to determine whether or not to discard a following full stop. In which case
 you can redefine:
-</p><!--l. 1710--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1769--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8034"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8035"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">true</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -3385,7 +3496,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1712--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1771--><p class="noindent" >
 You can access the field’s label using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabel</span>. This command should do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">true</span>&#x27E9; if the
@@ -3396,12 +3507,12 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-43">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-46">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrifcustomdiscardperiod}[2]{#2}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1719--><p class="nopar" > which means that no additional checks are performed. (Only the recognised category
+<!--l. 1778--><p class="nopar" > which means that no additional checks are performed. (Only the recognised category
 attributes will be checked.)
-</p><!--l. 1723--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Avoid the use of <span 
+</p><!--l. 1782--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Avoid the use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>-like and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>-like commands within the
 post-link hook as they will cause interference. Consider using commands like
@@ -3410,183 +3521,183 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsaccesstext </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp </span>(<a 
 href="#sec:nested"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.6 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:nested">Nested Links<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:nested --></a>) instead.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 1728--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1730--><p class="indent" >   By default <span 
+</p><!--l. 1787--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1789--><p class="indent" >   By default <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink </span>just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<a 
- id="dx1-8035"></a>&#x00A0;if
+ id="dx1-8036"></a>&#x00A0;if
 it exists, where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9; is the category label for the current entry. (For
 example, for the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-8036"></a> category, <span 
+ id="dx1-8037"></a> category, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlinkgeneral </span>if it has been
 defined.)
-</p><!--l. 1736--><p class="indent" >   The sentence-ending hook is slightly more complicated. If the command
+</p><!--l. 1795--><p class="indent" >   The sentence-ending hook is slightly more complicated. If the command
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<a 
- id="dx1-8037"></a>&#x00A0;is defined the hook will do that and then insert a
+ id="dx1-8038"></a>&#x00A0;is defined the hook will do that and then insert a
 full stop with the space factor adjusted to match the end of sentence. If
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<a 
- id="dx1-8038"></a>&#x00A0;hasn’t been defined, the space factor is adjusted to match
+ id="dx1-8039"></a>&#x00A0;hasn’t been defined, the space factor is adjusted to match
 the end of sentence. This means that if you have, for example, an entry that ends
 with a full stop, a redundant following full stop will be discarded and the space factor
 adjusted (in case the entry is in uppercase) unless the entry is followed by additional
 material, in which case the following full stop is no longer redundant and needs to be
 reinserted.
-</p><!--l. 1749--><p class="indent" >   There are some convenient commands you might want to use when customizing
+</p><!--l. 1808--><p class="indent" >   There are some convenient commands you might want to use when customizing
 the post-<a 
- id="dx1-8039"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8040"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> category hooks:
-</p><!--l. 1751--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1810--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8040"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8041"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1753--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1812--><p class="noindent" >
 This will add the description in parentheses on <a 
- id="dx1-8041"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8042"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>.
-</p><!--l. 1756--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose you want to append the description in parentheses on <a 
- id="dx1-8042"></a>first
+</p><!--l. 1815--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose you want to append the description in parentheses on <a 
+ id="dx1-8043"></a>first
 use for entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">symbol</span><a 
- id="dx1-8043"></a> category:
+ id="dx1-8044"></a> category:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-44">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-47">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrpostlinksymbol}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrpostlinkAddDescOnFirstUse
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1763--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 1765--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 1822--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1824--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8044"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlinkAddSymbolOnFirstUse</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1767--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1826--><p class="noindent" >
 This will append the symbol (if defined) in parentheses on <a 
- id="dx1-8045"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8046"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>.
-</p><!--l. 1771--><p class="indent" >   If you want to provide your own custom format be aware that you can’t use
+</p><!--l. 1830--><p class="indent" >   If you want to provide your own custom format be aware that you can’t use
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsused</span><a 
- id="dx1-8046"></a> within the post-<a 
- id="dx1-8047"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8047"></a> within the post-<a 
+ id="dx1-8048"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> hook as by this point the <a 
- id="dx1-8048"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8049"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuseflag">first use flag</a> will have
 been unset. Instead you can use
-</p><!--l. 1774--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1833--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrifwasfirstuse</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8049"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8050"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifwasfirstuse{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">true</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1776--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1835--><p class="noindent" >
 This will do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">true</span>&#x27E9; if the last used entry was the <a 
- id="dx1-8050"></a>first use for that entry, otherwise it
+ id="dx1-8051"></a>first use for that entry, otherwise it
 will do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">false</span>&#x27E9;. (Requires at least <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>v4.19 to work properly.) This command is
 locally set by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>, so don’t rely on it outside of the post-<a 
- id="dx1-8051"></a>link-text
+ id="dx1-8052"></a>link-text
 hook.
-</p><!--l. 1784--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Note that commands like <span 
+</p><!--l. 1843--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Note that commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirst</span><a 
- id="dx1-8052"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-8053"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-8053"></a> fake <a 
- id="dx1-8054"></a>first use for the
+ id="dx1-8054"></a> fake <a 
+ id="dx1-8055"></a>first use for the
 benefit of the post-<a 
- id="dx1-8055"></a>link-text hooks by setting <span 
+ id="dx1-8056"></a>link-text hooks by setting <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifwasfirstuse </span>to
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\@firstoftwo</span>. (Although, depending on the styles in use, they may not exactly
 match the text produced by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-8056"></a>-like commands on <a 
- id="dx1-8057"></a>first use.) However, the
+ id="dx1-8057"></a>-like commands on <a 
+ id="dx1-8058"></a>first use.) However, the
 <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-8058"></a> style alters <span 
+ id="dx1-8059"></a> style alters <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull </span>so that it fakes non-<a 
- id="dx1-8059"></a>first use otherwise
+ id="dx1-8060"></a>first use otherwise
 the inline full format would include the footnote, which is inappropriate.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 1793--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1795--><p class="indent" >   For example, if you want to place the description in a footnote after the <a 
- id="dx1-8060"></a>link-text
+</p><!--l. 1852--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1854--><p class="indent" >   For example, if you want to place the description in a footnote after the <a 
+ id="dx1-8061"></a>link-text
 on <a 
- id="dx1-8061"></a>first use for the <span 
+ id="dx1-8062"></a>first use for the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-8062"></a> category:
+ id="dx1-8063"></a> category:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-45">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-48">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrpostlinkgeneral}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrifwasfirstuse{\footnote{\glsentrydesc{\glslabel}}}{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1801--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 1803--><p class="indent" >   The <a 
+<!--l. 1860--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1862--><p class="indent" >   The <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-8063"></a> abbreviation style uses the post-<a 
- id="dx1-8064"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8064"></a> abbreviation style uses the post-<a 
+ id="dx1-8065"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> hook to place the
 footnote after trailing punctuation characters.
-</p><!--l. 1807--><p class="indent" >   You can set the default options used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 1866--><p class="indent" >   You can set the default options used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslink</span><a 
- id="dx1-8065"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-8066"></a>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-8066"></a> etc with:
-</p><!--l. 1809--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-8067"></a> etc with:
+</p><!--l. 1868--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8067"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8068"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1811--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1870--><p class="noindent" >
 For example, if you mostly don’t want to index entries then you can do:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-46">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-49">
 \GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts{noindex}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1816--><p class="nopar" > and then use, for example, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+<!--l. 1875--><p class="nopar" > and then use, for example, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls[noindex=false]{sample}</span></span></span> when you actually want
 the location added to the <a 
- id="dx1-8068"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-8069"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a>. These defaults may be overridden by other
 settings (such as category attributes) in addition to any settings passed in the option
 argument of commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslink </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.
-</p><!--l. 1823--><p class="indent" >   Note that if you don’t want <span 
+</p><!--l. 1882--><p class="indent" >   Note that if you don’t want <span 
 class="cmti-10">any </span>indexing, just omit <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\makeglossaries </span>and
 <span 
@@ -3593,22 +3704,22 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\printglossaries </span>(or analogous commands). If you want to adjust the
 default for <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrgloss</span><a 
- id="dx1-8069"></a>, it’s better to do this by redefining <span 
+ id="dx1-8070"></a>, it’s better to do this by redefining <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinitwrgloss</span><a 
- id="dx1-8070"></a>
+ id="dx1-8071"></a>
 instead.
-</p><!--l. 1829--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> <span 
+</p><!--l. 1888--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrSetDefaultGlsOpts </span>doesn’t affect <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span>. </div>
-</p><!--l. 1831--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1833--><p class="indent" >   If you want to change the default value of <span 
+</p><!--l. 1890--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1892--><p class="indent" >   If you want to change the default value of <span 
 class="cmss-10">format</span><a 
- id="dx1-8071"></a>, you can instead use:
-</p><!--l. 1835--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"> <span 
+ id="dx1-8072"></a>, you can instead use:
+</p><!--l. 1894--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">format</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1837--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1896--><p class="noindent" >
 This has the advantage of also working for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span>. For example, if you
 want all locations in the back matter to appear in italic (unless explicitly
@@ -3617,14 +3728,14 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-47">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-50">
 \backmatter
 &#x00A0;<br />\GlsXtrSetDefaultNumberFormat{hyperit}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1844--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 1846--><p class="indent" >   Commands like <span 
+<!--l. 1903--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 1905--><p class="indent" >   Commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-8072"></a> have star (<span 
+ id="dx1-8073"></a> have star (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">*</span>) and plus (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">+</span>) modifiers as a short cut for
 <span 
@@ -3632,10 +3743,10 @@
 class="cmtt-10">hyper=true</span>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package provides a way to add a
 third modifier, if required, using
-</p><!--l. 1850--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1909--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrSetAltModifier</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8073"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8074"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrSetAltModifier{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">char</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3642,7 +3753,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1852--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1911--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">char</span>&#x27E9; is the character used as the modifier and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">options</span>&#x27E9; is the default set of
@@ -3649,19 +3760,19 @@
 options (which may be overridden). Note that &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">char</span>&#x27E9; must be a single character (not a
 UTF-8 character, unless you are using <span class="HoLogo-XeLaTeX"><span class="HoLogo-Xe">X<span class="HoLogo-e">&#x018e;</span></span><span class="HoLogo-LaTeX">L<span class="HoLogo-a">A</span><span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span></span></span>&#x00A0;or Lua<span class="HoLogo-LaTeX">L<span class="HoLogo-a">A</span><span class="HoLogo-TeX">T<span class="HoLogo-e">E</span>X</span></span>).
-</p><!--l. 1859--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> When choosing the character &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 1918--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> When choosing the character &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">char</span>&#x27E9; take care of any changes in category code.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 1862--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 1864--><p class="indent" >   Example:
+</p><!--l. 1921--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1923--><p class="indent" >   Example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-48">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-51">
 \GlsXtrSetAltModifier{!}{noindex}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1867--><p class="nopar" > This means that <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+<!--l. 1926--><p class="nopar" > This means that <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls!{sample}</span></span></span> will be equivalent to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls[noindex]{sample}</span></span></span>. It’s
 not possible to mix modifiers. For example, if you want to do
@@ -3669,23 +3780,23 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-49">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-52">
 \gls[noindex,hyper=false]{sample}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1873--><p class="nopar" > you can use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+<!--l. 1932--><p class="nopar" > you can use <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls*[noindex]{sample}</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls![hyper=false]{sample}</span></span></span> but you
 can’t combine the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">* </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">! </span>modifiers.
-</p><!--l. 1878--><p class="indent" >   <a 
- id="dx1-8074"></a><a 
+</p><!--l. 1937--><p class="indent" >   <a 
+ id="dx1-8075"></a><a 
 href="#glo:locationlist">Location lists</a> displayed with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printnoidxglossary </span>internally use
-</p><!--l. 1880--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1939--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsnoidxdisplayloc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8075"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8076"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsnoidxdisplayloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">prefix</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3697,7 +3808,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">location</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1882--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1941--><p class="noindent" >
 This command is provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>, but is modified by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>to check
@@ -3706,11 +3817,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">)</span></span></span> which are discarded to
 obtain the actual control sequence name that forms the location formatting
 command.
-</p><!--l. 1889--><p class="indent" >   If the range identifiers aren’t present, this just uses
-</p><!--l. 1890--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1948--><p class="indent" >   If the range identifiers aren’t present, this just uses
+</p><!--l. 1949--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdisplaysingleloc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8076"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8077"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplaysingleloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">format</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3717,12 +3828,12 @@
 class="cmitt-10">location</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1892--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1951--><p class="noindent" >
 otherwise it uses
-</p><!--l. 1894--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1953--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdisplaystartloc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8077"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8078"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplaystartloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">format</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3729,14 +3840,14 @@
 class="cmitt-10">location</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1896--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1955--><p class="noindent" >
 for the start of a range (where the identifier has been stripped from &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">format</span>&#x27E9;)
 or
-</p><!--l. 1899--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1958--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdisplayendloc</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8078"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8079"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplayendloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">format</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3743,16 +3854,16 @@
 class="cmitt-10">location</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1901--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1960--><p class="noindent" >
 for the end of a range (where the identifier has been stripped from &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">format</span>&#x27E9;).
-</p><!--l. 1905--><p class="indent" >   By default the start range command saves the format in
-</p><!--l. 1906--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1964--><p class="indent" >   By default the start range command saves the format in
+</p><!--l. 1965--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlocrangefmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8079"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8080"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlocrangefmt </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1908--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1967--><p class="noindent" >
 and does <spacer type=vertical size=10><span class="obeylines-h">
    <br /><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplaysingleloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3763,12 +3874,12 @@
    <br /><spacer type=vertical size=10></span>
 (If the format is empty, it will be replaced with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">glsnumberformat</span>.)
-</p><!--l. 1916--><p class="indent" >   The end command checks that the format matches the start of the range,
+</p><!--l. 1975--><p class="indent" >   The end command checks that the format matches the start of the range,
 does
-</p><!--l. 1918--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 1977--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdisplayendlochook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-8080"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-8081"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplayendlochook{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">format</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3775,7 +3886,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">location</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 1920--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 1979--><p class="noindent" >
 (which does nothing by default), followed by <spacer type=vertical size=10><span class="obeylines-h">
    <br /><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdisplaysingleloc{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -3789,34 +3900,34 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 1927--><p class="indent" >   This means that the list
+</p><!--l. 1986--><p class="indent" >   This means that the list
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-50">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-53">
 \glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{(textbf}{1},
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{textbf}{1},
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{)textbf}{1}.
 </div>
-<!--l. 1932--><p class="nopar" > doesn’t display any differently from
+<!--l. 1991--><p class="nopar" > doesn’t display any differently from
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-51">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-54">
 \glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{textbf}{1},
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{textbf}{1},
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsnoidxdisplayloc{}{page}{textbf}{1}.
 </div>
-<!--l. 1938--><p class="nopar" > but it does make it easier to define your own custom list handler that can
+<!--l. 1997--><p class="nopar" > but it does make it easier to define your own custom list handler that can
 accommodate the ranges.
-</p><!--l. 1943--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2002--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 1943--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 2002--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.4   </span> <a 
  id="sec:entrycountmods"></a>Entry Counting Modifications</h3>
-<!--l. 1946--><p class="noindent" >If you are using <a 
+<!--l. 2005--><p class="noindent" >If you are using <a 
  id="dx1-9001"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
@@ -3826,7 +3937,7 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>9 </a><a 
 href="#sec:bib2gls">bib2gls: Managing Reference Databases<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:bib2gls --></a>
 instead.
-</p><!--l. 1950--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 2009--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span><a 
  id="dx1-9003"></a> command is modified to allow for the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
@@ -3839,163 +3950,333 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5
 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a>).
-</p><!--l. 1956--><p class="indent" >   For example, instead of just doing:
+</p><!--l. 2015--><p class="indent" >   For example, instead of just doing:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-52">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-55">
 \glsenableentrycount
 </div>
-<!--l. 1959--><p class="nopar" > you now need to do:
+<!--l. 2018--><p class="nopar" > you now need to do:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-53">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-56">
 \glsenableentrycount
 &#x00A0;<br />\glssetcategoryattribute{abbreviation}{entrycount}{1}
 </div>
-<!--l. 1964--><p class="nopar" > This will enable the entry counting for entries in the <span 
+<!--l. 2023--><p class="nopar" > This will enable the entry counting for entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviation</span><a 
  id="dx1-9005"></a> category, but any
 entries assigned to other categories will be unchanged.
-</p><!--l. 1969--><p class="indent" >   Further information about entry counting, including the new per-unit feature, is
+</p><!--l. 2028--><p class="indent" >   Further information about entry counting, including the new per-unit feature, is
 described in <a 
 href="#sec:entrycount"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>6.1 </a><a 
 href="#sec:entrycount">Entry Counting (First Use Flag)<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:entrycount --></a>.
-</p><!--l. 1972--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2031--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 1972--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 2031--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.5   </span> <a 
+ id="sec:glsunset"></a>Unsetting the First Use Flag</h3>
+<!--l. 2034--><p class="noindent" >The internal command used by <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsunset </span>is modified first to allow for the changing
+in entry counting, described above, but also to allow for buffering pending unsets
+when commands like <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>are used in a context where changing a boolean variable
+can cause things to go wrong. One example of this is using <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>in one of the
+commands provided with the <a 
+ id="dx1-10001"></a>package. For example:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-57">
+\ul{Some&#x00A0;text&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\gls{html}.}
+</div>
+<!--l. 2043--><p class="nopar" > This causes the confusing error:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-58">
+Glossary&#x00A0;entry&#x00A0;`{html}'&#x00A0;has&#x00A0;not&#x00A0;been&#x00A0;defined.
+</div>
+<!--l. 2047--><p class="nopar" > The simplest workaround is to put <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls{html}</span></span></span> inside the argument of <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\mbox</span>. For
+example:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-59">
+\ul{Some&#x00A0;text&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\mbox{\gls{html}}.}
+</div>
+<!--l. 2052--><p class="nopar" > This can work provided it’s not the first use of this entry. It if is, then unsetting the
+first use flag causes a problem and results in the error:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-60">
+!&#x00A0;Package&#x00A0;soul&#x00A0;Error:&#x00A0;Reconstruction&#x00A0;failed.
+</div>
+<!--l. 2058--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
+class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package provides a way of temporarily switching off <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsunset</span>
+so that it just makes a note of the entry’s label but doesn’t actually perform the
+change:
+</p><!--l. 2062--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-10002"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 2064--><p class="noindent" >
+Later you can restore <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsunset </span>and unset all buffered labels using:
+</p><!--l. 2067--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-10003"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 2069--><p class="noindent" >
+The starred form <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering* </span>uses <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glslocalunset </span>instead. For
+example:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-61">
+\documentclass{article}
+&#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[T1]{fontenc}
+&#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{soul}
+&#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
+&#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{html}{HTML}{hypertext&#x00A0;markup&#x00A0;language}
+&#x00A0;<br />\begin{document}
+&#x00A0;<br />\GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering
+&#x00A0;<br />\ul{Some&#x00A0;text&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\mbox{\gls{html}}.}
+&#x00A0;<br />\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering
+&#x00A0;<br />Next&#x00A0;use:&#x00A0;\gls{html}.
+&#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
+</div>
+<!--l. 2088--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2090--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Note that since the change in the first use flag now doesn’t occur until
+<span 
+class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering</span>, multiple references of the same term within the
+buffering zone will always be treated as first use (if the term wasn’t used before the
+buffering started). </div>
+</p><!--l. 2096--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2098--><p class="indent" >   There can still be a problem here as content within <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\mbox </span>can’t break across a
+line so you may end up with an overfull line or excessive white space within the
+paragraph.
+</p><!--l. 2102--><p class="indent" >   An alternative is to use <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\protect</span>:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-62">
+\GlsXtrStartUnsetBuffering
+&#x00A0;<br />\ul{Some&#x00A0;text&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\protect\gls{html}.}
+&#x00A0;<br />\GlsXtrStopUnsetBuffering
+</div>
+<!--l. 2107--><p class="nopar" > but the formatting (underlining in this example) won’t be applied. Another
+possibility is:
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p>
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-63">
+\usepackage[T1]{fontenc}
+&#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{soul}
+&#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
+&#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{html}{HTML}{hypertext&#x00A0;markup&#x00A0;language}
+&#x00A0;<br />\newrobustcmd{\gul}[1]{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;{%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\def\glsxtrabbreviationfont##1{\GlsXtrExpandedFmt{\ul}{##1}}%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\def\glsxtrregularfont##1{\GlsXtrExpandedFmt{\ul}{##1}}%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;#1%
+&#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;}%
+&#x00A0;<br />}
+&#x00A0;<br />\begin{document}
+&#x00A0;<br />\ul{Some&#x00A0;text&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;}\gls[textformat=gul]{html}.
+&#x00A0;<br />Next&#x00A0;use:&#x00A0;\gls{html}.
+&#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
+</div>
+<!--l. 2130--><p class="nopar" > This moves <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>outside of <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\ul </span>and uses <span 
+class="cmss-10">textformat</span><a 
+ id="dx1-10004"></a> to locally change the formatting
+command used by <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>(which is normally given by <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glstextformat </span>or the
+<a 
+href="#catattr.textformat"><span 
+class="cmss-10">textformat</span></a><a 
+ id="dx1-10005"></a> attribute) to a custom command <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\gul</span>, which locally changes the regular
+font and the default abbreviation font to use <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\ul</span>. It then uses
+</p><!--l. 2137--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrExpandedFmt</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-10006"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrExpandedFmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmitt-10">cs</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
+</p><!--l. 2139--><p class="noindent" >
+which (protected) fully expands &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; before applying &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">cs</span>&#x27E9;, which must be a control
+sequence that takes a single argument. This allows <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\ul </span>to move much further inside
+and increases its chances of working. It can still break if &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; expands to
+something that <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\ul </span>can’t deal with. For example, if an abbreviation style is used
+that contains complex formatting or if the field value contains problematic
+content.
+</p><!--l. 2149--><p class="noindent" >
+</p>
+<!--l. 2149--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.6   </span> <a 
  id="plurals"></a>Plurals</h3>
-<!--l. 1974--><p class="noindent" >Some languages, such as English, have a general rule that plurals are formed from
+<!--l. 2151--><p class="noindent" >Some languages, such as English, have a general rule that plurals are formed from
 the singular with a suffix appended. This isn’t an absolute rule. There are
 plenty of exceptions (for example, geese, children, churches, elves, fairies,
 sheep). The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-10001"></a> package allows the <span 
+ id="dx1-11001"></a> package allows the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10002"></a> key to be optional when
+ id="dx1-11002"></a> key to be optional when
 defining entries. In some cases a plural may not make any sense (for example,
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
 the term is a symbol) and in some cases the plural may be identical to the
 singular.
-</p><!--l. 1983--><p class="indent" >   To make life easier for languages where the majority of plurals can simply be
+</p><!--l. 2160--><p class="indent" >   To make life easier for languages where the majority of plurals can simply be
 formed by appending a suffix to the singular, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-10003"></a> package lets the <span 
+ id="dx1-11003"></a> package lets the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10004"></a>
+ id="dx1-11004"></a>
 field default to the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-10005"></a> field with <span 
+ id="dx1-11005"></a> field with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix</span><a 
- id="dx1-10006"></a> appended. This
+ id="dx1-11006"></a> appended. This
 command is defined to be just the letter “s”. This means that the majority of terms
 don’t need to have the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10007"></a> supplied as well, and you only need to use it for the
+ id="dx1-11007"></a> supplied as well, and you only need to use it for the
 exceptions.
-</p><!--l. 1992--><p class="indent" >   For languages that don’t have this general rule, the <span 
+</p><!--l. 2169--><p class="indent" >   For languages that don’t have this general rule, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10008"></a> field will always need to
+ id="dx1-11008"></a> field will always need to
 be supplied, where needed.
-</p><!--l. 1995--><p class="indent" >   There are other plural fields, such as <span 
+</p><!--l. 2172--><p class="indent" >   There are other plural fields, such as <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10009"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-11009"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">longplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10010"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-11010"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10011"></a>. Again, if
+ id="dx1-11011"></a>. Again, if
 you are using a language that doesn’t have a simple suffix rule, you’ll have to
 supply the plural forms if you need them (and if a plural makes sense in the
 context).
-</p><!--l. 2001--><p class="indent" >   If these fields are omitted, the <span 
+</p><!--l. 2178--><p class="indent" >   If these fields are omitted, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-10012"></a> package follows these rules: </p>
+ id="dx1-11012"></a> package follows these rules: </p>
      <ul class="itemize1">
      <li class="itemize">If <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10013"></a> is missing, then <span 
+ id="dx1-11013"></a> is missing, then <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix </span>is appended to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-10014"></a>
+ id="dx1-11014"></a>
      field, if that field has been supplied. If the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-10015"></a> field hasn’t been supplied
+ id="dx1-11015"></a> field hasn’t been supplied
      but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10016"></a> field has been supplied, then the <span 
+ id="dx1-11016"></a> field has been supplied, then the <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10017"></a> field defaults to
+ id="dx1-11017"></a> field defaults to
      the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10018"></a> field. If the <span 
+ id="dx1-11018"></a> field. If the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10019"></a> field hasn’t been supplied, then both the <span 
+ id="dx1-11019"></a> field hasn’t been supplied, then both the <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10020"></a>
+ id="dx1-11020"></a>
      and <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10021"></a> fields default to the <span 
+ id="dx1-11021"></a> fields default to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-10022"></a> field (or <span 
+ id="dx1-11022"></a> field (or <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-10023"></a>, if no <span 
+ id="dx1-11023"></a>, if no <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-10024"></a> field) with
+ id="dx1-11024"></a> field) with
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix </span>appended.
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
      </li>
      <li class="itemize">If the <span 
 class="cmss-10">longplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10025"></a> field is missing, then <span 
+ id="dx1-11025"></a> field is missing, then <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix </span>is appended to
      the <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-10026"></a> field, if the <span 
+ id="dx1-11026"></a> field, if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-10027"></a> field has been supplied.
+ id="dx1-11027"></a> field has been supplied.
      </li>
      <li class="itemize">If the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10028"></a> field is missing then, <span 
+ id="dx1-11028"></a> field is missing then, <span 
 class="cmti-10">with the base </span><span 
 class="cmssi-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-10029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-11029"></a> <span 
 class="cmti-10">acronym</span>
      <span 
 class="cmti-10">mechanism</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrpluralsuffix</span><a 
- id="dx1-10030"></a> is appended to the <span 
+ id="dx1-11030"></a> is appended to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-10031"></a> field.
+ id="dx1-11031"></a> field.
      </li></ul>
-<!--l. 2024--><p class="indent" >   This <span 
+<!--l. 2201--><p class="indent" >   This <span 
 class="cmti-10">last case is changed </span>with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>. With this extension package, the
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10032"></a> field defaults to the <span 
+ id="dx1-11032"></a> field defaults to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-10033"></a> field with <span 
+ id="dx1-11033"></a> field with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbrvpluralsuffix</span><a 
- id="dx1-10034"></a> appended
+ id="dx1-11034"></a> appended
 unless overridden by category attributes. This suffix command is set by the
 abbreviation styles. This means that every time an abbreviation style is
 implemented, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbrvpluralsuffix </span>is redefined. In most cases its redefined to
 use
-</p><!--l. 2032--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2209--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-10035"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-11035"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2034--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2211--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to just <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix</span>. Some of the abbreviation styles have their
 own command for the plural suffix, such as <span 
@@ -4008,70 +4289,73 @@
 the style. Redefining <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrpluralsuffix </span>will have no affect, since it’s not used by the
 new abbreviation mechanism.
-</p><!--l. 2044--><p class="indent" >   If you require a mixture (for example, in a multilingual document), there are two
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
+</p><!--l. 2221--><p class="indent" >   If you require a mixture (for example, in a multilingual document), there are two
 attributes that affect the short plural suffix formation. The first is <a 
 href="#catattr.aposplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">aposplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-10036"></a> which
+ id="dx1-11036"></a> which
 uses the suffix
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-54">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-64">
 '\abbrvpluralsuffix
 </div>
-<!--l. 2049--><p class="nopar" > That is, an apostrophe followed by <span 
+<!--l. 2226--><p class="nopar" > That is, an apostrophe followed by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbrvpluralsuffix </span>is appended. The second
 attribute is <a 
 href="#catattr.noshortplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">noshortplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-10037"></a> which suppresses the suffix and simply sets <span 
+ id="dx1-11037"></a> which suppresses the suffix and simply sets <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-10038"></a> to the
+ id="dx1-11038"></a> to the
 same as <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-10039"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 2055--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="dx1-11039"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 2232--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 2055--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.6   </span> <a 
+<!--l. 2232--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.7   </span> <a 
  id="sec:nested"></a>Nested Links</h3>
-<!--l. 2058--><p class="noindent" >Complications arise when you use <span 
+<!--l. 2235--><p class="noindent" >Complications arise when you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-11001"></a> in the value of the <span 
+ id="dx1-12001"></a> in the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-11002"></a> field (or <span 
+ id="dx1-12002"></a> field (or <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-11003"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-12003"></a> or <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-11004"></a>
+ id="dx1-12004"></a>
 fields, if set). This tends to occur with abbreviations that extend other abbreviations.
 For example, SHTML is an abbreviation for SSI enabled HTML, where SSI is an
 abbreviation for Server Side Includes and HTML is an abbreviation for Hypertext
 Markup Language.
-</p><!--l. 2066--><p class="indent" >   Things can go wrong if we try the following with the <span 
+</p><!--l. 2243--><p class="indent" >   Things can go wrong if we try the following with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-55">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-65">
 \newacronym{ssi}{SSI}{Server&#x00A0;Side&#x00A0;Includes}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newacronym{html}{HTML}{Hypertext&#x00A0;Markup&#x00A0;Language}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newacronym{shtml}{S\gls{html}}{\gls{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\gls{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2072--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2074--><p class="indent" >   The main problems are:
+<!--l. 2249--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2251--><p class="indent" >   The main problems are:
      </p><ol  class="enumerate1" >
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11006x1"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12006x1"><a 
  id="itm:nestedfirstucprob"></a> The first letter upper casing commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-11007"></a>, won’t work for the
+ id="dx1-12007"></a>, won’t work for the
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry on <a 
- id="dx1-11008"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12008"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> if the long form is displayed before the short
      form (which is the default abbreviation style). This will attempt to
      do
@@ -4078,10 +4362,10 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-56">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-66">
      \gls{\uppercase&#x00A0;ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\gls{html}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2082--><p class="nopar" > which just doesn’t work. Grouping the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+     <!--l. 2259--><p class="nopar" > which just doesn’t work. Grouping the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{ssi}</span></span></span> doesn’t work either as this
      will effectively try to do
                                                                   
@@ -4088,35 +4372,35 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-57">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-67">
      \uppercase{\gls{ssi}}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\gls{html}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2087--><p class="nopar" > This will upper case the label <span 
+     <!--l. 2264--><p class="nopar" > This will upper case the label <span 
 class="cmtt-10">ssi </span>so the entry won’t be recognised.
      This problem will also occur if you use the all capitals version, such as
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLS</span><a 
- id="dx1-11009"></a>.
+ id="dx1-12009"></a>.
      </p></li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11011x2"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12011x2"><a 
  id="itm:nonexpandprob"></a> The long and abbreviated forms accessed through <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrylong</span><a 
- id="dx1-11012"></a> and
+ id="dx1-12012"></a> and
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11013"></a> are no longer expandable and so can’t be used be used in
+ id="dx1-12013"></a> are no longer expandable and so can’t be used be used in
      contexts that require this, such as PDF bookmarks.
      </li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11015x3"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12015x3"><a 
  id="itm:nestedsortprob"></a> The nested commands may end up in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11016"></a> key, which will confuse the
+ id="dx1-12016"></a> key, which will confuse the
      indexing.
      </li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11018x4"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12018x4"><a 
  id="itm:inconsistentfirstuseprob"></a> The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry produces inconsistent results depending on whether the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">ssi</span>
@@ -4129,18 +4413,18 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-58">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-68">
      This&#x00A0;section&#x00A0;discusses&#x00A0;\gls{ssi},&#x00A0;\gls{html}&#x00A0;and&#x00A0;\gls{shtml}.
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2106--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
+     <!--l. 2283--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 2109--><p class="noindent" >This  section  discusses  server  side  includes  (SSI),  hypertext
+         <!--l. 2286--><p class="noindent" >This  section  discusses  server  side  includes  (SSI),  hypertext
          markup language (HTML) and SSI enabled HTML (SHTML).</p></div>
-     <!--l. 2112--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
- id="dx1-11019"></a><a 
+     <!--l. 2289--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
+ id="dx1-12019"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry produces “SSI enabled HTML (SHTML)”.
-     </p><!--l. 2115--><p class="noindent" >Now let’s suppose the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 2292--><p class="noindent" >Now let’s suppose the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">html </span>entry is used before the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>but the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">ssi </span>entry is
@@ -4150,21 +4434,21 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-59">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-69">
      The&#x00A0;sample&#x00A0;files&#x00A0;are&#x00A0;either&#x00A0;\gls{html}&#x00A0;or&#x00A0;\gls{shtml},&#x00A0;but&#x00A0;let's
      &#x00A0;<br />first&#x00A0;discuss&#x00A0;\gls{ssi}.
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2121--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
+     <!--l. 2298--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 2124--><p class="noindent" >The sample files are either hypertext markup language (HTML)
+         <!--l. 2301--><p class="noindent" >The sample files are either hypertext markup language (HTML)
          or server side includes (SSI) enabled HTML (SHTML), but let’s
          first discuss SSI.</p></div>
-     <!--l. 2129--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
- id="dx1-11020"></a><a 
+     <!--l. 2306--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
+ id="dx1-12020"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry now produces “server side includes (SSI)
      enabled HTML (SHTML)”, which looks a bit strange.
-     </p><!--l. 2133--><p class="noindent" >Now let’s suppose the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 2310--><p class="noindent" >Now let’s suppose the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry is used before (or without) the other two
      entries:
                                                                   
@@ -4171,20 +4455,20 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-60">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-70">
      This&#x00A0;article&#x00A0;is&#x00A0;an&#x00A0;introduction&#x00A0;to&#x00A0;\gls{shtml}.
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2137--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
+     <!--l. 2314--><p class="nopar" > This produces:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 2140--><p class="noindent" >This  article  is  an  introduction  to  server  side  includes  (SSI)
+         <!--l. 2317--><p class="noindent" >This  article  is  an  introduction  to  server  side  includes  (SSI)
          enabled hypertext markup language (HTML) (SHTML).</p></div>
-     <!--l. 2143--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
- id="dx1-11021"></a><a 
+     <!--l. 2320--><p class="noindent" >So the <a 
+ id="dx1-12021"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry now produces “server side includes (SSI)
      enabled hypertext markup language (HTML) (SHTML)”, which is even more
      strange.
-     </p><!--l. 2147--><p class="noindent" >This is all aggravated by setting the style using the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 2324--><p class="noindent" >This is all aggravated by setting the style using the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package’s
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\setacronymstyle</span>. For example:
@@ -4192,15 +4476,15 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-61">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-71">
      \setacronymstyle{long-short}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2152--><p class="nopar" > as this references the label through the use of <span 
+     <!--l. 2329--><p class="nopar" > as this references the label through the use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabel </span>when displaying the
      long and short forms, but this value changes with each use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>, so
      instead of displaying “(SHTML)” at the end of the <a 
- id="dx1-11022"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12022"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, it now
      displays “(HTML)”, since <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabel </span>has been changed to <span 
@@ -4207,7 +4491,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">html </span>by
      <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{html}</span></span></span>.
-     </p><!--l. 2160--><p class="noindent" >Another oddity occurs if you reset the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 2337--><p class="noindent" >Another oddity occurs if you reset the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">html </span>entry between uses of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml</span>
      entry. For example:
@@ -4215,27 +4499,27 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-62">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-72">
      \gls{shtml}&#x00A0;...&#x00A0;\glsreset{html}\gls{shtml}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 2164--><p class="nopar" > The next use of <span 
+     <!--l. 2341--><p class="nopar" > The next use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>produces “Shypertext markup language (HTML)”,
      which is downright weird.
-     </p><!--l. 2168--><p class="noindent" >Even without this, the short form has nested formatting commands, which
+     </p><!--l. 2345--><p class="noindent" >Even without this, the short form has nested formatting commands, which
      amount to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acronymfont{S\acronymfont{HTML}}</span></span></span>. This may not be a problem
      for some styles, but if you use one of the “sm” styles (that use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsmaller</span><a 
- id="dx1-11023"></a>),
+ id="dx1-12023"></a>),
      this will produce an odd result.
      </p></li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11025x5"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12025x5"><a 
  id="itm:indexingprob"></a> Each time the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">shtml </span>entry is used, the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">html </span>entry will also be indexed and
      marked as used, and on <a 
- id="dx1-11026"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12026"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> this will happen to both the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">ssi </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">html</span>
@@ -4243,23 +4527,23 @@
      helpful to the reader.
      </li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-11028x6"><a 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-12028x6"><a 
  id="itm:nestedhyplinkprob"></a> If <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-11029"></a> is in use, you’ll get nested hyperlinks and there’s no consistent way
+ id="dx1-12029"></a> is in use, you’ll get nested hyperlinks and there’s no consistent way
      of dealing with this across the available PDF viewers. If on the <a 
- id="dx1-11030"></a>first
+ id="dx1-12030"></a>first
      use case, the user clicks on the “HTML” part of the “SSI enabled
      HTML (SHTML)” link, they may be directed to the HTML entry
      in the glossary or they may be directed to the SHTML entry in the
      glossary.
      </li></ol>
-<!--l. 2189--><p class="indent" >   For these reasons it’s better to use the simple expandable commands
+<!--l. 2366--><p class="indent" >   For these reasons it’s better to use the simple expandable commands
 like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrytext</span><a 
- id="dx1-11031"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-12031"></a> or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11032"></a> in the definition of other entries
+ id="dx1-12032"></a> in the definition of other entries
 (although that doesn’t fix the first problem). Alternatively use something
 like:
                                                                   
@@ -4266,34 +4550,34 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-63">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-73">
 \newacronym
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;[description={\acrshort{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\acrshort{html}}]
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{shtml}{SHTML}{SSI&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;HTML}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2197--><p class="nopar" > with <span 
+<!--l. 2374--><p class="nopar" > with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>or:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-64">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-74">
 \newabbreviation
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;[description={\glsxtrshort{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\glsxtrshort{html}}]
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{shtml}{SHTML}{SSI&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;HTML}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2203--><p class="nopar" > with <span 
+<!--l. 2380--><p class="nopar" > with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>. This fixes all the above listed problems (as long as you don’t
 use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsdesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-11033"></a>). Note that replacing <span 
+ id="dx1-12033"></a>). Note that replacing <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort </span>in the original example
 may fix the <a 
- id="dx1-11034"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12034"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> issue, but it doesn’t fix any of the other problems listed
 above.
-</p><!--l. 2210--><p class="indent" >   If it’s simply that you want to use the abbreviation font, you can use
+</p><!--l. 2387--><p class="indent" >   If it’s simply that you want to use the abbreviation font, you can use
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont</span>:
                                                                   
@@ -4300,7 +4584,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-65">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-75">
 \setabbreviationstyle{long-short-sc}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{ssi}{ssi}{server-side&#x00A0;includes}
 &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{html}{html}{hypertext&#x00A0;markup&#x00A0;language}
@@ -4307,22 +4591,22 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{shtml}{shtml}{\glsabbrvfont{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsabbrvfont{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2219--><p class="nopar" > This will pick up the font style setting of the outer entry (shtml, in the above case).
+<!--l. 2396--><p class="nopar" > This will pick up the font style setting of the outer entry (shtml, in the above case).
 This isn’t a problem in the above example as all the abbreviations use the same
 style.
-</p><!--l. 2224--><p class="indent" >   However if you’re really determined to use <span 
+</p><!--l. 2401--><p class="indent" >   However if you’re really determined to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-11035"></a> in a field that may be included
+ id="dx1-12035"></a> in a field that may be included
 within some <a 
- id="dx1-11036"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12036"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>patches internals used by the linking commands
 so that if <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>(or plural or case changing variants) occurs in the <a 
- id="dx1-11037"></a>link-text it will
+ id="dx1-12037"></a>link-text it will
 behave as though you used <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span><a 
- id="dx1-11038"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-12038"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">[hyper=false,noindex] </span>instead. Grouping is
 also added so that, for example, when <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{shtml}</span></span></span> is used for the first time the long
@@ -4331,19 +4615,19 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-66">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-76">
 \gls{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\gls{html}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2235--><p class="nopar" > is treated as
+<!--l. 2412--><p class="nopar" > is treated as
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-67">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-77">
 {\glstext[hyper=false,noindex]{ssi}}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />{\glstext[hyper=false,noindex]{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2240--><p class="nopar" > This overcomes problems&#x00A0;<a 
+<!--l. 2417--><p class="nopar" > This overcomes problems&#x00A0;<a 
 href="#itm:inconsistentfirstuseprob">4<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:inconsistentfirstuseprob --></a>, <a 
 href="#itm:indexingprob">5<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:indexingprob --></a> and <a 
 href="#itm:nestedhyplinkprob">6<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:nestedhyplinkprob --></a> listed above, but still doesn’t fix problems&#x00A0;<a 
@@ -4352,24 +4636,24 @@
 href="#itm:nonexpandprob">2<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:nonexpandprob --></a>. Problem&#x00A0;<a 
 href="#itm:nestedsortprob">3<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:nestedsortprob --></a> usually won’t be an issue as most abbreviation styles set the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11039"></a>
+ id="dx1-12039"></a>
 key to the short form, so using these commands in the long form but not the short
 form will only affect entries with a style that sorts according to the long form (such
 as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-11040"></a>).
-</p><!--l. 2251--><p class="indent" >   Additionally, any instance of the long form commands, such as <span 
+ id="dx1-12040"></a>).
+</p><!--l. 2428--><p class="indent" >   Additionally, any instance of the long form commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-11041"></a> or
+ id="dx1-12041"></a> or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-11042"></a> will be temporarily redefined to just use </p><div class="alltt">
+ id="dx1-12042"></a> will be temporarily redefined to just use </p><div class="alltt">
 <div class="obeylines-v">
 <span 
 class="cmsy-10">{</span><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrylong</span><a 
- id="dx1-11043"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-12043"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -4379,11 +4663,11 @@
 </div> (or case-changing versions). Similarly the short form commands, such as
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11044"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-12044"></a> or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11045"></a> will use <span 
+ id="dx1-12045"></a> will use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11046"></a> in the argument of either
+ id="dx1-12046"></a> in the argument of either
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>(for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span>) or <span 
@@ -4394,65 +4678,65 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-68">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-78">
 \newacronym{shtml}{SHTML}{\acrshort{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled&#x00A0;\acrshort{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2264--><p class="nopar" > then (using the <a 
+<!--l. 2441--><p class="nopar" > then (using the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-11047"></a> style) the <a 
- id="dx1-11048"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-12047"></a> style) the <a 
+ id="dx1-12048"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> will be like
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-69">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-79">
 {\acronymfont{\glsentryshort{ssi}}}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />{\acronymfont{\glsentryshort{html}}}&#x00A0;(SHTML)
 </div>
-<!--l. 2270--><p class="nopar" > whereas if the entry is defined as:
+<!--l. 2447--><p class="nopar" > whereas if the entry is defined as:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-70">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-80">
 \newabbreviation{shtml}{SHTML}{\glsxtrshort{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsxtrshort{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2275--><p class="nopar" > then the <a 
- id="dx1-11049"></a><a 
+<!--l. 2452--><p class="nopar" > then the <a 
+ id="dx1-12049"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> will be like:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-71">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-81">
 {\glsabbrvfont{\glsentryshort{ssi}}}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />{\glsabbrvfont{\glsentryshort{html}}}&#x00A0;(SHTML)
 </div>
-<!--l. 2280--><p class="nopar" > Note that the first optional argument of <span 
+<!--l. 2457--><p class="nopar" > Note that the first optional argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>is ignored in
 this context. (The final optional argument will be inserted, if present.) The
 abbreviation style that governs <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-11050"></a> will be set for <span 
+ id="dx1-12050"></a> will be set for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-11051"></a>. Note
+ id="dx1-12051"></a>. Note
 that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort </span>doesn’t set the abbreviation style.
-</p><!--l. 2288--><p class="indent" >   Alternatively you can use:
-</p><!--l. 2289--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2465--><p class="indent" >   Alternatively you can use:
+</p><!--l. 2466--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrp</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11052"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12052"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">field</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2291--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2468--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9; is the field label and corresponds to a command in the form <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -4462,34 +4746,34 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtr</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9; (e.g.&#x00A0;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span>).
-</p><!--l. 2296--><p class="indent" >   There’s a shortcut command for the most common fields:
-</p><!--l. 2297--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2473--><p class="indent" >   There’s a shortcut command for the most common fields:
+</p><!--l. 2474--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsps</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11053"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12053"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsps{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2299--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2476--><p class="noindent" >
 which is equivalent to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp{short}</span></span></span><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>, and
-</p><!--l. 2301--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2478--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glspt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11054"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12054"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2303--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2480--><p class="noindent" >
 which is equivalent to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp{text}</span></span></span><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2306--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 2483--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp </span>command behaves much like the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmt</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9; commands described
@@ -4500,48 +4784,48 @@
 hook is also suppressed and extra grouping is added. It automatically sets
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyper</span><a 
- id="dx1-11055"></a> to <span 
+ id="dx1-12055"></a> to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">false </span>and <span 
 class="cmss-10">noindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-11056"></a> to <span 
+ id="dx1-12056"></a> to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true</span>. If you want to change this, you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 2313--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2490--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsetpopts</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11057"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12057"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsetpopts{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2315--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2492--><p class="noindent" >
 For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-72">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-82">
 \glsxtrsetpopts{hyper=false}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2319--><p class="nopar" > will just switch off the hyperlinks but not the indexing. Be careful using
+<!--l. 2496--><p class="nopar" > will just switch off the hyperlinks but not the indexing. Be careful using
 this command or you can end up back to the original problem of nested
 links.
-</p><!--l. 2324--><p class="indent" >   The hyper link is re-enabled within glossaries. This is done through the
+</p><!--l. 2501--><p class="indent" >   The hyper link is re-enabled within glossaries. This is done through the
 command:
-</p><!--l. 2326--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2503--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glossxtrsetpopts</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11058"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12058"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossxtrsetpopts </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2328--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2505--><p class="noindent" >
 which by default just does
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-73">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-83">
 \glsxtrsetpopts{noindex}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2332--><p class="nopar" > You can redefine this if you want to adjust the setting when <span 
+<!--l. 2509--><p class="nopar" > You can redefine this if you want to adjust the setting when <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp </span>is used in the
 glossary. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -4548,40 +4832,40 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-74">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-84">
 \renewcommand{\glossxtrsetpopts}{\glsxtrsetpopts{noindex=false}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2337--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2339--><p class="indent" >   For example,
+<!--l. 2514--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2516--><p class="indent" >   For example,
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-75">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-85">
 \glsxtrp{short}{ssi}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2342--><p class="nopar" > is equivalent to
+<!--l. 2519--><p class="nopar" > is equivalent to
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-76">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-86">
 {\let\glspostlinkhook\relax
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glsxtrshort[hyper=false,noindex]{ssi}[]%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2348--><p class="nopar" > in the main body of the document or
+<!--l. 2525--><p class="nopar" > in the main body of the document or
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-77">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-87">
 {\let\glspostlinkhook\relax
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glsxtrshort[noindex]{ssi}[]%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2354--><p class="nopar" > inside the glossary. (Note the post-link hook is locally disabled.)
-</p><!--l. 2357--><p class="indent" >   If <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+<!--l. 2531--><p class="nopar" > inside the glossary. (Note the post-link hook is locally disabled.)
+</p><!--l. 2534--><p class="indent" >   If <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrp{short}{ssi}</span></span></span> occurs in a sectioning mark, it’s equivalent
 to
                                                                   
@@ -4588,57 +4872,57 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-78">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-88">
 {\glsxtrheadshort{ssi}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2361--><p class="nopar" > (which recognises the <a 
+<!--l. 2538--><p class="nopar" > (which recognises the <a 
 href="#catattr.headuc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">headuc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-11059"></a> attribute.)
-</p><!--l. 2364--><p class="indent" >   If <span 
+ id="dx1-12059"></a> attribute.)
+</p><!--l. 2541--><p class="indent" >   If <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-11060"></a> has been loaded, then the bookmark will use <span 
+ id="dx1-12060"></a> has been loaded, then the bookmark will use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentry</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9;
 (<span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort{ssi}</span></span></span> in the above example).
-</p><!--l. 2368--><p class="indent" >   There are similar commands
-</p><!--l. 2369--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2545--><p class="indent" >   There are similar commands
+</p><!--l. 2546--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrp</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11061"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12061"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrp{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">field</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2371--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2548--><p class="noindent" >
 for first letter upper case and
-</p><!--l. 2373--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2550--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrp</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-11062"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-12062"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrp{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">field</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2375--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2552--><p class="noindent" >
 for all upper case.
-</p><!--l. 2378--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use any of the case-changing commands, such as <span 
+</p><!--l. 2555--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use any of the case-changing commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-11063"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-12063"></a> or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glstext</span><a 
- id="dx1-11064"></a>, (either
+ id="dx1-12064"></a>, (either
 all caps or first letter upper casing) don’t use any of the linking commands, such as
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-11065"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-12065"></a> or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span><a 
- id="dx1-11066"></a>, in the definition of entries for any of the fields that may be used
+ id="dx1-12066"></a>, in the definition of entries for any of the fields that may be used
 by those case-changing commands. </div>
-</p><!--l. 2384--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2386--><p class="indent" >   You can, with care, protect against issue&#x00A0;<a 
+</p><!--l. 2561--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2563--><p class="indent" >   You can, with care, protect against issue&#x00A0;<a 
 href="#itm:nestedfirstucprob">1<!--tex4ht:ref: itm:nestedfirstucprob --></a> by inserting an empty group at the
 start if the long form starts with a command that breaks the first letter uppercasing
 commands like <span 
@@ -4645,23 +4929,23 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\Gls</span>, but you still won’t be able to use the all caps commands, such
 as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLS</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2392--><p class="indent" >   If you <span 
+</p><!--l. 2569--><p class="indent" >   If you <span 
 class="cmti-10">really need </span>nested commands, the safest method is
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-79">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-89">
 \newabbreviation{shtml}{shtml}{{}\glsxtrp{short}{ssi}&#x00A0;enabled
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsxtrp{short}{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2396--><p class="nopar" > but be aware that it may have some unexpected results occasionally.
-</p><!--l. 2399--><p class="indent" >   Example document:
+<!--l. 2573--><p class="nopar" > but be aware that it may have some unexpected results occasionally.
+</p><!--l. 2576--><p class="indent" >   Example document:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-80">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-90">
 \documentclass{report}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[utf8]{inputenc}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[T1]{fontenc}
@@ -4686,20 +4970,20 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2437--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2439--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 2614--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2616--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 2439--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.7   </span> <a 
+<!--l. 2616--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.8   </span> <a 
  id="sec:acronymmods"></a>Acronym Style Modifications</h3>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-<!--l. 2442--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+<!--l. 2619--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package provides a new way of dealing with abbreviations and
 redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-12001"></a> to use <span 
+ id="dx1-13001"></a> to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(see <a 
 href="#sec:abbreviations"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>3 </a><a 
@@ -4713,10 +4997,10 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-81">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-91">
 \setabbreviationstyle[acronym]{long-short}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2450--><p class="nopar" > before you define any entries. For example, the following document using just
+<!--l. 2627--><p class="nopar" > before you define any entries. For example, the following document using just
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>
                                                                   
@@ -4723,7 +5007,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-82">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-92">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[acronym,nopostdot,toc]{glossaries}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -4734,13 +5018,13 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2463--><p class="nopar" > can be easily adapted to use <span 
+<!--l. 2640--><p class="nopar" > can be easily adapted to use <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-83">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-93">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[acronym]{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -4751,7 +5035,7 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2475--><p class="nopar" > Table&#x00A0;<a 
+<!--l. 2652--><p class="nopar" > Table&#x00A0;<a 
 href="#tab:acrabbrvstyles">2.1<!--tex4ht:ref: tab:acrabbrvstyles --></a> lists the nearest equivalent <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>abbreviation styles for the
 predefined acronym styles provided by <span 
@@ -4766,7 +5050,7 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-<!--l. 2482--><p class="indent" >   <a 
+<!--l. 2659--><p class="indent" >   <a 
  id="tab:acrabbrvstyles"></a></p><hr class="float" /><div class="float" 
 >
                                                                   
@@ -4783,7 +5067,7 @@
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">new-style-name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
-class="cmtt-10">}</span></span></div><!--tex4ht:label?: x1-120021 -->
+class="cmtt-10">}</span></span></div><!--tex4ht:label?: x1-130021 -->
 <div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-2" class="tabular" 
 cellspacing="0" cellpadding="0"  
 ><colgroup id="TBL-2-1g"><col 
@@ -4790,37 +5074,37 @@
 id="TBL-2-1" /><col 
 id="TBL-2-2" /></colgroup><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-1-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-1-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2489--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2666--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmbx-10">Old Style Name</span>      </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-1-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2490--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td10"><!--l. 2667--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmbx-10">New Style Name</span>                                         </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-2-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-2-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2491--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2668--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sc-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-12003"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-2-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2491--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13003"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-2-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2668--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12004"></a>                                                        </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13004"></a>                                                        </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-3-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-3-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2492--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2669--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sm-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-12005"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-3-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2492--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13005"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-3-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2669--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sm"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sm</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12006"></a>                                                       </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13006"></a>                                                       </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-4-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-4-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2493--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2670--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sp-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-12007"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-4-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2493--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13007"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-4-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2670--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12008"></a> <br 
+ id="dx1-13008"></a> <br 
 class="newline" />with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\renewcommand</span><span 
 class="cmsy-10">{</span><span 
@@ -4834,67 +5118,67 @@
 class="cmsy-10">}}</span> </p> </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-5-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-5-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2495--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2672--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-12009"></a>                    </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-5-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2495--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13009"></a>                    </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-5-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2672--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12010"></a>                                                            </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13010"></a>                                                            </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-6-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-6-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2496--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2673--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">sc-short-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-12011"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-6-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2496--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13011"></a>                </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-6-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2673--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12012"></a>                                                        </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13012"></a>                                                        </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-7-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-7-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2497--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2674--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">sm-short-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-12013"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-7-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2497--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13013"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-7-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2674--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12014"></a>                                                       </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13014"></a>                                                       </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-8-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-8-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2498--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2675--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12015"></a>             </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-8-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2498--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13015"></a>             </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-8-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2675--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12016"></a>                                                      </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13016"></a>                                                      </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-9-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-9-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2499--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2676--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sc-short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12017"></a>          </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-9-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2499--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13017"></a>          </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-9-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2676--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sc-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sc-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12018"></a>                                                  </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13018"></a>                                                  </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-10-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-10-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2500--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2677--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sm-short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12019"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-10-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2500--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13019"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-10-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2677--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sm-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sm-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12020"></a>                                                 </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13020"></a>                                                 </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-11-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-11-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2501--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2678--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sp-short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12021"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-11-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2501--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13021"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-11-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2678--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12022"></a> <br 
+ id="dx1-13022"></a> <br 
 class="newline" />with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\renewcommand</span><span 
 class="cmsy-10">{</span><span 
@@ -4908,109 +5192,109 @@
 class="cmsy-10">}}</span> </p> </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-12-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-12-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2503--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2680--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12023"></a>             </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-12-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2503--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13023"></a>             </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-12-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2680--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12024"></a>                                                      </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13024"></a>                                                      </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-13-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-13-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2504--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2681--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">sc-short-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12025"></a>          </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-13-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2504--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13025"></a>          </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-13-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2681--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12026"></a>                                                  </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13026"></a>                                                  </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-14-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-14-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2505--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2682--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">sm-short-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12027"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-14-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2505--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13027"></a>         </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-14-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2682--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12028"></a>                                                 </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13028"></a>                                                 </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-15-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-15-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2506--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2683--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">dua</span><a 
- id="dx1-12029"></a>                            </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-15-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2506--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13029"></a>                            </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-15-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2683--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12030"></a>                                                         </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13030"></a>                                                         </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-16-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-16-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2507--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2684--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">dua-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12031"></a>                     </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-16-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2507--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13031"></a>                     </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-16-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2684--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12032"></a>                                                   </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13032"></a>                                                   </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-17-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-17-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2508--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2685--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-12033"></a>                      </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-17-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2508--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13033"></a>                      </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-17-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2685--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12034"></a>                                                       </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13034"></a>                                                       </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-18-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-18-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2509--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2686--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12035"></a>                  </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-18-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2509--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13035"></a>                  </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-18-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2686--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12036"></a>                                                   </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13036"></a>                                                   </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-19-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-19-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2510--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2687--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-12037"></a>                 </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-19-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2510--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13037"></a>                 </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-19-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2687--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12038"></a>                                                  </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13038"></a>                                                  </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-20-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-20-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2511--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2688--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12039"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-20-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2511--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13039"></a>               </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-20-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2688--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12040"></a>                                                </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13040"></a>                                                </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-21-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-21-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2512--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2689--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sc-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12041"></a>            </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-21-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2512--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13041"></a>            </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-21-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2689--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-footnote-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-footnote-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12042"></a>                                             </p></td>
+ id="dx1-13042"></a>                                             </p></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-2-22-"><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-22-1"  
-class="td01"><!--l. 2513--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+class="td01"><!--l. 2690--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sm-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-12043"></a>           </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-22-2"  
-class="td10"><!--l. 2513--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+ id="dx1-13043"></a>           </p></td><td  style="white-space:wrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-2-22-2"  
+class="td10"><!--l. 2690--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-footnote-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-footnote-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12044"></a>                                            </p></td></tr></table></div>
+ id="dx1-13044"></a>                                            </p></td></tr></table></div>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
    </div><hr class="endfloat" />
    </div>
-<!--l. 2517--><p class="indent" >   The reason for introducing the new style of abbreviation commands provided by
+<!--l. 2694--><p class="indent" >   The reason for introducing the new style of abbreviation commands provided by
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>is because the original acronym commands provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>are
@@ -5019,80 +5303,80 @@
 However, if you really want to restore the generic acronym function provided by
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>you can use
-</p><!--l. 2524--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2701--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\RestoreAcronyms</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-12045"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-13045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2526--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2703--><p class="noindent" >
 (before any use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>).
-</p><!--l. 2529--><p class="indent" >   <span 
+</p><!--l. 2706--><p class="indent" >   <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms </span>should not be used in combination with the newer
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>abbreviations. Don’t combine old and new style entries with the same
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">type</span><a 
- id="dx1-12046"></a>. The original <span 
+ id="dx1-13046"></a>. The original <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>acronym mechanism doesn’t work well with the newer
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>commands.
-</p><!--l. 2535--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use <span 
+</p><!--l. 2712--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span>, don’t use any of the commands provided by
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>intended for abbreviations (such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-12047"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-13047"></a> or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-12048"></a>)
+ id="dx1-13048"></a>)
 with entries defined via <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-12049"></a> as it will cause unexpected results.
+ id="dx1-13049"></a> as it will cause unexpected results.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 2541--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2543--><p class="indent" >   In general, there’s rarely any need for <span 
+</p><!--l. 2718--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2720--><p class="indent" >   In general, there’s rarely any need for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span>. If you have a
 document that uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronymstyle</span><a 
- id="dx1-12050"></a>, then it’s best to either stick with just
+ id="dx1-13050"></a>, then it’s best to either stick with just
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>for that document or define an equivalent abbreviation style with
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviationstyle</span><a 
- id="dx1-12051"></a>. (See <a 
+ id="dx1-13051"></a>. (See <a 
 href="#sec:newabbrvstyle"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>3.5 </a><a 
 href="#sec:newabbrvstyle">Defining New Abbreviation Styles<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:newabbrvstyle --></a> for further
 details.)
-</p><!--l. 2550--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2727--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsacspace</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-12052"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-13052"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsacspace{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2552--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2729--><p class="noindent" >
 The space command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsacspace </span>used by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sp-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-12053"></a> acronym style provided
+ id="dx1-13053"></a> acronym style provided
 by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>is modified so that it uses
-</p><!--l. 2556--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2733--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsacspacemax</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-12054"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-13054"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsacspacemax </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2558--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2735--><p class="noindent" >
 instead of the hard-coded 3em. This is a command not a length and so can be
 changed using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\renewcommand</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2562--><p class="indent" >   Any of the new abbreviation styles that use <span 
+</p><!--l. 2739--><p class="indent" >   Any of the new abbreviation styles that use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep</span><a 
- id="dx1-12055"></a> (such as <a 
+ id="dx1-13055"></a> (such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-12056"></a>)
+ id="dx1-13056"></a>)
 can easily be changed to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsacspace </span>with
                                                                   
@@ -5099,49 +5383,49 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-84">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-94">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrfullsep}[1]{\glsacspace{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2567--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2569--><p class="indent" >   The <a 
- id="dx1-12057"></a><a 
+<!--l. 2744--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2746--><p class="indent" >   The <a 
+ id="dx1-13057"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> acronym font command
-</p><!--l. 2570--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition">  <span 
+</p><!--l. 2747--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition">  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\firstacronymfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2572--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2749--><p class="noindent" >
 is redefined to use the <a 
- id="dx1-12058"></a>first use abbreviation font command <span 
+ id="dx1-13058"></a>first use abbreviation font command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-12059"></a>.
+ id="dx1-13059"></a>.
 This will be reset if you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2577--><p class="indent" >   The subsequent use acronym font command
-</p><!--l. 2578--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition">  <span 
+</p><!--l. 2754--><p class="indent" >   The subsequent use acronym font command
+</p><!--l. 2755--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition">  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acronymfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2580--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2757--><p class="noindent" >
 is redefined to use the subsequent use abbreviation font command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-12060"></a>.
+ id="dx1-13060"></a>.
 This will be reset if you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span>.
 </p>
-<!--l. 2585--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.8   </span> <a 
- id="x1-130002.8"></a><span 
+<!--l. 2762--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.9   </span> <a 
+ id="x1-140002.9"></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-bookindex </span>package</h3>
-<!--l. 2588--><p class="noindent" >As from v1.21, <span 
+<!--l. 2765--><p class="noindent" >As from v1.21, <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>has a new supplementary package <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13001"></a>
+ id="dx1-14001"></a>
 which provides the glossary style <span 
 class="cmss-10">bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13002"></a>. This is very similar to the <span 
+ id="dx1-14002"></a>. This is very similar to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">mcolindexgroup</span><a 
- id="dx1-13003"></a>
+ id="dx1-14003"></a>
 style but is designed for indexes, so by default only the name and location list
 are displayed. You can either load this package explicitly and then set the
 style:
@@ -5149,46 +5433,46 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-85">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-95">
 \usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossary-bookindex}
 &#x00A0;<br />\setglossarystyle{bookindex}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2598--><p class="nopar" > or use both the <a 
+<!--l. 2775--><p class="nopar" > or use both the <a 
 href="#styopt.stylemods"><span 
 class="cmss-10">stylemods</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-13004"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-14004"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">style</span><a 
- id="dx1-13005"></a> options:
+ id="dx1-14005"></a> options:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-86">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-96">
 \usepackage[stylemods=bookindex,style=bookindex]{glossaries-extra}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2602--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
+<!--l. 2779--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
 class="cmss-10">bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13006"></a> style only supports a maximum hierarchical level of 2 (top-level,
+ id="dx1-14006"></a> style only supports a maximum hierarchical level of 2 (top-level,
 level&#x00A0;1 and level&#x00A0;2).
-</p><!--l. 2606--><p class="indent" >   The number of columns is given by
-</p><!--l. 2607--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2783--><p class="indent" >   The number of columns is given by
+</p><!--l. 2784--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexcols</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13007"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14007"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexcols </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2609--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2786--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to 2.
-</p><!--l. 2612--><p class="indent" >   This style uses the <span 
+</p><!--l. 2789--><p class="indent" >   This style uses the <span 
 class="cmss-10">multicols</span><a 
- id="dx1-13008"></a><a 
- id="dx1-13009"></a> environment. If the command
-</p><!--l. 2614--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-14008"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14009"></a> environment. If the command
+</p><!--l. 2791--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexcolspread</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13010"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14010"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexcolspread </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2616--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2793--><p class="noindent" >
 isn’t empty then it’s supplied as the optional argument following <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\begin{multicols}</span></span></span>
 <span 
@@ -5196,35 +5480,35 @@
 class="cmti-10">n</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>. You can switch from <span 
 class="cmss-10">multicols</span><a 
- id="dx1-13011"></a><a 
- id="dx1-13012"></a> to <span 
+ id="dx1-14011"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14012"></a> to <span 
 class="cmss-10">multicols*</span><a 
- id="dx1-13013"></a><a 
- id="dx1-13014"></a> by redefining
-</p><!--l. 2620--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-14013"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14014"></a> by redefining
+</p><!--l. 2797--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13015"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14015"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2622--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2799--><p class="noindent" >
 For example
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-87">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-97">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrbookindexmulticolsenv}{multicols*}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2626--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2628--><p class="indent" >   Each top-level entry is displayed using
-</p><!--l. 2629--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 2803--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 2805--><p class="indent" >   Each top-level entry is displayed using
+</p><!--l. 2806--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13016"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14016"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2631--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2808--><p class="noindent" >
 where the entry is identified by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;. This just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5235,39 +5519,39 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-88">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-98">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrbookindexname}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glossentryname{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\ifglshassymbol{#1}{\space&#x00A0;(\glossentrysymbol{#1})}{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2640--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively you can use the <span 
+<!--l. 2817--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively you can use the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostname</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category</span>&#x27E9; hook.
-</p><!--l. 2644--><p class="indent" >   Sub-entries are displayed using
-</p><!--l. 2645--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2821--><p class="indent" >   Sub-entries are displayed using
+</p><!--l. 2822--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13017"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14017"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2647--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2824--><p class="noindent" >
 which just defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2650--><p class="indent" >   The separator used before the location list for top-level entries is given
+</p><!--l. 2827--><p class="indent" >   The separator used before the location list for top-level entries is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 2652--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2829--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13018"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14018"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexprelocation{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2654--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2831--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label. This checks if the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">location </span>field has been set. If it
@@ -5276,60 +5560,60 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-89">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-99">
 ,\glsxtrprelocation
 </div>
-<!--l. 2660--><p class="nopar" > otherwise it just does <span 
+<!--l. 2837--><p class="nopar" > otherwise it just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrprelocation </span>(which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\space</span>). If you’re not
 using <a 
- id="dx1-13019"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14019"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-13020"></a></a>, the <span 
+ id="dx1-14020"></a></a>, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">location</span><a 
- id="dx1-13021"></a> field won’t be set.
-</p><!--l. 2665--><p class="indent" >   The separator used before the location list for sub-entries is given by
-</p><!--l. 2667--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-14021"></a> field won’t be set.
+</p><!--l. 2842--><p class="indent" >   The separator used before the location list for sub-entries is given by
+</p><!--l. 2844--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13022"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14022"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubprelocation{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2669--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2846--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexprelocation{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2672--><p class="indent" >   The separator used between a top-level parent and child entry is given
+</p><!--l. 2849--><p class="indent" >   The separator used between a top-level parent and child entry is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 2674--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2851--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13023"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14023"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2676--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2853--><p class="noindent" >
 This defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\nopagebreak</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2679--><p class="indent" >   The separator used between a sub-level parent and child entry is given
+</p><!--l. 2856--><p class="indent" >   The separator used between a sub-level parent and child entry is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 2681--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2858--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexparentsubchildsep</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13024"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexparentsubchildsep</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2683--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2860--><p class="noindent" >
 This defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexparentchildsep</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2686--><p class="indent" >   The separator between top-level entries is given by
-</p><!--l. 2687--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2863--><p class="indent" >   The separator between top-level entries is given by
+</p><!--l. 2864--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexbetween</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13025"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14025"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexbetween{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label1</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5336,7 +5620,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">label2</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2689--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2866--><p class="noindent" >
 This comes after the entry given by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label1</span>&#x27E9;, if the entry has no children, or after the
 last descendent otherwise, so it always comes immediately before the entry given by
@@ -5343,11 +5627,11 @@
 &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label2</span>&#x27E9; unless the entry occurs at the start of a group. This does nothing by
 default.
-</p><!--l. 2696--><p class="indent" >   The separator between two level&#x00A0;1 entries is given by
-</p><!--l. 2697--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2873--><p class="indent" >   The separator between two level&#x00A0;1 entries is given by
+</p><!--l. 2874--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubbetween</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13026"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14026"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubbetween{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label1</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5354,12 +5638,12 @@
 class="cmitt-10">label2</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2699--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2701--><p class="indent" >   The separator between two level&#x00A0;2 entries is given by
-</p><!--l. 2702--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2876--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2878--><p class="indent" >   The separator between two level&#x00A0;2 entries is given by
+</p><!--l. 2879--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubsubbetween</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubsubbetween{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label1</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -5367,12 +5651,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label2</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2704--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2881--><p class="noindent" >
 At the end of each letter group, the following hooks are done in order:
-</p><!--l. 2707--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2884--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13028"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14028"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5381,36 +5665,36 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 2709--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2710--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2886--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2887--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14029"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubatendgroup{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">sub-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2712--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2713--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2889--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2890--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexatendgroup</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexatendgroup{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2715--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2892--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">sub-sub-label</span>&#x27E9; is the label of the last level&#x00A0;2 entry, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">sub-label</span>&#x27E9; is the label of the
 last level&#x00A0;1 entry and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the label of the last level&#x00A0;0 entry.
-</p><!--l. 2721--><p class="indent" >   For example, the resource option <span 
+</p><!--l. 2898--><p class="indent" >   For example, the resource option <span 
 class="cmtt-10">seealso=omit </span>instructs <a 
- id="dx1-13031"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14031"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-13032"></a></a> to omit the
+ id="dx1-14032"></a></a> to omit the
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">seealso </span>cross-reference from the location list. (The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">see </span>cross-reference will still be
@@ -5422,7 +5706,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-90">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-100">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrbookindexatendgroup}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrifhasfield{seealso}{#1}{\glstreesubitem\glsxtruseseealso{#1}}{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
@@ -5443,7 +5727,7 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrbookindexsubsubatendgroup{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2751--><p class="nopar" > This uses <span 
+<!--l. 2928--><p class="nopar" > This uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreesubitem </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreesubsubitem </span>to indent the cross-reference
 according to the next level down, so the cross-reference for a top-level entry is aligned
@@ -5451,22 +5735,22 @@
 sub-sub-entries. In the event that a level&#x00A0;2 entry has a cross-reference, this is
 indented a bit further (but it won’t be aligned with any deeper level as the <span 
 class="cmss-10">bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13033"></a>
+ id="dx1-14033"></a>
 style only supports a maximum of two sub-levels).
-</p><!--l. 2762--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 2939--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13034"></a> style uses group headings. (If you use <a 
- id="dx1-13035"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-14034"></a> style uses group headings. (If you use <a 
+ id="dx1-14035"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-13036"></a></a> remember to invoke
+ id="dx1-14036"></a></a> remember to invoke
 it with the <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">--group</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">-g</span></span></span> switch.) The heading will use
-</p><!--l. 2765--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2942--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexbookmark</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexbookmark{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">group title</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5473,7 +5757,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2767--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2944--><p class="noindent" >
 If <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\pdfbookmark </span>has been defined, this will use that command to bookmark the
 group title. If <a 
@@ -5480,16 +5764,16 @@
 href="#styopt.section"><span 
 class="cmss-10">section</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=chapter</span><a 
- id="dx1-13038"></a> is set (default if chapters are defined) then this
+ id="dx1-14038"></a> is set (default if chapters are defined) then this
 uses level&#x00A0;1 otherwise it uses level&#x00A0;2. You can redefine this command if this
 isn’t appropriate. If <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\pdfbookmark </span>hasn’t been defined, this command does
 nothin.
-</p><!--l. 2775--><p class="indent" >   The group heading is formatted according to
-</p><!--l. 2776--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2952--><p class="indent" >   The group heading is formatted according to
+</p><!--l. 2953--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexformatheader</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13039"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14039"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexformatheader{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">group title</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -5497,81 +5781,81 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 2778--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2955--><p class="noindent" >
 which is defined as
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-91">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-101">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrbookindexformatheader}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\par{\centering\glstreegroupheaderfmt{#1}\par}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2784--><p class="nopar" > where <span 
+<!--l. 2961--><p class="nopar" > where <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreegroupheaderfmt </span>is provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-tree</span><a 
- id="dx1-13040"></a> package, which is
+ id="dx1-14040"></a> package, which is
 automatically loaded. Note that the entry names aren’t encapsulated with
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreenamefmt</span>.
-</p><!--l. 2790--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 2967--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-bookindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-13041"></a> package provides some supplementary commands that
+ id="dx1-14041"></a> package provides some supplementary commands that
 aren’t used by default, but may be used when adjusting the style. These commands
 should only be used within one of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\print</span><span 
 class="cmtt-10">&#x2026;glossary </span>commands. (That is, they
 should only be used in glossary styles.)
-</p><!--l. 2795--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2972--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexmarkentry</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13042"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14042"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexmarkentry{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2797--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2974--><p class="noindent" >
 This writes information to the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">.aux </span>file that can be read on the next run to obtain
 the first and last entry on each page of the glossary.
-</p><!--l. 2802--><p class="indent" >   You can display the first entry associated with the current page using:
-</p><!--l. 2804--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2979--><p class="indent" >   You can display the first entry associated with the current page using:
+</p><!--l. 2981--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexfirstmark</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13043"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14043"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexfirstmark </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2806--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2983--><p class="noindent" >
 and the last entry associated with the current page using:
-</p><!--l. 2809--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2986--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexlastmark</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13044"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14044"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexlastmark </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2811--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2988--><p class="noindent" >
 These do nothing if there are no entries marked on the current page (or if the
 document build isn’t up to date).
-</p><!--l. 2815--><p class="indent" >   The entry is formatted using:
-</p><!--l. 2816--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2992--><p class="indent" >   The entry is formatted using:
+</p><!--l. 2993--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexfirstmarkfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13045"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexfirstmarkfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2818--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2995--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first instance and
-</p><!--l. 2820--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 2997--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrbookindexlastmarkfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-13046"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-14046"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexlastmarkfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2822--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 2999--><p class="noindent" >
 for the last.
-</p><!--l. 2825--><p class="indent" >   These commands are designed for use in page headers or footers where the page
+</p><!--l. 3002--><p class="indent" >   These commands are designed for use in page headers or footers where the page
 number is stable. For example, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexname </span>can be redefined to mark the
 current entry:
@@ -5579,13 +5863,13 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-92">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-102">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrbookindexname}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrbookindexmarkentry{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glossentryname{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2833--><p class="nopar" > If you only want to mark the top-level entries, remember to redefine
+<!--l. 3010--><p class="nopar" > If you only want to mark the top-level entries, remember to redefine
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexsubname </span>as it defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrbookindexname</span>:
@@ -5593,21 +5877,21 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-93">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-103">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrbookindexsubname}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glossentryname{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2841--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2843--><p class="indent" >   Then if you’re using <span 
+<!--l. 3018--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 3020--><p class="indent" >   Then if you’re using <span 
 class="cmss-10">fancyhdr</span><a 
- id="dx1-13047"></a> you can set the page style to show the first and last
+ id="dx1-14047"></a> you can set the page style to show the first and last
 entry for the current page with:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-94">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-104">
 &#x00A0;&#x00A0;\pagestyle{fancy}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\lhead{\thepage}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\lfoot{\glsxtrbookindexfirstmark}%
@@ -5614,30 +5898,30 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\cfoot{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\rfoot{\glsxtrbookindexlastmark}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 2851--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 2853--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 3028--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 3030--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 2853--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.9   </span> <a 
+<!--l. 3030--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.10   </span> <a 
  id="sec:glosstylemods"></a>Glossary Style Modifications</h3>
-<!--l. 2856--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+<!--l. 3033--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods</span><a 
- id="dx1-14001"></a> package (more conveniently loaded through the
+ id="dx1-15001"></a> package (more conveniently loaded through the
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span><a 
 href="#styopt.stylemods"><span 
 class="cmss-10">stylemods</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-14002"></a> option) modifies some of the predefined styles that are
+ id="dx1-15002"></a> option) modifies some of the predefined styles that are
 provided with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package. These modifications are described in more detail
 in <a 
-href="#x1-170002.9.3"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.9.3 </a><a 
-href="#x1-170002.9.3">The <span 
+href="#x1-180002.10.3"><span 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.10.3 </a><a 
+href="#x1-180002.10.3">The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods </span>Package<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:stylemods --></a>.
-</p><!--l. 2863--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3040--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-14003"></a> package tries to determine the group title from its label by first
+ id="dx1-15003"></a> package tries to determine the group title from its label by first
 checking if <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -5644,42 +5928,42 @@
 class="cmtt-10">groupname </span>exists. If it doesn’t exist, then the title is assumed to be
 the same as the label. For example, when typesetting the “A” letter group, <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-14004"></a>
+ id="dx1-15004"></a>
 first checks if <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Agroupname </span>exists. This could potentially cause conflict with another
 package that may have some other meaning for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Agroupname</span>, so <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span><a 
- id="dx1-14005"></a> first
+ id="dx1-15005"></a> first
 checks for the existence of the internal command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtr at grouptitle@</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;
 which shouldn’t clash with another package. You can set the group title
 using
-</p><!--l. 2875--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3052--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsetgrouptitle</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-14006"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-15006"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsetgrouptitle{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">title</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2877--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3054--><p class="noindent" >
 For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-95">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-105">
 \glsxtrsetgrouptitle{A}{A&#x00A0;(a)}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2881--><p class="nopar" > This uses a global assignment. If you need to scope the change you can
+<!--l. 3058--><p class="nopar" > This uses a global assignment. If you need to scope the change you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 2884--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3061--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlocalsetgrouptitle</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-14007"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-15007"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlocalsetgrouptitle{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5686,60 +5970,60 @@
 class="cmitt-10">title</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2886--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2888--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3063--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3065--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 2888--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.9.1   </span> <a 
+<!--l. 3065--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.10.1   </span> <a 
  id="sec:stylehooks"></a>Style Hooks</h4>
-<!--l. 2891--><p class="noindent" >The commands <span 
+<!--l. 3068--><p class="noindent" >The commands <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-15001"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-16001"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentrydesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-15002"></a> are modified to take into
+ id="dx1-16002"></a> are modified to take into
 account the <a 
 href="#catattr.glossname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15003"></a>, <a 
+ id="dx1-16003"></a>, <a 
 href="#catattr.glossdesc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossdesc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15004"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-16004"></a> and <a 
 href="#catattr.glossdescfont"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossdescfont</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15005"></a> attributes (see <a 
+ id="dx1-16005"></a> attributes (see <a 
 href="#sec:categories"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a>). This
 means you can make simple case-changing modifications to the name and description
 without defining a new glossary style.
-</p><!--l. 2897--><p class="indent" >   If you want to adapt a style to use another field instead of <span 
+</p><!--l. 3074--><p class="indent" >   If you want to adapt a style to use another field instead of <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-15006"></a>, you can
+ id="dx1-16006"></a>, you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 2899--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3076--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glossentrynameother</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-15007"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-16007"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentrynameother{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">field</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2901--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3078--><p class="noindent" >
 This behaves just like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname </span>(that is, it obeys <a 
 href="#catattr.glossname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15008"></a>, <a 
+ id="dx1-16008"></a>, <a 
 href="#catattr.glossnamefont"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossnamefont</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15009"></a> or
+ id="dx1-16009"></a> or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsnamefont </span>and uses the post-name hook) but it uses the given &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9; instead of
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-15010"></a>. The &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-16010"></a>. The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field</span>&#x27E9; argument must be the internal field name (for example <span 
 class="cmtt-10">desc </span>rather
 than <span 
@@ -5746,28 +6030,28 @@
 class="cmtt-10">description</span>). See the key to field mappings table in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>user
 manual.
-</p><!--l. 2910--><p class="indent" >   There is a hook after <span 
+</p><!--l. 3087--><p class="indent" >   There is a hook after <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-15011"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-16011"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-15012"></a>:
-</p><!--l. 2912--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-16012"></a>:
+</p><!--l. 3089--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostnamehook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-15013"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-16013"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostnamehook{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2914--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3091--><p class="noindent" >
 By default this checks the <a 
 href="#catattr.indexname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15014"></a> attribute. If the attribute exists for the
+ id="dx1-16014"></a> attribute. If the attribute exists for the
 category to which the label belongs, then the name is automatically indexed
 using
-</p><!--l. 2919--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3096--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdoautoindexname</span><a 
- id="dx1-15015"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-16015"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span><span 
@@ -5774,18 +6058,18 @@
 class="cmsy-10">{</span><span 
 class="cmtt-10">indexname</span><span 
 class="cmsy-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2920--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3097--><p class="noindent" >
 See <a 
 href="#sec:autoindex"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:autoindex">Auto-Indexing<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:autoindex --></a> for further details.
-</p><!--l. 2924--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.04, the post-name hook <span 
+</p><!--l. 3101--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.04, the post-name hook <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostnamehook </span>will also use
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostname</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9; if it exists. You can use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glscurrententrylabel</span><a 
- id="dx1-15016"></a> to
+ id="dx1-16016"></a> to
 obtain the entry label with the definition of this command. For example,
 suppose you are using a glossary style the doesn’t display the symbol, you can
 insert the symbol after the name for a particular category, say, the “symbol”
@@ -5794,39 +6078,39 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-96">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-106">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrpostnamesymbol}{\space
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;(\glsentrysymbol{\glscurrententrylabel})}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2935--><p class="nopar" > As from version 1.25, the post-name hook also does
-</p><!--l. 2937--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 3112--><p class="nopar" > As from version 1.25, the post-name hook also does
+</p><!--l. 3114--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsextrapostnamehook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-15017"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-16017"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsextrapostnamehook{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2939--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3116--><p class="noindent" >
 (before <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostname</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;) to allow for additional non-category related code.
 This does nothing by default.
-</p><!--l. 2944--><p class="indent" >   The post-description code used within the glossary is modified so that it also
+</p><!--l. 3121--><p class="indent" >   The post-description code used within the glossary is modified so that it also
 does
-</p><!--l. 2946--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3123--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrpostdescription</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-15018"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-16018"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostdescription </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2948--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3125--><p class="noindent" >
 This occurs before the original <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription</span>, so if the <a 
 href="#styopt.nopostdot"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nopostdot</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=false</span><a 
- id="dx1-15019"></a>
+ id="dx1-16019"></a>
 option is used, it will be inserted before the terminating full stop.
-</p><!--l. 2953--><p class="indent" >   This new command will do <span 
+</p><!--l. 3130--><p class="indent" >   This new command will do <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostdesc</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category</span>&#x27E9; if it exists, where
 &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5834,39 +6118,39 @@
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostdescgeneral </span>for entries with the category set to <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-15020"></a> or
+ id="dx1-16020"></a> or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostdescacronym </span>for entries with the category set to <span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-15021"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 2960--><p class="indent" >   Since both <span 
+ id="dx1-16021"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 3137--><p class="indent" >   Since both <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentry </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\subglossentry </span>set
-</p><!--l. 2961--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3138--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glscurrententrylabel</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-15022"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-16022"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glscurrententrylabel </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2963--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3140--><p class="noindent" >
 to the label for the current entry, you can use this within the definition of these
 post-description hooks if you need to reference the label.
-</p><!--l. 2968--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose you want to insert the plural form in brackets after the
+</p><!--l. 3145--><p class="indent" >   For example, suppose you want to insert the plural form in brackets after the
 description in the glossary, but only for entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-15023"></a> category, then you could
+ id="dx1-16023"></a> category, then you could
 do:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-97">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-107">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrpostdescgeneral}{\space
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;(plural:&#x00A0;\glsentryplural{\glscurrententrylabel})}
 </div>
-<!--l. 2974--><p class="nopar" > This means you don’t have to define a custom glossary style, which you may find
+<!--l. 3151--><p class="nopar" > This means you don’t have to define a custom glossary style, which you may find
 more complicated. (It also allows more flexibility if you decide to change the
 underlying glossary style.)
-</p><!--l. 2979--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> This feature can’t be used for glossary styles that ignore <span 
+</p><!--l. 3156--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> This feature can’t be used for glossary styles that ignore <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription </span>or if
 you redefine <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription </span>without including <span 
@@ -5876,68 +6160,68 @@
 the <a 
 href="#styopt.nopostdot"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nopostdot</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-15024"></a> option to suppress the terminating full stop.) See <a 
-href="#x1-170002.9.3"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.9.3 </a><a 
-href="#x1-170002.9.3">The
+ id="dx1-16024"></a> option to suppress the terminating full stop.) See <a 
+href="#x1-180002.10.3"><span 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.10.3 </a><a 
+href="#x1-180002.10.3">The
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods </span>Package<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:stylemods --></a> to patch the predefined styles provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>
 that are missing <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription</span>. </div>
-</p><!--l. 2988--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 2990--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3165--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3167--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 2990--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.9.2   </span> <a 
+<!--l. 3167--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.10.2   </span> <a 
  id="sec:glosstylenumlist"></a>Number List</h4>
-<!--l. 2993--><p class="noindent" >The <a 
- id="dx1-16001"></a><a 
+<!--l. 3170--><p class="noindent" >The <a 
+ id="dx1-17001"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> is now placed inside the argument of
-</p><!--l. 2994--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3171--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrFormatLocationList</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-16002"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-17002"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrFormatLocationList{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">number list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 2996--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3173--><p class="noindent" >
 This is internally used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossaryentrynumbers</span>. The <a 
 href="#styopt.nonumberlist"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nonumberlist</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-16003"></a> option
+ id="dx1-17003"></a> option
 redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossaryentrynumbers </span>so that it doesn’t display the <a 
- id="dx1-16004"></a>number list, but it
+ id="dx1-17004"></a>number list, but it
 still saves the <a 
- id="dx1-16005"></a>number list in case it’s required.
-</p><!--l. 3002--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to suppress the <a 
- id="dx1-16006"></a>number list always use the <a 
+ id="dx1-17005"></a>number list in case it’s required.
+</p><!--l. 3179--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to suppress the <a 
+ id="dx1-17006"></a>number list always use the <a 
 href="#styopt.nonumberlist"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nonumberlist</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-16007"></a> option
+ id="dx1-17007"></a> option
 instead of redefining <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossaryentrynumbers </span>to do nothing. </div>
-</p><!--l. 3006--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3008--><p class="indent" >   If you want to, for example, change the font for the entire <a 
- id="dx1-16008"></a>number list
+</p><!--l. 3183--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3185--><p class="indent" >   If you want to, for example, change the font for the entire <a 
+ id="dx1-17008"></a>number list
 then redefine <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrFormatLocationList </span>as appropriate. Don’t modify
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossaryentrynumbers</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3012--><p class="indent" >   Sometimes users like to insert “page” or “pages” in front of the <a 
- id="dx1-16009"></a>number list. This
+</p><!--l. 3189--><p class="indent" >   Sometimes users like to insert “page” or “pages” in front of the <a 
+ id="dx1-17009"></a>number list. This
 is quite fiddly to do with the base <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package, but <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>provides a
 way of doing this. First you need to enable this option and specify the text to display
 using:
-</p><!--l. 3017--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3194--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-16010"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-17010"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">page</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -5944,10 +6228,10 @@
 class="cmitt-10">pages</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3019--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3196--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">page</span>&#x27E9; is the text to display if the <a 
- id="dx1-16011"></a>number list only contains a single location and
+ id="dx1-17011"></a>number list only contains a single location and
 &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">pages</span>&#x27E9; is the text to display otherwise. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -5954,34 +6238,34 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-98">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-108">
 \GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag{Page:&#x00A0;}{Pages:&#x00A0;}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3025--><p class="nopar" > An extra run is required when using this command.
-</p><!--l. 3028--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Use <span 
+<!--l. 3202--><p class="nopar" > An extra run is required when using this command.
+</p><!--l. 3205--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">glsignore </span>not <span 
 class="cmtt-10">@gobble </span>as the format if you want to suppress the page
 number (and only index the entry once). </div>
-</p><!--l. 3031--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3033--><p class="indent" >   See the accompanying sample file <span 
+</p><!--l. 3208--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3210--><p class="indent" >   See the accompanying sample file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-pages.tex</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3035--><p class="indent" >   Note that <a 
- id="dx1-16012"></a><a 
+</p><!--l. 3212--><p class="indent" >   Note that <a 
+ id="dx1-17012"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-16013"></a></a> can be instructed to insert a prefix at the start of non-empty
+ id="dx1-17013"></a></a> can be instructed to insert a prefix at the start of non-empty
 location lists, which can be used as an alternative to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnablePreLocationTag</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3039--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3216--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 3039--><p class="noindent" ><a 
-href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.9.3   </span> <a 
- id="x1-170002.9.3"></a>The <span 
+<!--l. 3216--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">2.10.3   </span> <a 
+ id="x1-180002.10.3"></a>The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods </span>Package</h4>
-<!--l. 3042--><p class="noindent" >As from v1.02, <span 
+<!--l. 3219--><p class="noindent" >As from v1.02, <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>now includes the package <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods</span><a 
- id="dx1-17001"></a> that
+ id="dx1-18001"></a> that
 will redefine the predefined styles to include the post-description hook (for those that
 are missing it). You will need to make sure the styles have already been defined
 before loading <span 
@@ -5990,12 +6274,12 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-99">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-109">
 \usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossary-longragged}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra-stylemods}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3051--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively you can load <span 
+<!--l. 3228--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively you can load <span 
 class="cmtt-10">glossary-</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">.sty </span>at the same time by passing &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6002,59 +6286,59 @@
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;
 as a package option to <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods</span><a 
- id="dx1-17002"></a>. For example:
+ id="dx1-18002"></a>. For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-100">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-110">
 \usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[longragged]{glossaries-extra-stylemods}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3059--><p class="nopar" > Another option is to use the <a 
+<!--l. 3236--><p class="nopar" > Another option is to use the <a 
 href="#styopt.stylemods"><span 
 class="cmss-10">stylemods</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-17003"></a> key when you load <span 
+ id="dx1-18003"></a> key when you load <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>. You can
 omit a value if you only want to use the predefined styles that are automatically
 loaded by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>(for example, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">long3col</span><a 
- id="dx1-17004"></a> style):
+ id="dx1-18004"></a> style):
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-101">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-111">
 \usepackage[style=long3col,stylemods]{glossaries-extra}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3066--><p class="nopar" > Or the value of <a 
+<!--l. 3243--><p class="nopar" > Or the value of <a 
 href="#styopt.stylemods"><span 
 class="cmss-10">stylemods</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-17005"></a> may be a comma-separated list of the style package
+ id="dx1-18005"></a> may be a comma-separated list of the style package
 identifiers. For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-102">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-112">
 \usepackage[style=mcoltree,stylemods=mcols]{glossaries-extra}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3071--><p class="nopar" > Remember to group the value if it contains any commas:
+<!--l. 3248--><p class="nopar" > Remember to group the value if it contains any commas:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-103">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-113">
 \usepackage[stylemods={mcols,longbooktabs}]{glossaries-extra}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3075--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 3077--><p class="indent" >   Note that the <span 
+<!--l. 3252--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 3254--><p class="indent" >   Note that the <span 
 class="cmss-10">inline</span><a 
- id="dx1-17006"></a> style is dealt with slightly differently. The original definition
+ id="dx1-18006"></a> style is dealt with slightly differently. The original definition
 provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-inline</span><a 
- id="dx1-17007"></a> package uses <span 
+ id="dx1-18007"></a> package uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription </span>at the end of the
 glossary (not after each entry description) within the definition of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostinline</span>.
@@ -6069,23 +6353,23 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glspostdescription</span>). This means that the
 modified <span 
 class="cmss-10">inline</span><a 
- id="dx1-17008"></a> style isn’t affected by the <a 
+ id="dx1-18008"></a> style isn’t affected by the <a 
 href="#styopt.nopostdot"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nopostdot</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-17009"></a> option, but the post-description
+ id="dx1-18009"></a> option, but the post-description
 category hook can still be used.
-</p><!--l. 3091--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3268--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">tabular</span><a 
- id="dx1-17010"></a><a 
- id="dx1-17011"></a>-like styles, such as <span 
+ id="dx1-18010"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-18011"></a>-like styles, such as <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-17012"></a> are adjusted so that the <span 
+ id="dx1-18012"></a> are adjusted so that the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsnogroupskip</span><a 
- id="dx1-17013"></a>
+ id="dx1-18013"></a>
 conditional (set with <a 
 href="#styopt.nogroupskip"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nogroupskip</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-17014"></a>) is moved outside of the definition of
+ id="dx1-18014"></a>) is moved outside of the definition of
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgroupskip </span>to avoid problems that cause an “Incomplete <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\iftrue</span>” error with
@@ -6095,23 +6379,23 @@
 change this conditional using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\setupglossaries </span>or using the <span 
 class="cmss-10">nogroupskip</span><a 
- id="dx1-17015"></a> option in
+ id="dx1-18015"></a> option in
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printglossary</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printnoidxglossary </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\printunsrtglossary</span>, you must also
 reset the glossary style.
-</p><!--l. 3102--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.21, the hard-coded <span 
+</p><!--l. 3279--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.21, the hard-coded <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\space </span>before the <a 
- id="dx1-17016"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-18016"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> in many of
 the predefined styles is replaced with
-</p><!--l. 3105--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3282--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17017"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18017"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrprelocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3107--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3284--><p class="noindent" >
 This just defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\space </span>but may be redefined as required. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -6118,122 +6402,122 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-104">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-114">
 \renewcommand{\glsxtrprelocation}{\dotfill}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3112--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 3114--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+<!--l. 3289--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 3291--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">list</span><a 
- id="dx1-17018"></a> styles use
-</p><!--l. 3115--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-18018"></a> styles use
+</p><!--l. 3292--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslistprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17019"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18019"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslistprelocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3117--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3294--><p class="noindent" >
 (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrprelocation</span>) for top-level items and
-</p><!--l. 3119--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3296--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslistchildprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17020"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18020"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslistchildprelocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3121--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3298--><p class="noindent" >
 (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslistprelocation</span>) for child items.
-</p><!--l. 3124--><p class="indent" >   For just the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3301--><p class="indent" >   For just the <span 
 class="cmss-10">list</span><a 
- id="dx1-17021"></a> style and its letter group variations (not the <span 
+ id="dx1-18021"></a> style and its letter group variations (not the <span 
 class="cmss-10">altlist</span><a 
- id="dx1-17022"></a> or <span 
+ id="dx1-18022"></a> or <span 
 class="cmss-10">listdotted</span><a 
- id="dx1-17023"></a>
+ id="dx1-18023"></a>
 variations) the <a 
- id="dx1-17024"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-18024"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> for child entries is followed by
-</p><!--l. 3127--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3304--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslistchildpostlocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17025"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18025"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslistchildpostlocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3129--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3306--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to a full stop.
-</p><!--l. 3132--><p class="indent" >   The default value of <span 
+</p><!--l. 3309--><p class="indent" >   The default value of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslistdottedwidth</span><a 
- id="dx1-17026"></a> is changed so that it’s set at the start
+ id="dx1-18026"></a> is changed so that it’s set at the start
 of the document (if it hasn’t been changed in the preamble). This should
 take into account situations where <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\hsize </span>isn’t set until the start of the
 document.
-</p><!--l. 3137--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3314--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">index</span><a 
- id="dx1-17027"></a>-like and <span 
+ id="dx1-18027"></a>-like and <span 
 class="cmss-10">tree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17028"></a>-like styles insert the pre-<a 
- id="dx1-17029"></a>number list space with
-</p><!--l. 3139--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-18028"></a>-like styles insert the pre-<a 
+ id="dx1-18029"></a>number list space with
+</p><!--l. 3316--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glstreeprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreeprelocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3141--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3318--><p class="noindent" >
 (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrprelocation</span>) for top-level items and
-</p><!--l. 3143--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3320--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glstreechildprelocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17031"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreechildprelocation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3145--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3322--><p class="noindent" >
 (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstreeprelocation</span>) for child items.
-</p><!--l. 3149--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.05, the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3326--><p class="indent" >   As from version 1.05, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra-stylemods </span>package provides some
 additional commands for use with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">alttree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17032"></a> style to make it easier to modify. These
+ id="dx1-18032"></a> style to make it easier to modify. These
 commands are only defined if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-tree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17033"></a> package has already been loaded,
+ id="dx1-18033"></a> package has already been loaded,
 which is typically the case unless the <a 
 href="#styopt.notree"><span 
 class="cmss-10">notree</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-17034"></a> option has been used when loading
+ id="dx1-18034"></a> option has been used when loading
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3157--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3334--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\gglssetwidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17035"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18035"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gglssetwidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3159--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3336--><p class="noindent" >
 (New to version 1.21.) This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetwidest </span>(provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-tree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17036"></a>) but
+ id="dx1-18036"></a>) but
 performs a global assignment.
-</p><!--l. 3164--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3341--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\eglssetwidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\eglssetwidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3166--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3343--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetwidest </span>but performs a protected expansion on &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;. This has a
 localised effect. For a global setting, use
-</p><!--l. 3170--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3347--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\xglssetwidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17038"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18038"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\xglssetwidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6242,173 +6526,173 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 3172--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3349--><p class="noindent" >
 The following only set the value if &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; is wider than the current value (new to
 version 1.23). Local update:
-</p><!--l. 3175--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3352--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsupdatewidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17039"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18039"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsupdatewidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3177--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3354--><p class="noindent" >
 Global update:
-</p><!--l. 3179--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3356--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\gglsupdatewidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17040"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18040"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gglsupdatewidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3181--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3358--><p class="noindent" >
 Locale update (expands &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;):
-</p><!--l. 3183--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3360--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\eglsupdatewidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17041"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18041"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\eglsupdatewidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3185--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3362--><p class="noindent" >
 Global update (expands &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;):
-</p><!--l. 3187--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3364--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\xglsupdatewidest</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17042"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18042"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\xglsupdatewidest[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3189--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3192--><p class="indent" >   The widest entry value can later be retrieved using
-</p><!--l. 3193--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3366--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3369--><p class="indent" >   The widest entry value can later be retrieved using
+</p><!--l. 3370--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsgetwidestname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17043"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18043"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgetwidestname </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3195--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3372--><p class="noindent" >
 for the top-level entries and
-</p><!--l. 3197--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3374--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsgetwidestsubname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17044"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18044"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgetwidestsubname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">level</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3199--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3376--><p class="noindent" >
 for sub-entries, where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">level</span>&#x27E9; is the level number.
-</p><!--l. 3202--><p class="indent" >   Note that if you are using <a 
- id="dx1-17045"></a><a 
+</p><!--l. 3379--><p class="indent" >   Note that if you are using <a 
+ id="dx1-18045"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-17046"></a></a>, you can use the resource option <span 
+ id="dx1-18046"></a></a>, you can use the resource option <span 
 class="cmtt-10">set-widest</span>
 which will try to determine the widest name of all the selected entries. This isn’t
 guaranteed to work as it may depend on fonts or commands that <a 
- id="dx1-17047"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-18047"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-17048"></a>
+ id="dx1-18048"></a>
 can’t replicate, but it should be suitable for names that just consist of text,
 and can be more efficient than iterating over all the defined entries using
 <span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3210--><p class="indent" >   The command <span 
+</p><!--l. 3387--><p class="indent" >   The command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfindwidesttoplevelname </span>provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossary-tree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17049"></a> has a
+ id="dx1-18049"></a> has a
 CamelCase synonym:
-</p><!--l. 3212--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3389--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestTopLevelName</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17050"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18050"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestTopLevelName[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3214--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3391--><p class="noindent" >
 Similar commands are also provided:
-</p><!--l. 3216--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3393--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17051"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18051"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary</span>
 <span 
 class="cmitt-10">list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3218--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3395--><p class="noindent" >
 This has an additional check that the entry has been used. Naturally this is only
 useful if the glossaries that use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">alttree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17052"></a> style occur at the end of the document.
+ id="dx1-18052"></a> style occur at the end of the document.
 This command should be placed just before the start of the glossary. (Alternatively,
 place it at the end of the document and save the value in the auxiliary file for the
 next run.)
-</p><!--l. 3226--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3403--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyName</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17053"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18053"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyName[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3228--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3405--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but if doesn’t check the <span 
 class="cmss-10">parent</span><a 
- id="dx1-17054"></a> key. This is useful if
+ id="dx1-18054"></a> key. This is useful if
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 all levels should have the same width for the name.
-</p><!--l. 3233--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3410--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestAnyName</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17055"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18055"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestAnyName[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3235--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3412--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but doesn’t check if the entry has been
 used.
-</p><!--l. 3239--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3416--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedLevelTwo</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17056"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18056"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedLevelTwo[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3241--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3418--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedTopLevelName </span>but also sets the first two sub-levels
 as well. Any entry that has a great-grandparent is ignored.
-</p><!--l. 3246--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3423--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestLevelTwo</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17057"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18057"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestLevelTwo[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3248--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3425--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but doesn’t check if the entry has been
 used.
-</p><!--l. 3252--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3429--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17058"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18058"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6416,15 +6700,15 @@
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3255--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3432--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyName </span>but also measures the symbol. The length
 of the widest symbol is stored in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">register</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 3260--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3437--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbol</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17059"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18059"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbol[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary</span>
 <span 
@@ -6432,13 +6716,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3262--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3439--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but it doesn’t check if the entry has been
 used.
-</p><!--l. 3266--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3443--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17060"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18060"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6448,24 +6732,24 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">location register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3269--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3446--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbol </span>but also measures the <a 
- id="dx1-17061"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-18061"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a>.
 This requires <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrynumberlist</span><a 
- id="dx1-17062"></a> (see the <span 
+ id="dx1-18062"></a> (see the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>user manual). The length of
 the widest symbol is stored in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">symbol register</span>&#x27E9; and the length of the widest <a 
- id="dx1-17063"></a>number
+ id="dx1-18063"></a>number
 list is stored in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">location register</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 3277--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3454--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbolLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17064"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18064"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestAnyNameSymbolLocation</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6475,13 +6759,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">location register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3280--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3457--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but it doesn’t check if the entry has been
 used.
-</p><!--l. 3284--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3461--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17065"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18065"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameLocation</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6489,16 +6773,16 @@
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3287--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3464--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestUsedAnyNameSymbolLocation </span>but doesn’t measure the
 symbol. The length of the widest <a 
- id="dx1-17066"></a>number list is stored in &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-18066"></a>number list is stored in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">register</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 3292--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3469--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsFindWidestAnyNameLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17067"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18067"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsFindWidestAnyNameLocation[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary</span>
 <span 
@@ -6506,19 +6790,19 @@
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">register</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3295--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3472--><p class="noindent" >
 This is like the previous command but doesn’t check if the entry has been
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 used.
-</p><!--l. 3299--><p class="indent" >   The layout of the symbol, description and <a 
- id="dx1-17068"></a><a 
+</p><!--l. 3476--><p class="indent" >   The layout of the symbol, description and <a 
+ id="dx1-18068"></a><a 
 href="#glo:numberlist">number list</a> is governed by
-</p><!--l. 3301--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3478--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtralttreeSymbolDescLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17069"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18069"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtralttreeSymbolDescLocation</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6526,12 +6810,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">number list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3303--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3480--><p class="noindent" >
 for top-level entries and
-</p><!--l. 3305--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3482--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtralttreeSubSymbolDescLocation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17070"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18070"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtralttreeSubSymbolDescLocation</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6539,29 +6823,29 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">number list</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3307--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3484--><p class="noindent" >
 for sub-entries.
-</p><!--l. 3310--><p class="indent" >   There is now a user level command that performs the initialisation for the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3487--><p class="indent" >   There is now a user level command that performs the initialisation for the <span 
 class="cmss-10">alttree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17071"></a>
+ id="dx1-18071"></a>
 style:
-</p><!--l. 3312--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3489--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtralttreeInit</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17072"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18072"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtralttreeInit </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3314--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3316--><p class="indent" >   The paragraph indent for subsequent paragraphs in multi-paragraph descriptions
+</p><!--l. 3491--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3493--><p class="indent" >   The paragraph indent for subsequent paragraphs in multi-paragraph descriptions
 is provided by the length
-</p><!--l. 3318--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3495--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrAltTreeIndent</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-17073"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-18073"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrAltTreeIndent </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3320--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3322--><p class="indent" >   For additional commands that are available with the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3497--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3499--><p class="indent" >   For additional commands that are available with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">alttree</span><a 
- id="dx1-17074"></a> style, see the
+ id="dx1-18074"></a> style, see the
 documented code (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">glossaries-extra-code.pdf</span>). For examples, see the
 accompanying sample files <span 
@@ -6573,11 +6857,11 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 3329--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 3329--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 3506--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 3506--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">3. <a 
  id="sec:abbreviations"></a>Abbreviations</h2>
-</p><!--l. 3332--><p class="indent" >   Abbreviations include acronyms (words formed from initial letters, such as
+</p><!--l. 3509--><p class="indent" >   Abbreviations include acronyms (words formed from initial letters, such as
 “laser”), initialisms (initial letters of a phrase, such as “html”, that aren’t
 pronounced as words) and contractions (where parts of words are omitted, often
 replaced by an apostrophe, such as “don’t”). The “acronym” code provided by the
@@ -6585,19 +6869,19 @@
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package is misnamed as it’s more often than not used for initialisms instead.
 Acronyms tend not to be <span 
 class="cmti-10">expanded </span>on <a 
- id="dx1-18001"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-19001"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> (although they may need
 to be <span 
 class="cmti-10">described </span>for readers unfamiliar with the term). They are therefore
 more like a regular term, which may or may not require a description in the
 glossary.
-</p><!--l. 3344--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3521--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package corrects this misnomer, and provides better
 abbreviation handling, with
-</p><!--l. 3346--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3523--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\newabbreviation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-18002"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-19002"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6608,10 +6892,10 @@
 class="cmitt-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3348--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3350--><p class="indent" >   This sets the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3525--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3527--><p class="indent" >   This sets the <span 
 class="cmss-10">category</span><a 
- id="dx1-18003"></a> key to <span 
+ id="dx1-19003"></a> key to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">abbreviation </span>by default, but that value may be
 overridden in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">options</span>&#x27E9;. The category may have attributes that modify the way
@@ -6618,52 +6902,52 @@
 abbreviations are defined. For example, the <a 
 href="#catattr.insertdots"><span 
 class="cmss-10">insertdots</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18004"></a> attribute will automatically
+ id="dx1-19004"></a> attribute will automatically
 insert full stops (periods) into &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; or the <a 
 href="#catattr.noshortplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">noshortplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18005"></a> attribute will set the default
+ id="dx1-19005"></a> attribute will set the default
 value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-18006"></a> key to just &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-19006"></a> key to just &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (without appending the plural suffix). See <a 
 href="#sec:categories"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5
 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a> for further details.
-</p><!--l. 3360--><p class="indent" >   See <a 
+</p><!--l. 3537--><p class="indent" >   See <a 
 href="#sec:nested"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.6 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:nested">Nested Links<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:nested --></a> regarding the pitfalls of using commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-18007"></a> or
+ id="dx1-19007"></a> or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-18008"></a> within &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-19008"></a> within &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; or &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 3364--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Make sure that you set the category attributes before defining new abbreviations
+</p><!--l. 3541--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Make sure that you set the category attributes before defining new abbreviations
 or they may not be correctly applied. </div>
-</p><!--l. 3367--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3369--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3544--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3546--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-18009"></a> command provided by the <span 
+ id="dx1-19009"></a> command provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package is redefined by
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">category</span><a 
- id="dx1-18010"></a> set to <span 
+ id="dx1-19010"></a> set to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">acronym </span>(see also
 <a 
 href="#sec:acronymmods"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.7 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.8 </a><a 
 href="#sec:acronymmods">Acronym Style Modifications<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:acronymmods --></a>) so
-</p><!--l. 3373--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3550--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\newacronym</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-18011"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-19011"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6673,7 +6957,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3375--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3552--><p class="noindent" >
 is
 now
 equivalent
@@ -6699,7 +6983,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 <br /><spacer type=vertical size=10></span>
-</p><!--l. 3382--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 3559--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>command is superficially similar to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>
 package’s <span 
@@ -6707,55 +6991,55 @@
 default style is <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18012"></a> for entries in the <span 
+ id="dx1-19012"></a> for entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-18013"></a> category and <a 
+ id="dx1-19013"></a> category and <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18014"></a> for
+ id="dx1-19014"></a> for
 entries in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-18015"></a> category. (These aren’t the same as the acronym
+ id="dx1-19015"></a> category. (These aren’t the same as the acronym
 styles provided by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package, although they may produce similar
 results.)
-</p><!--l. 3392--><p class="indent" >   The way the abbreviations are displayed by commands like <span 
+</p><!--l. 3569--><p class="indent" >   The way the abbreviations are displayed by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>varies according
 to the abbreviation style. The styles are set according to the entry’s category so,
 unlike the base <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package, you can have different abbreviation styles within
 the same glossary.
-</p><!--l. 3398--><p class="indent" >   There are two types of full forms. The display full form, which is used on
+</p><!--l. 3575--><p class="indent" >   There are two types of full forms. The display full form, which is used on
 <a 
- id="dx1-18016"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-19016"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-18017"></a> and the inline full form, which is used by
+ id="dx1-19017"></a> and the inline full form, which is used by
 commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-18018"></a>. For some of the abbreviation styles, such as
+ id="dx1-19018"></a>. For some of the abbreviation styles, such as
 <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18019"></a>, the display and inline forms are the same. In the case of styles
+ id="dx1-19019"></a>, the display and inline forms are the same. In the case of styles
 such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18020"></a> or <a 
+ id="dx1-19020"></a> or <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-18021"></a>, the display and inline full forms are
+ id="dx1-19021"></a>, the display and inline full forms are
 different.
-</p><!--l. 3405--><p class="indent" >   These formatting commands aren’t stored in the <span 
+</p><!--l. 3582--><p class="indent" >   These formatting commands aren’t stored in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-18022"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-19022"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-18023"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-19023"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-18024"></a> or
+ id="dx1-19024"></a> or
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">longplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-18025"></a> fields, which means they won’t be used within commands like
+ id="dx1-19025"></a> fields, which means they won’t be used within commands like
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort </span>(but they are used within commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>and
@@ -6762,45 +7046,45 @@
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtshort</span>). Note that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-18026"></a> and the case-changing variants don’t use
+ id="dx1-19026"></a> and the case-changing variants don’t use
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3413--><p class="indent" >   You can apply the formatting command used for the short form to some arbitrary
+</p><!--l. 3590--><p class="indent" >   You can apply the formatting command used for the short form to some arbitrary
 text using
-</p><!--l. 3415--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3592--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsuseabbrvfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-18027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-19027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsuseabbrvfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3417--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3594--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9; is the category label that identifies the abbreviation style. Similarly
 for the formatting command use by the long form:
-</p><!--l. 3421--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3598--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsuselongfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-18028"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-19028"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsuselongfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3423--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3600--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 3425--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 3602--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.1   </span> <a 
  id="sec:tagging"></a>Tagging Initials</h3>
-<!--l. 3428--><p class="noindent" >If you would like to tag the initial letters in the long form such that those letters are
+<!--l. 3605--><p class="noindent" >If you would like to tag the initial letters in the long form such that those letters are
 underlined in the glossary but not in the main part of the document, you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 3431--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3608--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-19001"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-20001"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">categories</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -6808,9 +7092,9 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">cs</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3433--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3610--><p class="noindent" >
 before you define your abbreviations.
-</p><!--l. 3436--><p class="indent" >   This command (robustly) defines &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 3613--><p class="indent" >   This command (robustly) defines &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">cs</span>&#x27E9; (a control sequence) to accept a single
 argument, which is the letter (or letters) that needs to be tagged. The normal
 behaviour of this command within the document is to simply do its argument, but in
@@ -6820,23 +7104,23 @@
 the glossary it’s activated for those categories that have the <a 
 href="#catattr.tagging"><span 
 class="cmss-10">tagging</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-19002"></a> attribute set to
+ id="dx1-20002"></a> attribute set to
 “true”. For those cases it will use
-</p><!--l. 3443--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3620--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrtagfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-19003"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-20003"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrtagfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3445--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3622--><p class="noindent" >
 This command defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\underline</span><a 
- id="dx1-19004"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-20004"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>but may be redefined as required.
-</p><!--l. 3449--><p class="indent" >   The control sequence &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 3626--><p class="indent" >   The control sequence &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">cs</span>&#x27E9; can’t already be defined when used with the unstarred
 version of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging </span>for safety reasons. The starred
@@ -6845,32 +7129,32 @@
 commands, ensure that you don’t redefine something important. In fact, just
 forget the existence of the starred version and let’s pretend I didn’t mention
 it.
-</p><!--l. 3458--><p class="indent" >   The first argument of <span 
+</p><!--l. 3635--><p class="indent" >   The first argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging </span>is a comma-separated list
 of category names. The <a 
 href="#catattr.tagging"><span 
 class="cmss-10">tagging</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-19005"></a> attribute will automatically be set for those
+ id="dx1-20005"></a> attribute will automatically be set for those
 categories. You can later set this attribute for other categories (see <a 
 href="#sec:categories"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a>) but
 this must be done before the glossary is displayed.
-</p><!--l. 3465--><p class="indent" >   The accompanying sample file <span 
+</p><!--l. 3642--><p class="indent" >   The accompanying sample file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-mixtures.tex </span>uses initial tagging for both
 the <span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-19006"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-20006"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-19007"></a> categories:
+ id="dx1-20007"></a> categories:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-105">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-115">
 \GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging{acronym,abbreviation}{\itag}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3470--><p class="nopar" > This defines the command <span 
+<!--l. 3647--><p class="nopar" > This defines the command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\itag </span>which can be used in the definitions. For
 example:
                                                                   
@@ -6877,7 +7161,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-106">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-116">
 \newacronym
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;[description={a&#x00A0;system&#x00A0;for&#x00A0;detecting&#x00A0;the&#x00A0;location&#x00A0;and
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;speed&#x00A0;of&#x00A0;ships,&#x00A0;aircraft,&#x00A0;etc,&#x00A0;through&#x00A0;the&#x00A0;use&#x00A0;of&#x00A0;radio
@@ -6889,21 +7173,21 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{xml}{XML}
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{e\itag{x}tensible&#x00A0;\itag{m}arkup&#x00A0;\itag{l}anguage}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3485--><p class="nopar" > The underlining of the tagged letters only occurs in the glossary and then only for
+<!--l. 3662--><p class="nopar" > The underlining of the tagged letters only occurs in the glossary and then only for
 entries with the <a 
 href="#catattr.tagging"><span 
 class="cmss-10">tagging</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-19008"></a> attribute set.
-</p><!--l. 3490--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="dx1-20008"></a> attribute set.
+</p><!--l. 3667--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 3490--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 3667--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.2   </span> <a 
  id="sec:abbrstyle"></a>Abbreviation Styles</h3>
-<!--l. 3493--><p class="noindent" >The abbreviation style must be set before abbreviations are defined using:
-</p><!--l. 3495--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 3670--><p class="noindent" >The abbreviation style must be set before abbreviations are defined using:
+</p><!--l. 3672--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\setabbreviationstyle</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20001"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21001"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\setabbreviationstyle[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6910,7 +7194,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">style-name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3497--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3674--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">style-name</span>&#x27E9; is the name of the style and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9; is the category label
@@ -6923,22 +7207,22 @@
 example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-20002"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-21002"></a> and <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-20003"></a> styles set the <a 
+ id="dx1-21003"></a> styles set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-20004"></a> attribute to
+ id="dx1-21004"></a> attribute to
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3508--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to apply different styles to groups of abbreviations, assign a
+</p><!--l. 3685--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to apply different styles to groups of abbreviations, assign a
 different category to each group and set the style for the given category.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 3512--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3514--><p class="indent" >   Note that <span 
+</p><!--l. 3689--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3691--><p class="indent" >   Note that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\setacronymstyle</span><a 
- id="dx1-20005"></a> is disabled by <span 
+ id="dx1-21005"></a> is disabled by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>. Use </p><div class="alltt">
 <div class="obeylines-v">
 <span 
@@ -6951,26 +7235,26 @@
 </div>
 </div> instead. The original acronym interface can be restored with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span><a 
- id="dx1-20006"></a> (see
+ id="dx1-21006"></a> (see
 <a 
 href="#sec:acronymmods"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.7 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.8 </a><a 
 href="#sec:acronymmods">Acronym Style Modifications<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:acronymmods --></a>). However the original acronym interface is
 incompatible with all the commands described here.
-<!--l. 3524--><p class="indent" >   Abbreviations can be used with the standard <span 
+<!--l. 3701--><p class="indent" >   Abbreviations can be used with the standard <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-20007"></a>,
+ id="dx1-21007"></a>,
 but don’t use the acronym commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-20008"></a> (which use <span 
+ id="dx1-21008"></a> (which use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acronymfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-20009"></a>).
+ id="dx1-21009"></a>).
 The short form can be produced with:
-</p><!--l. 3528--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3705--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20010"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21010"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6978,15 +7262,15 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3530--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3707--><p class="noindent" >
 (Use this instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-20011"></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 3533--><p class="indent" >   The long form can be produced with
-</p><!--l. 3534--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-21011"></a>.)
+</p><!--l. 3710--><p class="indent" >   The long form can be produced with
+</p><!--l. 3711--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20012"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21012"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -6994,16 +7278,16 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3536--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3713--><p class="noindent" >
 (Use this instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-20013"></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 3539--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+ id="dx1-21013"></a>.)
+</p><!--l. 3716--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmti-10">inline </span>full form can be produced with
-</p><!--l. 3540--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3717--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfull</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20014"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21014"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7011,48 +7295,48 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3542--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3719--><p class="noindent" >
 (This this instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-20015"></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 3545--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> In general, it’s best not to use commands like <span 
+ id="dx1-21015"></a>.)
+</p><!--l. 3722--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> In general, it’s best not to use commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirst</span><a 
- id="dx1-20016"></a> for abbreviations,
+ id="dx1-21016"></a> for abbreviations,
 especially if you use the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; optional argument. Use either <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>(possibly with a
 reset) or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span>. </div>
-</p><!--l. 3550--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3552--><p class="indent" >   As mentioned earlier, the inline full form may not necessarily match the format
+</p><!--l. 3727--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3729--><p class="indent" >   As mentioned earlier, the inline full form may not necessarily match the format
 used on <a 
- id="dx1-20017"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-21017"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>. For example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-20018"></a> style only displays the
+ id="dx1-21018"></a> style only displays the
 short form on <a 
- id="dx1-20019"></a>first use, but the full form will display the long form followed by the
+ id="dx1-21019"></a>first use, but the full form will display the long form followed by the
 short form in parentheses.
-</p><!--l. 3559--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to use an abbreviation in a chapter or section title, use the
+</p><!--l. 3736--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you want to use an abbreviation in a chapter or section title, use the
 commands described in <a 
 href="#sec:headtitle"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>4 </a><a 
 href="#sec:headtitle">Entries in Sectioning Titles, Headers, Captions and
 Contents<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:headtitle --></a> instead. </div>
-</p><!--l. 3563--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3565--><p class="indent" >   The arguments &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 3740--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3742--><p class="indent" >   The arguments &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">options</span>&#x27E9;, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; are the same as for commands such as
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>. There are also analogous case-changing commands:
-</p><!--l. 3569--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case short form:
-</p><!--l. 3570--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3746--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case short form:
+</p><!--l. 3747--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20020"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21020"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrshort[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7060,12 +7344,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3572--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3574--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case long form:
-</p><!--l. 3575--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3749--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3751--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case long form:
+</p><!--l. 3752--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20021"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21021"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrlong[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7073,12 +7357,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3577--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3579--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case inline full form:
-</p><!--l. 3580--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3754--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3756--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case inline full form:
+</p><!--l. 3757--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrfull</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20022"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21022"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfull[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7086,15 +7370,15 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3582--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3584--><p class="indent" >   All upper case short form:
+</p><!--l. 3759--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3761--><p class="indent" >   All upper case short form:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 3585--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3762--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20023"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21023"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrshort[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7102,12 +7386,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3587--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3589--><p class="indent" >   All upper case long form:
-</p><!--l. 3590--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3764--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3766--><p class="indent" >   All upper case long form:
+</p><!--l. 3767--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20024"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrlong[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7115,12 +7399,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3592--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3594--><p class="indent" >   All upper case inline full form:
-</p><!--l. 3595--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3769--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3771--><p class="indent" >   All upper case inline full form:
+</p><!--l. 3772--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GLSxtrfull</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20025"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21025"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfull[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7128,13 +7412,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3597--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3599--><p class="indent" >   Plural forms are also available.
-</p><!--l. 3601--><p class="indent" >   Short form plurals:
-</p><!--l. 3602--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3774--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3776--><p class="indent" >   Plural forms are also available.
+</p><!--l. 3778--><p class="indent" >   Short form plurals:
+</p><!--l. 3779--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20026"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21026"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7142,11 +7426,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3604--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3605--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3781--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3782--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrshortpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrshortpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7154,11 +7438,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3607--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3608--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3784--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3785--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GLSxtrshortpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20028"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21028"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrshortpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7166,12 +7450,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3610--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3612--><p class="indent" >   Long form plurals:
-</p><!--l. 3613--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3787--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3789--><p class="indent" >   Long form plurals:
+</p><!--l. 3790--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21029"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7179,11 +7463,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3615--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3616--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3792--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3793--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrlongpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrlongpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7191,11 +7475,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3618--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3619--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3795--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3796--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GLSxtrlongpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20031"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrlongpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7203,12 +7487,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3621--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3623--><p class="indent" >   Full form plurals:
-</p><!--l. 3624--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3798--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3800--><p class="indent" >   Full form plurals:
+</p><!--l. 3801--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfullpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20032"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21032"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7216,11 +7500,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3626--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3627--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3803--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3804--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrfullpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfullpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7228,11 +7512,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3629--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3630--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3806--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3807--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GLSxtrfullpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-20034"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-21034"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfullpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -7240,8 +7524,8 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3632--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3634--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Be careful about using <span 
+</p><!--l. 3809--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3811--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Be careful about using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfull</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsentryfull</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfullpl </span>and
@@ -7250,32 +7534,32 @@
 than the style in use when the entry was defined. If you have mixed styles,
 you’ll need to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-20035"></a> instead. Similarly for <span 
+ id="dx1-21035"></a> instead. Similarly for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort </span>etc.
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 3640--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3642--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3817--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3819--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 3642--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 3819--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.3   </span> <a 
  id="sec:abbrshortcuts"></a>Shortcut Commands</h3>
-<!--l. 3645--><p class="noindent" >The abbreviation shortcut commands can be enabled using the package option
+<!--l. 3822--><p class="noindent" >The abbreviation shortcut commands can be enabled using the package option
 <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-21001"></a> (or <a 
+ id="dx1-22001"></a> (or <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=abbr</span><a 
- id="dx1-21002"></a>) or <a 
+ id="dx1-22002"></a>) or <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-21003"></a>. (You can use
+ id="dx1-22003"></a>. (You can use
 both settings at the same time.) The provided shortcut commands listed in
 <a 
 href="#tab:abbrshortcuts">table&#x00A0;3.1</a>.
@@ -7284,7 +7568,7 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-<!--l. 3652--><p class="indent" >   <a 
+<!--l. 3829--><p class="indent" >   <a 
  id="tab:abbrshortcuts"></a></p><hr class="float" /><div class="float" 
 >
                                                                   
@@ -7292,7 +7576,7 @@
                                                                   
  <div class="caption" 
 ><span class="id">Table&#x00A0;3.1: </span><span  
-class="content">Abbreviation Shortcut Commands</span></div><!--tex4ht:label?: x1-210041 -->
+class="content">Abbreviation Shortcut Commands</span></div><!--tex4ht:label?: x1-220041 -->
 <div class="tabular"> <table id="TBL-3" class="tabular" 
 cellspacing="0" cellpadding="0"  
 ><colgroup id="TBL-3-1g"><col 
@@ -7313,7 +7597,7 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">=abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-21005"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-22005"></a><span 
 class="cmbx-10">)</span></td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-2-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmbx-10">(</span><a 
@@ -7320,415 +7604,415 @@
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-21006"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-22006"></a><span 
 class="cmbx-10">)</span></td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-3-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-3-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ab</span><a 
- id="dx1-21007"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-3-2"  
+ id="dx1-22007"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-3-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-21008"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-3-3"  
+ id="dx1-22008"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-3-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-21009"></a>                </td>
+ id="dx1-22009"></a>                </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-4-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-4-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21010"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-4-2"  
+ id="dx1-22010"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-4-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21011"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-4-3"  
+ id="dx1-22011"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-4-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglspl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21012"></a>              </td>
+ id="dx1-22012"></a>              </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-5-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-5-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\as</span><a 
- id="dx1-21013"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-5-2"  
+ id="dx1-22013"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-5-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acs</span><a 
- id="dx1-21014"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-5-3"  
+ id="dx1-22014"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-5-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-21015"></a>         </td>
+ id="dx1-22015"></a>         </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-6-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-6-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\asp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21016"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-6-2"  
+ id="dx1-22016"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-6-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acsp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21017"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-6-3"  
+ id="dx1-22017"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-6-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21018"></a>       </td>
+ id="dx1-22018"></a>       </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-7-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-7-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\al</span><a 
- id="dx1-21019"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-7-2"  
+ id="dx1-22019"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-7-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21020"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-7-3"  
+ id="dx1-22020"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-7-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-21021"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22021"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-8-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-8-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\alp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21022"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-8-2"  
+ id="dx1-22022"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-8-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\aclp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21023"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-8-3"  
+ id="dx1-22023"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-8-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21024"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22024"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-9-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-9-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\af</span><a 
- id="dx1-21025"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-9-2"  
+ id="dx1-22025"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-9-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acf</span><a 
- id="dx1-21026"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-9-3"  
+ id="dx1-22026"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-9-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-21027"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22027"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-10-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-10-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\afp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21028"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-10-2"  
+ id="dx1-22028"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-10-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\acfp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21029"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-10-3"  
+ id="dx1-22029"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-10-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21030"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22030"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-11-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Ab</span><a 
- id="dx1-21031"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-2"  
+ id="dx1-22031"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-21032"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-3"  
+ id="dx1-22032"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-11-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-21033"></a>                </td>
+ id="dx1-22033"></a>                </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-12-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-12-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Abp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21034"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-12-2"  
+ id="dx1-22034"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-12-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21035"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-12-3"  
+ id="dx1-22035"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-12-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglspl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21036"></a>              </td>
+ id="dx1-22036"></a>              </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-13-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-13-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\As</span><a 
- id="dx1-21037"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-13-2"  
+ id="dx1-22037"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-13-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acs</span><a 
- id="dx1-21038"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-13-3"  
+ id="dx1-22038"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-13-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-21039"></a>         </td>
+ id="dx1-22039"></a>         </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-14-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-14-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Asp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21040"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-14-2"  
+ id="dx1-22040"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-14-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acsp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21041"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-14-3"  
+ id="dx1-22041"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-14-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrshortpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21042"></a>       </td>
+ id="dx1-22042"></a>       </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-15-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-15-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Al</span><a 
- id="dx1-21043"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-15-2"  
+ id="dx1-22043"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-15-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21044"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-15-3"  
+ id="dx1-22044"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-15-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-21045"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22045"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-16-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-16-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Alp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21046"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-16-2"  
+ id="dx1-22046"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-16-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Aclp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21047"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-16-3"  
+ id="dx1-22047"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-16-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrlongpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21048"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22048"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-17-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-17-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Af</span><a 
- id="dx1-21049"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-17-2"  
+ id="dx1-22049"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-17-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acf</span><a 
- id="dx1-21050"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-17-3"  
+ id="dx1-22050"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-17-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-21051"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22051"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-18-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-18-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Afp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21052"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-18-2"  
+ id="dx1-22052"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-18-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Acfp</span><a 
- id="dx1-21053"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-18-3"  
+ id="dx1-22053"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-18-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21054"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22054"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-19-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-19-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AB</span><a 
- id="dx1-21055"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-19-2"  
+ id="dx1-22055"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-19-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AC</span><a 
- id="dx1-21056"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-19-3"  
+ id="dx1-22056"></a>          </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-19-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLS</span><a 
- id="dx1-21057"></a>                </td>
+ id="dx1-22057"></a>                </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-20-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-20-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ABP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21058"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-20-2"  
+ id="dx1-22058"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-20-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21059"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-20-3"  
+ id="dx1-22059"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-20-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLSpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21060"></a>              </td>
+ id="dx1-22060"></a>              </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-21-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-21-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AS</span><a 
- id="dx1-21061"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-21-2"  
+ id="dx1-22061"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-21-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACS</span><a 
- id="dx1-21062"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-21-3"  
+ id="dx1-22062"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-21-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-21063"></a>         </td>
+ id="dx1-22063"></a>         </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-22-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-22-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ASP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21064"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-22-2"  
+ id="dx1-22064"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-22-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACSP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21065"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-22-3"  
+ id="dx1-22065"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-22-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrshortpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21066"></a>       </td>
+ id="dx1-22066"></a>       </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-23-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-23-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AL</span><a 
- id="dx1-21067"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-23-2"  
+ id="dx1-22067"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-23-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACL</span><a 
- id="dx1-21068"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-23-3"  
+ id="dx1-22068"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-23-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-21069"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22069"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-24-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-24-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ALP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21070"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-24-2"  
+ id="dx1-22070"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-24-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACLP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21071"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-24-3"  
+ id="dx1-22071"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-24-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrlongpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21072"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22072"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-25-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-25-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AF</span><a 
- id="dx1-21073"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-25-2"  
+ id="dx1-22073"></a>                   </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-25-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACF</span><a 
- id="dx1-21074"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-25-3"  
+ id="dx1-22074"></a>         </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-25-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-21075"></a>          </td>
+ id="dx1-22075"></a>          </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-26-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-26-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\AFP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21076"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-26-2"  
+ id="dx1-22076"></a>                  </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-26-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ACFP</span><a 
- id="dx1-21077"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-26-3"  
+ id="dx1-22077"></a>        </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-26-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-21078"></a>        </td>
+ id="dx1-22078"></a>        </td>
 </tr><tr  
  style="vertical-align:baseline;" id="TBL-3-27-"><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-27-1"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbr</span><a 
- id="dx1-21079"></a>              </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-27-2"  
+ id="dx1-22079"></a>              </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-27-2"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbr</span><a 
- id="dx1-21080"></a>     </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-27-3"  
+ id="dx1-22080"></a>     </td><td  style="white-space:nowrap; text-align:left;" id="TBL-3-27-3"  
 class="td11"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-21081"></a>     </td></tr></table></div>
+ id="dx1-22081"></a>     </td></tr></table></div>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
    </div><hr class="endfloat" />
    </div>
-<!--l. 3690--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 3867--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.4   </span> <a 
  id="sec:predefabbrvstyles"></a>Predefined Abbreviation Styles</h3>
-<!--l. 3693--><p class="noindent" >There are two types of abbreviation styles: those that treat the abbreviation as a
+<!--l. 3870--><p class="noindent" >There are two types of abbreviation styles: those that treat the abbreviation as a
 regular entry (so that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22001"></a> uses <span 
+ id="dx1-23001"></a> uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgenentryfmt</span><a 
- id="dx1-22002"></a>) and those that don’t treat the
+ id="dx1-23002"></a>) and those that don’t treat the
 abbreviation as a regular entry (so that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22003"></a> uses <span 
+ id="dx1-23003"></a> uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrgenabbrvfmt</span><a 
- id="dx1-22004"></a>).
-</p><!--l. 3698--><p class="indent" >   The regular entry abbreviation styles set the <a 
+ id="dx1-23004"></a>).
+</p><!--l. 3875--><p class="indent" >   The regular entry abbreviation styles set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22005"></a> attribute to “true” for the
+ id="dx1-23005"></a> attribute to “true” for the
 category assigned to each abbreviation with that style. This means that on <a 
- id="dx1-22006"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-23006"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>,
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22007"></a> uses the value of the <span 
+ id="dx1-23007"></a> uses the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-22008"></a> field and on subsequent use <span 
+ id="dx1-23008"></a> field and on subsequent use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22009"></a> uses the value of the
+ id="dx1-23009"></a> uses the value of the
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-22010"></a> field (and analogously for the plural and case-changing versions). The <span 
+ id="dx1-23010"></a> field (and analogously for the plural and case-changing versions). The <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-22011"></a> and
+ id="dx1-23011"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-22012"></a> fields are set as appropriate and may be accessed through commands like
+ id="dx1-23012"></a> fields are set as appropriate and may be accessed through commands like
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-22013"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 3707--><p class="indent" >   The other abbreviation styles don’t modify the <a 
+ id="dx1-23013"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 3884--><p class="indent" >   The other abbreviation styles don’t modify the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22014"></a> attribute. The <span 
+ id="dx1-23014"></a> attribute. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-22015"></a>
+ id="dx1-23015"></a>
 and <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-22016"></a> fields (and their plural forms) are set and can be accessed through
+ id="dx1-23016"></a> fields (and their plural forms) are set and can be accessed through
 commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirst</span>, but they aren’t used by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22017"></a>, which
+ id="dx1-23017"></a>, which
 instead use the short form (stored in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-22018"></a> key) and the display full
+ id="dx1-23018"></a> key) and the display full
 format (through commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullformat</span><a 
- id="dx1-22019"></a> that are defined by the
+ id="dx1-23019"></a> that are defined by the
 style).
-</p><!--l. 3715--><p class="indent" >   In both cases, the <a 
- id="dx1-22020"></a>first use of <span 
+</p><!--l. 3892--><p class="indent" >   In both cases, the <a 
+ id="dx1-23020"></a>first use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-22021"></a> may not match the text produced by
+ id="dx1-23021"></a> may not match the text produced by
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirst</span><a 
- id="dx1-22022"></a> (and likewise for the plural and case-changing versions).
-</p><!--l. 3719--><p class="indent" >   The sample file <span 
+ id="dx1-23022"></a> (and likewise for the plural and case-changing versions).
+</p><!--l. 3896--><p class="indent" >   The sample file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-abbr-styles.tex </span>demonstrates all predefined styles
 described here.
-</p><!--l. 3722--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> For the “sc” styles that use <span 
+</p><!--l. 3899--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> For the “sc” styles that use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span><a 
- id="dx1-22023"></a>, be careful about your choice of fonts as
+ id="dx1-23023"></a>, be careful about your choice of fonts as
 some only have limited support. For example, you may not be able to combine bold
 and small-caps. I recommend that you at least use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">fontenc</span><a 
- id="dx1-22024"></a> package with the <span 
+ id="dx1-23024"></a> package with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">T1</span>
 option or something similar. </div>
-</p><!--l. 3728--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 3730--><p class="indent" >   The parenthetical styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 3905--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3907--><p class="indent" >   The parenthetical styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22025"></a>, use
-</p><!--l. 3732--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-23025"></a>, use
+</p><!--l. 3909--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrparen</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22026"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23026"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrparen{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3734--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3911--><p class="noindent" >
 to set the parenthetical material. This just puts parentheses around the text:
 (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9;).
-</p><!--l. 3738--><p class="indent" >   The basic abbreviation styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 3915--><p class="indent" >   The basic abbreviation styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22027"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-23027"></a> and <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22028"></a> use
-</p><!--l. 3740--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-23028"></a> use
+</p><!--l. 3917--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvdefaultfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23029"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3742--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3919--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short form. This just does &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; by default. (That is, no font change is
 applied.) On first use,
-</p><!--l. 3745--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3922--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3747--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3924--><p class="noindent" >
 is used instead. By default, this just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvdefaultfont</span>. The long form is
 formatted according to
-</p><!--l. 3750--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3927--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongdefaultfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22031"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
@@ -7735,57 +8019,57 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 3752--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3929--><p class="noindent" >
 which again just does &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; (no font change). On first use,
-</p><!--l. 3754--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3931--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlongdefaultfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22032"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23032"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3756--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3933--><p class="noindent" >
 is used instead. This just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongdefaultfont</span>. The plural suffix used for the
 short form is given by
-</p><!--l. 3759--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3936--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3761--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3938--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix</span><a 
- id="dx1-22034"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 3764--><p class="indent" >   The small-cap styles, such as <a 
+ id="dx1-23034"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 3941--><p class="indent" >   The small-cap styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22035"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-23035"></a> and <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22036"></a>, use
-</p><!--l. 3766--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-23036"></a>, use
+</p><!--l. 3943--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvscfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3768--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3945--><p class="noindent" >
 which uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span>.<span class="footnote-mark"><a 
 href="#fn1x3" id="fn1x3-bk"><sup class="textsuperscript">3.1</sup></a></span><a 
- id="x1-22038f1"></a>
+ id="x1-23038f1"></a>
 On first use
-</p><!--l. 3774--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3951--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvdefaultfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22039"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23039"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvscfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3776--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3953--><p class="noindent" >
 is used instead. This uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont </span>by default. So redefine, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span>
@@ -7792,150 +8076,150 @@
 to change first and subsequent uses or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvscfont </span>to change just the
 first use.
-</p><!--l. 3781--><p class="indent" >   The long form for the small-cap styles uses <span 
+</p><!--l. 3958--><p class="indent" >   The long form for the small-cap styles uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongdefaultfont </span>or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongdefaultfont</span>, as with the basic style. The suffix is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 3784--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3961--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrscsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22040"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23040"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrscsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3786--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3963--><p class="noindent" >
 This is defined as
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-107">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-117">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrscsuffix}{\glstextup{\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3790--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
+<!--l. 3967--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstextup</span><a 
- id="dx1-22041"></a> command is provided by <span 
+ id="dx1-23041"></a> command is provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>and is used to switch off the
 small caps font for the suffix. If you override the default short plural using the
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-22042"></a> key when you define the abbreviation you will need to make the
+ id="dx1-23042"></a> key when you define the abbreviation you will need to make the
 appropriate adjustment if necessary. (Remember that the default plural suffix
 behaviour can be modified through the use of the <a 
 href="#catattr.aposplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">aposplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22043"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-23043"></a> and <a 
 href="#catattr.noshortplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">noshortplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22044"></a>
+ id="dx1-23044"></a>
 attributes. See <a 
 href="#sec:categories"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a> for further details.)
-</p><!--l. 3801--><p class="indent" >   The small styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 3978--><p class="indent" >   The small styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sm"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sm</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22045"></a> and <a 
+ id="dx1-23045"></a> and <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22046"></a>, use
-</p><!--l. 3803--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-23046"></a>, use
+</p><!--l. 3980--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22047"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23047"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3805--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3982--><p class="noindent" >
 which uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsmaller</span>. (This requires the <span 
 class="cmss-10">relsizes</span><a 
- id="dx1-22048"></a> package, which isn’t loaded by
+ id="dx1-23048"></a> package, which isn’t loaded by
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>, so must be loaded explicitly.) On first use
-</p><!--l. 3810--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3987--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvsmfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22049"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23049"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvsmfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3812--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3989--><p class="noindent" >
 is used instead. This uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont </span>by default.
-</p><!--l. 3815--><p class="indent" >   The long form for the smaller styles uses <span 
+</p><!--l. 3992--><p class="indent" >   The long form for the smaller styles uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongdefaultfont </span>or
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongdefaultfont</span>, as with the basic style. The suffix is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 3818--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 3995--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsmsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22050"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23050"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsmsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3820--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 3997--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to just <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3823--><p class="indent" >   The “short-em” (emphasize short) styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 4000--><p class="indent" >   The “short-em” (emphasize short) styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22051"></a> or <a 
+ id="dx1-23051"></a> or <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22052"></a>,
+ id="dx1-23052"></a>,
 use
-</p><!--l. 3825--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4002--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvemfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22053"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23053"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3827--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4004--><p class="noindent" >
 On first use
-</p><!--l. 3829--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4006--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvemfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22054"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23054"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvemfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3831--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4008--><p class="noindent" >
 is used instead. This uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont </span>by default. The suffix is given
 by
-</p><!--l. 3834--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4011--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtremsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22055"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23055"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtremsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3836--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4013--><p class="noindent" >
 which defaults to just <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix</span>. The long form is as for the basic
 style unless the style is a “long-em” style.
-</p><!--l. 3841--><p class="indent" >   The “long-em” (emphasize long) styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 4018--><p class="indent" >   The “long-em” (emphasize long) styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22056"></a> or <a 
+ id="dx1-23056"></a> or <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-long-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-long-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22057"></a>,
+ id="dx1-23057"></a>,
 use
-</p><!--l. 3843--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4020--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22058"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23058"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">long-form</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3845--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4022--><p class="noindent" >
 instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long-form</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>and
-</p><!--l. 3847--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4024--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongemfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22059"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23059"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongemfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">long-form</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
@@ -7942,7 +8226,7 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 3849--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4026--><p class="noindent" >
 instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongdefaultfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long-form</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -7950,129 +8234,129 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span>
 is initialised to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongemfont</span>.
-</p><!--l. 3853--><p class="indent" >   The user styles have similar commands:
-</p><!--l. 3854--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4030--><p class="indent" >   The user styles have similar commands:
+</p><!--l. 4031--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvuserfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22060"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23060"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvuserfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3856--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4033--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short form,
-</p><!--l. 3858--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4035--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvuserfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22061"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23061"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvuserfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3860--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4037--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use short form,
-</p><!--l. 3862--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4039--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslonguserfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22062"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23062"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslonguserfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3864--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4041--><p class="noindent" >
 for the long form,
-</p><!--l. 3866--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4043--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlonguserfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22063"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23063"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlonguserfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3868--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4045--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use long form, and
-</p><!--l. 3870--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4047--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrusersuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22064"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23064"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrusersuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3872--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4049--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short plural suffix.
-</p><!--l. 3875--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the hyphen styles:
-</p><!--l. 3876--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4052--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the hyphen styles:
+</p><!--l. 4053--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvhyphenfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22065"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23065"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvhyphenfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3878--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4055--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short form,
-</p><!--l. 3880--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4057--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvhyphenfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22066"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23066"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvhyphenfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3882--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4059--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use short form,
-</p><!--l. 3884--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4061--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslonghyphenfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22067"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23067"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslonghyphenfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3886--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4063--><p class="noindent" >
 for the long form,
-</p><!--l. 3888--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4065--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlonghyphenfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22068"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23068"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlonghyphenfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3890--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4067--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use long form, and
-</p><!--l. 3892--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4069--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrhyphensuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22069"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23069"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrhyphensuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3894--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4071--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short plural suffix.
-</p><!--l. 3897--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the “only” styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 4074--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the “only” styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-only-short-only"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-only-short-only</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22070"></a>:
-</p><!--l. 3899--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-23070"></a>:
+</p><!--l. 4076--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvonlyfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22071"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23071"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvonlyfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3901--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4078--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short form,
-</p><!--l. 3903--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4080--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvonlyfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22072"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23072"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvonlyfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3905--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4082--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use short form,
-</p><!--l. 3907--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4084--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongonlyfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22073"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23073"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongonlyfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3909--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4086--><p class="noindent" >
 for the long form,
-</p><!--l. 3911--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4088--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlongonlyfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22074"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23074"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongonlyfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
@@ -8079,46 +8363,46 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 3913--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4090--><p class="noindent" >
 for the first use long form, and
-</p><!--l. 3915--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4092--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtronlysuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22075"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23075"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtronlysuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3917--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4094--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short plural suffix.
-</p><!--l. 3920--><p class="indent" >   Note that by default inserted material (provided in the final optional argument of
+</p><!--l. 4097--><p class="indent" >   Note that by default inserted material (provided in the final optional argument of
 commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>), is placed outside the font command in the predefined styles. To
 move it inside, use:
-</p><!--l. 3923--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4100--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrinsertinsidetrue</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22076"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23076"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinsertinsidetrue </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3925--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4102--><p class="noindent" >
 This applies to all the predefined styles. For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-108">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-118">
 \setabbreviationstyle{long-short}
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\glsfirstlongdefaultfont}[1]{\emph{#1}}
 &#x00A0;<br />\glsxtrinsertinsidetrue
 </div>
-<!--l. 3931--><p class="nopar" > This will make the long form and the inserted text emphasized, whereas the default
+<!--l. 4108--><p class="nopar" > This will make the long form and the inserted text emphasized, whereas the default
 (without <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinsertinsidetrue</span>) would place the inserted text outside of the
 emphasized font.
-</p><!--l. 3936--><p class="indent" >   Note that for some styles, such as the <a 
+</p><!--l. 4113--><p class="indent" >   Note that for some styles, such as the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22077"></a>, the inserted text would be
+ id="dx1-23077"></a>, the inserted text would be
 placed inside the font command for the short form (rather than the long form in the
 above example).
-</p><!--l. 3940--><p class="indent" >   Remember that <span 
+</p><!--l. 4117--><p class="indent" >   Remember that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc </span>renders <span 
 class="cmti-10">lowercase </span>letters as small capitals. Uppercase
 letters are rendered as normal uppercase letters, so if you specify the short form in
@@ -8129,30 +8413,30 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-109">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-119">
 \renewcommand*{\glsabbrvscfont}[1]{\textsc{\MakeLowercase{#1}}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3947--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 3949--><p class="indent" >   If you want to easily switch between the “sc” and “sm” styles, you may find it
+<!--l. 4124--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 4126--><p class="indent" >   If you want to easily switch between the “sc” and “sm” styles, you may find it
 easier to redefine this command to convert case:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-110">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-120">
 \renewcommand*{\glsabbrvscfont}[1]{\textsc{\MakeTextLowercase{#1}}}
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\glsabbrvsmfont}[1]{\textsmaller{\MakeTextUppercase{#1}}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3955--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 3957--><p class="indent" >   Some of the styles use
-</p><!--l. 3958--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 4132--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 4134--><p class="indent" >   Some of the styles use
+</p><!--l. 4135--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfullsep</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22078"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23078"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 3960--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4137--><p class="noindent" >
 as a separator between the long and short forms. This is defined as a space by
 default, but may be changed as required. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -8159,19 +8443,19 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-111">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-121">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrfullsep}[1]{~}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3965--><p class="nopar" > or
+<!--l. 4142--><p class="nopar" > or
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-112">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-122">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrfullsep}[1]{\glsacspace{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 3969--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 3971--><p class="indent" >   The new naming scheme for abbreviation styles is as follows: </p>
+<!--l. 4146--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 4148--><p class="indent" >   The new naming scheme for abbreviation styles is as follows: </p>
      <ul class="itemize1">
      <li class="itemize">&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field1</span>&#x27E9;[<span 
@@ -8182,7 +8466,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">-</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier2</span>&#x27E9;][<span 
 class="cmtt-10">-user</span>]
-     <!--l. 3976--><p class="noindent" >This is for the parenthetical styles. The <span 
+     <!--l. 4153--><p class="noindent" >This is for the parenthetical styles. The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">-</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9; parts may be omitted.
      These styles display &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -8192,30 +8476,30 @@
      &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field2</span>&#x27E9; starts with “no” then that element is omitted from the display style
      (no parenthetical part) but is included in the inline style.
-     </p><!--l. 3982--><p class="noindent" >If the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4159--><p class="noindent" >If the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">-</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9; part is present, then the field has a font changing command
      applied to it. The special modifier <span 
 class="cmtt-10">-only </span>indicates that field is only present
      according to whether or not the entry has been used.
-     </p><!--l. 3987--><p class="noindent" >If  <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4164--><p class="noindent" >If  <span 
 class="cmtt-10">post </span>is  present  then  &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field2</span>&#x27E9;  is  placed  after  the  <a 
- id="dx1-22079"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-23079"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a>  using  the
      post-link hook.
-     </p><!--l. 3990--><p class="noindent" >If the <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4167--><p class="noindent" >If the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">-user </span>part is present, then the <span 
 class="cmss-10">user1</span><a 
- id="dx1-22080"></a> value, if provided, is inserted
+ id="dx1-23080"></a> value, if provided, is inserted
      into the parenthetical material . (The field used for the inserted material
      may be changed.)
-     </p><!--l. 3994--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
+     </p><!--l. 4171--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
          <ul class="itemize2">
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-sc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-sc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22081"></a>:  &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-23081"></a>:  &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field1</span>&#x27E9;  is  the  long  form,  the  short  form  is  set  in
          smallcaps but omitted in the display style.
          </li>
@@ -8222,21 +8506,21 @@
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22082"></a>:  both  the  long  form  and  the  short  form  are
+ id="dx1-23082"></a>:  both  the  long  form  and  the  short  form  are
          emphasized. The short form is in parentheses.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22083"></a>: the short form is emphasized but not the long form.
+ id="dx1-23083"></a>: the short form is emphasized but not the long form.
          The short form is in parentheses.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22084"></a>: if the <span 
+ id="dx1-23084"></a>: if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">user1</span><a 
- id="dx1-22085"></a> key has been set, this produces the style
+ id="dx1-23085"></a> key has been set, this produces the style
          &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;, &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -8247,7 +8531,7 @@
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22086"></a>:  the  short  form  and  the  inserted
+ id="dx1-23086"></a>:  the  short  form  and  the  inserted
          material (provided by the final optional argument of commands like
          <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>) is moved to the post-link hook. The long form is formatted
@@ -8266,31 +8550,31 @@
      <li class="itemize">&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">style</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">-noreg</span>
-     <!--l. 4018--><p class="noindent" >Some styles set the <a 
+     <!--l. 4195--><p class="noindent" >Some styles set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22087"></a> attribute. In some cases, there’s a version of the
+ id="dx1-23087"></a> attribute. In some cases, there’s a version of the
      style that doesn’t set this attribute. For example, <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-noshort-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22088"></a> sets the
+ id="dx1-23088"></a> sets the
      <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22089"></a> attribute. The <a 
+ id="dx1-23089"></a> attribute. The <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-noreg"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-noshort-em-noreg</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22090"></a> style is a minor variation that
+ id="dx1-23090"></a> style is a minor variation that
      style that doesn’t set the attribute.
-     </p><!--l. 4025--><p class="noindent" >There are a few “noshort” styles, such as <a 
+     </p><!--l. 4202--><p class="noindent" >There are a few “noshort” styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-noshort-noreg"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-noshort-noreg</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22091"></a>, that have
+ id="dx1-23091"></a>, that have
      “-noreg” version without a regular version. This is because the style won’t work
      properly with the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22092"></a> set, but the naming scheme is maintained for
+ id="dx1-23092"></a> set, but the naming scheme is maintained for
      consistency with the other “noshort” styles.
      </p></li>
      <li class="itemize">&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -8300,79 +8584,79 @@
 class="cmtt-10">-</span>[<span 
 class="cmtt-10">post</span>]<span 
 class="cmtt-10">footnote</span>
-     <!--l. 4035--><p class="noindent" >The display style uses &#x27E8;<span 
+     <!--l. 4212--><p class="noindent" >The display style uses &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field1</span>&#x27E9; followed by a footnote with the other field in it. If
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">post </span>is present then the footnote is placed after the <a 
- id="dx1-22093"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-23093"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> using the
      post-link hook. The inline style does &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field1</span>&#x27E9; followed by the other field in
      parentheses.
-     </p><!--l. 4041--><p class="noindent" >If <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4218--><p class="noindent" >If <span 
 class="cmtt-10">-</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier1</span>&#x27E9; is present, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field1</span>&#x27E9; has a font-changing command applied to
      it.
-     </p><!--l. 4044--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
+     </p><!--l. 4221--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
          <ul class="itemize2">
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22094"></a>:  short  form  in  the  text  with  the  long  form  in  the
+ id="dx1-23094"></a>:  short  form  in  the  text  with  the  long  form  in  the
          footnote.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22095"></a>: short form in smallcaps with the long form in
+ id="dx1-23095"></a>: short form in smallcaps with the long form in
          the footnote outside of the <a 
- id="dx1-22096"></a>link-text.</li></ul>
-     <!--l. 4052--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Take care with the footnote styles. Remember that there are some situations
+ id="dx1-23096"></a>link-text.</li></ul>
+     <!--l. 4229--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Take care with the footnote styles. Remember that there are some situations
      where <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-22097"></a> doesn’t work. </div>
-     </p><!--l. 4055--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="dx1-23097"></a> doesn’t work. </div>
+     </p><!--l. 4232--><p class="noindent" >
      </p></li>
      <li class="itemize">&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">style</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">-desc</span>
-     <!--l. 4059--><p class="noindent" >Like &#x27E8;<span 
+     <!--l. 4236--><p class="noindent" >Like &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">style</span>&#x27E9; but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-22098"></a> key must be provided when defining abbreviations
+ id="dx1-23098"></a> key must be provided when defining abbreviations
      with this style.
-     </p><!--l. 4062--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
+     </p><!--l. 4239--><p class="noindent" >Examples: </p>
          <ul class="itemize2">
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22099"></a>: like <a 
+ id="dx1-23099"></a>: like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22100"></a> but requires a description.
+ id="dx1-23100"></a> but requires a description.
          </li>
          <li class="itemize"><a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-footnote-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-footnote-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22101"></a>:   like   <a 
+ id="dx1-23101"></a>:   like   <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-22102"></a>   but   requires   a
+ id="dx1-23102"></a>   but   requires   a
          description.</li></ul>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
      </li></ul>
-<!--l. 4072--><p class="indent" >   Not all combinations that fit the above syntax are provided. Pre-version 1.04
+<!--l. 4249--><p class="indent" >   Not all combinations that fit the above syntax are provided. Pre-version 1.04
 styles that didn’t fit this naming scheme are either provided with a synonym (where
 the former name wasn’t ambiguous) or provided with a deprecated synonym (where
 the former name was confusing). The deprecated style names generate a warning
 using:
-</p><!--l. 4078--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 4255--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrWarnDeprecatedAbbrStyle</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-22103"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-23103"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrWarnDeprecatedAbbrStyle</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -8380,38 +8664,38 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">new-name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 4080--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4257--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">old-name</span>&#x27E9; is the deprecated name and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">new-name</span>&#x27E9; is the preferred name. You
 can suppress these warnings by redefining this command to do nothing.
-</p><!--l. 4086--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 4263--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 4086--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 4263--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.4.1   </span> <a 
  id="sec:predefregabbrvstyles"></a>Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Set the Regular Attribute</h4>
-<!--l. 4089--><p class="noindent" >The following abbreviation styles set the <a 
+<!--l. 4266--><p class="noindent" >The following abbreviation styles set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23001"></a> attribute to “true” for all categories
+ id="dx1-24001"></a> attribute to “true” for all categories
 that have abbreviations defined with any of these styles.
      </p><dl class="description"><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-nolong"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-nolong</span><a 
- id="dx1-23002"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24002"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This only displays the short form on <a 
- id="dx1-23003"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-24003"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-23004"></a> is set to the
+ id="dx1-24004"></a> is set to the
      short form through the command
-     <!--l. 4097--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4274--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortnolongname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-23005"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-24005"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortnolongname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4099--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4276--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for the other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">short</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -8424,33 +8708,33 @@
      take effect. Make sure to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\protect </span>any formatting commands (or anything else
      that shouldn’t be expanded).
-     </p><!--l. 4108--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4285--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-23006"></a> is set to the long form. The inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24006"></a> is set to the long form. The inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;
      (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;). The long form on its own can be displayed through commands like
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span><a 
- id="dx1-23007"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24007"></a>.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-23008"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24008"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23009"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24009"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.nolong-short"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nolong-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-23010"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24010"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23011"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24011"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;).
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -8457,25 +8741,25 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-nolong"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-nolong</span><a 
- id="dx1-23012"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24012"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23013"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24013"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23014"></a> (which defaults to <span 
+ id="dx1-24014"></a> (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span>).
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23015"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24015"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23016"></a>
+ id="dx1-24016"></a>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -8483,11 +8767,11 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.nolong-short-sc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nolong-short-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23017"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24017"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23018"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24018"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;).
      The name is still obtained from <span 
@@ -8502,34 +8786,34 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-nolong"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-nolong</span><a 
- id="dx1-23019"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24019"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23020"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24020"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23021"></a> (which defaults to <span 
+ id="dx1-24021"></a> (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsmaller</span>).
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-23022"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24022"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23023"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24023"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.nolong-short-sm"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nolong-short-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-23024"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24024"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23025"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24025"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;
      (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;).
@@ -8537,33 +8821,33 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-nolong"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-nolong</span><a 
- id="dx1-23026"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24026"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23027"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24027"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23028"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24028"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23029"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24029"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23030"></a>
+ id="dx1-24030"></a>
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.nolong-short-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nolong-short-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23031"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24031"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23032"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24032"></a> but the inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;
      (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;).
@@ -8571,20 +8855,20 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-nolong-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23033"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24033"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23034"></a> style, but the <span 
+ id="dx1-24034"></a> style, but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-23035"></a> is set to the full form
+ id="dx1-24035"></a> is set to the full form
      obtained by expanding
-     <!--l. 4155--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4332--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-23036"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-24036"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortdescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4157--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4334--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for the other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">short</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -8597,16 +8881,16 @@
      before <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>).
-     </p><!--l. 4164--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4341--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-23037"></a> must be supplied by the user. You may prefer to use
+ id="dx1-24037"></a> must be supplied by the user. You may prefer to use
      the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23038"></a> style with the post-description hook set to display
+ id="dx1-24038"></a> style with the post-description hook set to display
      the long form and override the <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-23039"></a> key. (See the sample file
+ id="dx1-24039"></a> key. (See the sample file
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-acronym-desc.tex</span>.)
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
@@ -8613,24 +8897,24 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23040"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24040"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23041"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24041"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-nolong-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-nolong-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23042"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24042"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23043"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24043"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23044"></a> (which defaults to <span 
+ id="dx1-24044"></a> (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span>).
                                                                   
 
@@ -8639,83 +8923,83 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23045"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24045"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23046"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24046"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-nolong-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-nolong-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23047"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24047"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23048"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24048"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23049"></a> (which defaults to <span 
+ id="dx1-24049"></a> (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsmaller</span>).
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23050"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24050"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sm-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sm-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23051"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24051"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-nolong-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-nolong-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23052"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24052"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23053"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24053"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23054"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24054"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23055"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24055"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23056"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24056"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23057"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24057"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style only displays the long form, regardless of first or
      subsequent use of commands <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-23058"></a>. The short form may be accessed
+ id="dx1-24058"></a>. The short form may be accessed
      through commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23059"></a>. The inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-24059"></a>. The inline full form displays &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;
      (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;).
-     <!--l. 4200--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     <!--l. 4377--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23060"></a> key are set to the long form. The <span 
+ id="dx1-24060"></a> key are set to the long form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-23061"></a> key is also set to the long form,
+ id="dx1-24061"></a> key is also set to the long form,
      but this is done by expanding
-     </p><!--l. 4203--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4380--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongnoshortdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-23062"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-24062"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongnoshortdescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4205--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4382--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for the other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">long</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -8725,9 +9009,9 @@
      indicated otherwise.) This command should only be redefined before
      abbreviations are defined, and any fragile or formatting commands within it
      need protecting.
-     </p><!--l. 4211--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4388--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-23063"></a> must be provided by the user. The predefined glossary styles
+ id="dx1-24063"></a> must be provided by the user. The predefined glossary styles
      won’t display the short form. You can use the post-description hook to
      automatically append the short form to the description. The inline full form
      will display &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -8737,44 +9021,44 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23064"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24064"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23065"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24065"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-sc-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-sc-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23066"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24066"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23067"></a> style but the short form (accessed
+ id="dx1-24067"></a> style but the short form (accessed
      through commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23068"></a>) use <span 
+ id="dx1-24068"></a>) use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23069"></a>. (This style was
+ id="dx1-24069"></a>. (This style was
      originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-desc-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23070"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name
+ id="dx1-24070"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name
      retained as a deprecated synonym for backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-sm-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-sm-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23071"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24071"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23072"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24072"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23073"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-24073"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-desc-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-23074"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-24074"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
                                                                   
@@ -8784,60 +9068,60 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23075"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24075"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23076"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24076"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23077"></a>. The long form isn’t emphasized. (This style was originally
+ id="dx1-24077"></a>. The long form isn’t emphasized. (This style was originally
      called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-desc-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23078"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
+ id="dx1-24078"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
      deprecated synonym for backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-noshort-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23079"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24079"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23080"></a> but
+ id="dx1-24080"></a> but
      redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23081"></a>. The long form uses
+ id="dx1-24081"></a>. The long form uses
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23082"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-24082"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23083"></a>.
+ id="dx1-24083"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23084"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24084"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style doesn’t really make sense if you don’t use the short form
      anywhere in the document, but is provided for completeness. This is
      like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23085"></a> style, but the <span 
+ id="dx1-24085"></a> style, but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23086"></a> key is set to the short
+ id="dx1-24086"></a> key is set to the short
      form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-23087"></a> key is also set to the short form, but this is done by
+ id="dx1-24087"></a> key is also set to the short form, but this is done by
      expanding
-     <!--l. 4252--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4429--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongnoshortname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-23088"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-24088"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongnoshortname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4254--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4431--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">long</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -8845,51 +9129,51 @@
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9; styles, unless indicated
      otherwise.) This command should only be redefined before abbreviations are
      defined, and fragile or formatting commands should be protected.
-     </p><!--l. 4261--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4438--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-23089"></a> is set to the long form.
+ id="dx1-24089"></a> is set to the long form.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-23090"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24090"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23091"></a>
+ id="dx1-24091"></a>
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-sc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23092"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24092"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23093"></a> style but the short form (accessed through
+ id="dx1-24093"></a> style but the short form (accessed through
      commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23094"></a>) use <span 
+ id="dx1-24094"></a>) use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23095"></a>. (This style was originally
+ id="dx1-24095"></a>. (This style was originally
      called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-23096"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
+ id="dx1-24096"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
      deprecated synonym for backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-sm"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-23097"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24097"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23098"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24098"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23099"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-24099"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-23100"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-24100"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -8896,28 +9180,28 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23101"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24101"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23102"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-24102"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23103"></a>. The long form isn’t emphasized. (This style was originally
+ id="dx1-24103"></a>. The long form isn’t emphasized. (This style was originally
      called <span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23104"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
+ id="dx1-24104"></a>. Renamed in version 1.04, but original name retained as a
      deprecated synonym for backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-noshort-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-23105"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-24105"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23106"></a> but redefines
+ id="dx1-24106"></a> but redefines
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -8924,7 +9208,7 @@
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-23107"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-24107"></a>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont </span>and <span 
@@ -8932,27 +9216,27 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongemfont</span>. The short
      form isn’t used by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-23108"></a>, but can be obtained using
+ id="dx1-24108"></a>, but can be obtained using
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-23109"></a>. The related style <a 
+ id="dx1-24109"></a>. The related style <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-noshort-em-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-23110"></a> doesn’t set the
+ id="dx1-24110"></a> doesn’t set the
      <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-23111"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-24111"></a> attribute.
      </dd></dl>
-<!--l. 4298--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 4475--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 4298--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 4475--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h4 class="subsectionHead"></p><h4 class="subsectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.4.2   </span> <a 
  id="sec:predefnonregabbrvstyles"></a>Predefined Abbreviation Styles that Don’t Set the Regular Attribute</h4>
-<!--l. 4301--><p class="noindent" >The following abbreviation styles will set the <a 
+<!--l. 4478--><p class="noindent" >The following abbreviation styles will set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24001"></a> attribute to “false” if it has
+ id="dx1-25001"></a> attribute to “false” if it has
 previously been set. If it hasn’t already been set, it’s left unset. Other attributes may
 also be set, depending on the style.
      </p><dl class="description"><dt class="description">
@@ -8959,24 +9243,24 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short</span><a 
- id="dx1-24002"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25002"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">On <a 
- id="dx1-24003"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25003"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, this style uses the format &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;). The inline and
      display full forms are the same. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-24004"></a> key is set to the short form. The <span 
+ id="dx1-25004"></a> key is set to the short form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24005"></a>
+ id="dx1-25005"></a>
      is also set to the short form through
-     <!--l. 4312--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4489--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongshortname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24006"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25006"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4314--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4491--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">long</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -8989,64 +9273,64 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\the\glslongtok </span>and the short form can be referenced with
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\the\glsshorttok</span>.
-     </p><!--l. 4324--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4501--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24007"></a> is set to the long form. The long and short forms are separated
+ id="dx1-25007"></a> is set to the long form. The long and short forms are separated
      by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep</span>. If you want to insert material within the parentheses
      (such as a&#x00A0;translation), try the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24008"></a> style.
+ id="dx1-25008"></a> style.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-sc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24009"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25009"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24010"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25010"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24011"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25011"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-sm"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-24012"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25012"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24013"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25013"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24014"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25014"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-24015"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25015"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24016"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25016"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24017"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25017"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-short-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-short-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-24018"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25018"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24019"></a> but redefines
+ id="dx1-25019"></a> but redefines
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24020"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25020"></a>.
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -9054,7 +9338,7 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-only-short-only"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-only-short-only</span><a 
- id="dx1-24021"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25021"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style only shows the long form on first
      use and only shows the short form on subsequent use. The inline full form
      <span 
@@ -9061,13 +9345,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull </span>shows the long form followed by the short form in parentheses.
      The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24022"></a> field is obtained from
-     <!--l. 4351--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-25022"></a> field is obtained from
+     <!--l. 4528--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtronlyname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24023"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25023"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtronlyname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4353--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4530--><p class="noindent" >
      Any redefinition of this command must come before the abbreviations
      are defined as it expands on definition. Make sure you protect any
      commands that shouldn’t be expanded. The long form can be referenced
@@ -9079,21 +9363,21 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-only-short-only-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-only-short-only-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24024"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25024"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-only-short-only"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-only-short-only</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24025"></a>
+ id="dx1-25025"></a>
      but the user must supply the description. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24026"></a> field is obtained
+ id="dx1-25026"></a> field is obtained
      from
-     <!--l. 4365--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4542--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtronlydescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtronlydescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4367--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4544--><p class="noindent" >
      Any redefinition of this command must come before the abbreviations
      are defined as it expands on definition. Make sure you protect any
      commands that shouldn’t be expanded. The long form can be referenced
@@ -9105,41 +9389,41 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-noshort-em-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24028"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25028"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-noshort-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24029"></a>
+ id="dx1-25029"></a>
      but doesn’t set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24030"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25030"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-user"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-user</span><a 
- id="dx1-24031"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25031"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style was introduced in version 1.04. It’s like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24032"></a> style
+ id="dx1-25032"></a> style
      but additional information can be inserted into the parenthetical material. This
      checks the value of the field given by
-     <!--l. 4384--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4561--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtruserfield</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruserfield </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4386--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4563--><p class="noindent" >
      (which defaults to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">useri</span>) using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglshasfield</span><a 
- id="dx1-24034"></a> (provided by <span 
+ id="dx1-25034"></a> (provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>). If the
      field hasn’t been set, the style behaves like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24035"></a> style and produces
+ id="dx1-25035"></a> style and produces
      &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;) but if the field has been set, the contents of that field are inserted
@@ -9148,35 +9432,53 @@
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">field-value</span>&#x27E9;). The format is
      governed by
-     </p><!--l. 4394--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4571--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtruserparen</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24036"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25036"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruserparen{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4396--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4573--><p class="noindent" >
      where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; is the short form (for the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24037"></a> style) or the long form (for
+ id="dx1-25037"></a> style) or the long form (for
      the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24038"></a> style). This command first inserts a space using
+ id="dx1-25038"></a> style). This command first inserts a space using
+                                                                  
+
+                                                                  
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep </span>and then the parenthetical content (using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrparen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24039"></a>).
-                                                                  
-
-                                                                  
-     </p><!--l. 4403--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+ id="dx1-25039"></a>).
+     The <span 
+class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
+ id="dx1-25040"></a> is set to
+     </p><!--l. 4580--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+class="cmtt-9">\glsuserdescription</span><span 
+class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
+ id="dx1-25041"></a> <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsuserdescription{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmitt-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
+     </p><!--l. 4582--><p class="noindent" >
+     The default definition ignores the &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; and encapsulates &#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; with
+     <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glslonguserfont</span>.
+     </p><!--l. 4586--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24040"></a> is obtained by expanding <span 
+ id="dx1-25042"></a> is obtained by expanding <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortname </span>(see above). The
      &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9; argument includes the font formatting command, <span 
@@ -9187,7 +9489,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>in the case of the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24041"></a> style and <span 
+ id="dx1-25043"></a> style and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -9194,13 +9496,13 @@
      in the case of the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24042"></a> style.
-     </p><!--l. 4411--><p class="noindent" >For example:
+ id="dx1-25044"></a> style.
+     </p><!--l. 4594--><p class="noindent" >For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-113">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-123">
      \setabbreviationstyle[acronym]{long-short-user}
      &#x00A0;<br />\newacronym{tug}{TUG}{\TeX\&#x00A0;User&#x00A0;Group}
      &#x00A0;<br />\newacronym
@@ -9207,123 +9509,123 @@
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;[user1={German&#x00A0;Speaking&#x00A0;\TeX\&#x00A0;User&#x00A0;Group}]
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{dante}{DANTE}{Deutschsprachige&#x00A0;Anwendervereinigung&#x00A0;\TeX\&#x00A0;e.V}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4421--><p class="nopar" > On first use, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+     <!--l. 4604--><p class="nopar" > On first use, <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{tug}</span></span></span> will appear as:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4424--><p class="noindent" ><span class="TEX">T<span 
+         <!--l. 4607--><p class="noindent" ><span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span>&#x00A0;User Group (TUG)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4426--><p class="noindent" >whereas <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+     <!--l. 4609--><p class="noindent" >whereas <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{dante}</span></span></span> will appear as:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4428--><p class="noindent" >Deutschsprachige  Anwendervereinigung  <span class="TEX">T<span 
+         <!--l. 4611--><p class="noindent" >Deutschsprachige  Anwendervereinigung  <span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span>&#x00A0;e.V  (DANTE,
          German Speaking <span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span>&#x00A0;User Group)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4431--><p class="noindent" >The short form is formatted according to
-     </p><!--l. 4432--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4614--><p class="noindent" >The short form is formatted according to
+     </p><!--l. 4615--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvuserfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24043"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvuserfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4434--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4617--><p class="noindent" >
      and the plural suffix is given by
-     </p><!--l. 4436--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4619--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrusersuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24044"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25046"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrusersuffix </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4438--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4440--><p class="noindent" >These may be redefined as appropriate. For example, if you want a&#x00A0;smallcaps
+     </p><!--l. 4621--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4623--><p class="noindent" >These may be redefined as appropriate. For example, if you want a&#x00A0;smallcaps
      style, you can just set these commands to those used by the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-sc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-sc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24045"></a>
+ id="dx1-25047"></a>
      style:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-114">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-124">
      \renewcommand{\glsabbruserfont}[1]{\glsabbrvscfont{#1}}
      &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand{\glsxtrusersuffix}{\glsxtrscsuffix}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4446--><p class="nopar" >
+     <!--l. 4629--><p class="nopar" >
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24046"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25048"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24047"></a> but it doesn’t set the <a 
+ id="dx1-25049"></a> but it doesn’t set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24048"></a>
+ id="dx1-25050"></a>
      attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-noshort-desc-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24049"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25051"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24050"></a> but it doesn’t set the
+ id="dx1-25052"></a> but it doesn’t set the
      <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24051"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25053"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24052"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25054"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">On <a 
- id="dx1-24053"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25055"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, this style uses the format &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;). The
      inline and display full forms are the same. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24054"></a> is set to the full
+ id="dx1-25056"></a> is set to the full
      form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-24055"></a> key is set to &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-25057"></a> key is set to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;). Before version 1.04, this was
      incorrectly set to the short form. If you want to revert back to this you can
      redefine
-     <!--l. 4463--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4646--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongshortdescsort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24056"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25058"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortdescsort </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4465--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4648--><p class="noindent" >
      For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-115">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-125">
      \renewcommand*{\glsxtrlongshortdescsort}{\the\glsshorttok}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4469--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
+     <!--l. 4652--><p class="nopar" > The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24057"></a> must be supplied by the user. The long and short
+ id="dx1-25059"></a> must be supplied by the user. The long and short
      forms are separated by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep</span>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24058"></a> field is obtained
+ id="dx1-25060"></a> field is obtained
      from
-     </p><!--l. 4473--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4656--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongshortdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24059"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25061"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortdescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4475--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4658--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">long</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -9341,172 +9643,172 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-sc-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-sc-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24060"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25062"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24061"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25063"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24062"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25064"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-sm-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-sm-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24063"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25065"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24064"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25066"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24065"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25067"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24066"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25068"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24067"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25069"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24068"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25070"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-short-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-short-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24069"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25071"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-em-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-em-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24070"></a> but
+ id="dx1-25072"></a> but
      redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24071"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25073"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-desc-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-em-noshort-em-desc-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24072"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25074"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style is like
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-noshort-em-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-noshort-em-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24073"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
+ id="dx1-25075"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24074"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25076"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-short-user-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-short-user-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24075"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25077"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like a&#x00A0;cross between the
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24076"></a> style and the <a 
+ id="dx1-25078"></a> style and the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24077"></a> style. The display and
+ id="dx1-25079"></a> style. The display and
      inline forms are as for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24078"></a> and the <span 
+ id="dx1-25080"></a> and the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24079"></a> key is obtained
+ id="dx1-25081"></a> key is obtained
      from
-     <!--l. 4513--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4696--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlongshortuserdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24080"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25082"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortuserdescname </span></div><hr>
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     </p><!--l. 4515--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4698--><p class="noindent" >
      Again, this should only be redefined before <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>), and fragile and formatting commands need protecting.
-     </p><!--l. 4519--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4702--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24081"></a> key must be supplied in the optional argument of
+ id="dx1-25083"></a> key must be supplied in the optional argument of
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>). The <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-24082"></a> key is set to &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-25084"></a> key is set to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;) as per
      the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24083"></a> style.
+ id="dx1-25085"></a> style.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-nolong-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-nolong-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24084"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25086"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24085"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
+ id="dx1-25087"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24086"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25088"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.nolong-short-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nolong-short-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24087"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25089"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.nolong-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nolong-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24088"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
+ id="dx1-25090"></a> but doesn’t set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24089"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25091"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-long"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-24090"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25092"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">On <a 
- id="dx1-24091"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25093"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, this style uses the format &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;). The inline and
      display full forms are the same. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24092"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-25094"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-24093"></a> keys are set to the
+ id="dx1-25095"></a> keys are set to the
      short form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24094"></a> is set to the long form. The short and long
+ id="dx1-25096"></a> is set to the long form. The short and long
      forms are separated by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep</span>. If you want to insert material
      within the parentheses (such as a&#x00A0;translation), try the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24095"></a>
+ id="dx1-25097"></a>
      style.
-     <!--l. 4542--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     <!--l. 4725--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24096"></a> field is obtained from
-     </p><!--l. 4543--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-25098"></a> field is obtained from
+     </p><!--l. 4726--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortlongname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24097"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25099"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4545--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4728--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">short</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -9523,122 +9825,129 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-long"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-24098"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25100"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24099"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25101"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24100"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25102"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-long"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-24101"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25103"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24102"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25104"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24103"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25105"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-long"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-long</span><a 
- id="dx1-24104"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25106"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24105"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25107"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24106"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25108"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-long-em"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-long-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-24107"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25109"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24108"></a> but redefines
+ id="dx1-25110"></a> but redefines
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24109"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25111"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-long-user"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-long-user</span><a 
- id="dx1-24110"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25112"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04. This style is like the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24111"></a> style but
+ id="dx1-25113"></a> style but
      with the long and short forms switched. The parenthetical material is governed
      by the same command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtruserparen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24112"></a>, but the first argument supplied to it
+ id="dx1-25114"></a>, but the first argument supplied to it
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
      is the long form instead of the short form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24113"></a> field is obtained by
+ id="dx1-25115"></a> field is obtained by
      expanding
-     <!--l. 4579--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4762--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortlongname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24114"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25116"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4581--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4764--><p class="noindent" >
      Again, this should only be redefined before <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or
      <span 
-class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>) and commands that should be expanded need to be
-     protected.
+class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>) and commands that should be expanded need to be protected.
+     The <span 
+class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
+ id="dx1-25117"></a> is set to <span 
+class="cmtt-10">\glsuserdescription{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
+class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
+class="cmtt-10">}</span>.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-nolong-desc-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24115"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25118"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-nolong-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-nolong-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24116"></a> but it doesn’t set the
+ id="dx1-25119"></a> but it doesn’t set the
      <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24117"></a> attribute.
+ id="dx1-25120"></a> attribute.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-long-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24118"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25121"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">On <a 
- id="dx1-24119"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25122"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, this style uses the format &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;). The
      inline and display full forms are the same. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24120"></a> is set to the full
+ id="dx1-25123"></a> is set to the full
      form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24121"></a> must be supplied by the user. The short and long
+ id="dx1-25124"></a> must be supplied by the user. The short and long
      forms are separated by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep</span>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24122"></a> field is obtained
+ id="dx1-25125"></a> field is obtained
      from
-     <!--l. 4597--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4781--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortlongdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24123"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25126"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongdescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4599--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4783--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">short</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -9656,90 +9965,90 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-long-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24124"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25127"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24125"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25128"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24126"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25129"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-long-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24127"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25130"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24128"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25131"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24129"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25132"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-long-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-long-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24130"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25133"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24131"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25134"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24132"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25135"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-long-em-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-long-em-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24133"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25136"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-em-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-em-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24134"></a> but
+ id="dx1-25137"></a> but
      redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont </span>to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24135"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25138"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-long-user-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-long-user-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24136"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25139"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.04, this style is like a&#x00A0;cross between the
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24137"></a> style and the <a 
+ id="dx1-25140"></a> style and the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24138"></a> style. The display and
+ id="dx1-25141"></a> style. The display and
      inline forms are as for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24139"></a>, but the <span 
+ id="dx1-25142"></a>, but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24140"></a> key is obtained
+ id="dx1-25143"></a> key is obtained
      from
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <!--l. 4631--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4815--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshortlonguserdescname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24141"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25144"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlonguserdescname </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4633--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4817--><p class="noindent" >
      Again, this should only be redefined before <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>), and fragile and formatting commands need protecting.
-     </p><!--l. 4637--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4821--><p class="noindent" >The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24142"></a> key must be supplied in the optional argument of
+ id="dx1-25145"></a> key must be supplied in the optional argument of
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>).
@@ -9747,36 +10056,36 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-footnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24143"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25146"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">On <a 
- id="dx1-24144"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25147"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>, this style displays the short form with the long form as
      a footnote. This style automatically sets the <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyperfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyperfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24145"></a> attribute to “true” for
+ id="dx1-25148"></a> attribute to “true” for
      the supplied category, so the <a 
- id="dx1-24146"></a>first use won’t be hyperlinked (but the footnote
+ id="dx1-25149"></a>first use won’t be hyperlinked (but the footnote
      marker may be, if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-24147"></a> package is used).
-     <!--l. 4648--><p class="noindent" >The inline full form uses the &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-25150"></a> package is used).
+     <!--l. 4832--><p class="noindent" >The inline full form uses the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;) style. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24148"></a> is set to the short
+ id="dx1-25151"></a> is set to the short
      form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24149"></a> is set to the long form. The <span 
+ id="dx1-25152"></a> is set to the long form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24150"></a> key is obtained by
+ id="dx1-25153"></a> key is obtained by
      expanding
-     </p><!--l. 4652--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4836--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfootnotename</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24151"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25154"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfootnotename </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4654--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4838--><p class="noindent" >
      (Similarly for other <span 
 class="cmtt-10">short</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">modifier</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -9788,42 +10097,42 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>(or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span>), and fragile or formatting commands
      should be protected from expansion.
-     </p><!--l. 4661--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.05, all the footnote styles use:
-     </p><!--l. 4662--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4845--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.05, all the footnote styles use:
+     </p><!--l. 4846--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlongfootnotefont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24152"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25155"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfootnotefont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
      </div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4664--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4848--><p class="noindent" >
      to format the long form on <a 
- id="dx1-24153"></a>first use or for the full form and
-     </p><!--l. 4666--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-25156"></a>first use or for the full form and
+     </p><!--l. 4850--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongfootnotefont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24154"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25157"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongfootnotefont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4668--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4852--><p class="noindent" >
      to format the long form elsewhere (for example, when used with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span>).
-     </p><!--l. 4672--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.07, all the footnote styles use:
-     </p><!--l. 4673--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 4856--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.07, all the footnote styles use:
+     </p><!--l. 4857--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrabbrvfootnote</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24155"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25158"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrabbrvfootnote{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4675--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4859--><p class="noindent" >
      By default, this just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24156"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-25159"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>(the first argument is ignored). For
@@ -9833,22 +10142,22 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-116">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-126">
      \renewcommand{\glsxtrabbrvfootnote}[2]{%
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\footnote{\glshyperlink[#2]{#1}}%
      &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4683--><p class="nopar" > or to include the short form with a hyperlink:
+     <!--l. 4867--><p class="nopar" > or to include the short form with a hyperlink:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-117">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-127">
      \renewcommand{\glsxtrabbrvfootnote}[2]{%
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\footnote{\glshyperlink[\glsfmtshort{#1}]{#1}:&#x00A0;#2}%
      &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4689--><p class="nopar" > Note that I haven’t used commands like <span 
+     <!--l. 4873--><p class="nopar" > Note that I haven’t used commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>to avoid interference
      (see <a 
 href="#sec:entryfmtmods"><span 
@@ -9855,32 +10164,32 @@
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.3 </a><a 
 href="#sec:entryfmtmods">Entry Display Style Modifications<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:entryfmtmods --></a> and <a 
 href="#sec:nested"><span 
-class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.6 </a><a 
+class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:nested">Nested Links<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:nested --></a>).
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.footnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24157"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25160"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24158"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25161"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-footnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24159"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25162"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24160"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25163"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24161"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25164"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24162"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-25165"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -9887,17 +10196,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-footnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24163"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25166"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24164"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25167"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24165"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25168"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-24166"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-25169"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -9904,17 +10213,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-footnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-footnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24167"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25170"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24168"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25171"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24169"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25172"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">footnote-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-24170"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-25173"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -9921,45 +10230,45 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-postfootnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24171"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25174"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is similar to the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24172"></a> style but doesn’t modify the
+ id="dx1-25175"></a> style but doesn’t modify the
      category attribute. Instead it changes <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostlink</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category</span>&#x27E9;<a 
- id="dx1-24173"></a>&#x00A0;to insert the
+ id="dx1-25176"></a>&#x00A0;to insert the
      footnote after the <a 
- id="dx1-24174"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25177"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> on <a 
- id="dx1-24175"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-25178"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>. This will also defer the footnote
      until after any following punctuation character that’s recognised by
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifnextpunc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24176"></a>.
-     <!--l. 4726--><p class="noindent" >The inline full form uses the &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-25179"></a>.
+     <!--l. 4910--><p class="noindent" >The inline full form uses the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;) style. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24177"></a> is set to the short
+ id="dx1-25180"></a> is set to the short
      form. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24178"></a> is set to the long form. Note that this style will change
+ id="dx1-25181"></a> is set to the long form. Note that this style will change
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull </span>(and it’s variants) so that it fakes non-<a 
- id="dx1-24179"></a>first use. (Otherwise the
+ id="dx1-25182"></a>first use. (Otherwise the
      footnote would appear after the inline form.)
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.postfootnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">postfootnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24180"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25183"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">A synonym for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24181"></a>.
+ id="dx1-25184"></a>.
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -9967,17 +10276,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sc-postfootnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sc-postfootnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24182"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25185"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24183"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25186"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvscfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24184"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25187"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">postfootnote-sc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24185"></a>. Renamed in
+ id="dx1-25188"></a>. Renamed in
      version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -9984,17 +10293,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-sm-postfootnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-sm-postfootnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24186"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25189"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24187"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25190"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvsmfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24188"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25191"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">postfootnote-sm</span><a 
- id="dx1-24189"></a>. Renamed
+ id="dx1-25192"></a>. Renamed
      in version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10001,17 +10310,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-em-postfootnote"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-em-postfootnote</span><a 
- id="dx1-24190"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25193"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postfootnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postfootnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24191"></a> but redefines <span 
+ id="dx1-25194"></a> but redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>to use
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-24192"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
+ id="dx1-25195"></a>. (This style was originally called <span 
 class="cmss-10">postfootnote-em</span><a 
- id="dx1-24193"></a>. Renamed
+ id="dx1-25196"></a>. Renamed
      in version 1.04, but original name retained as a deprecated synonym for
      backward-compatibility.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10018,18 +10327,18 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-postlong-user"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-postlong-user</span><a 
- id="dx1-24194"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25197"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style was introduced in version 1.12. It’s like the
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24195"></a> style but defers the parenthetical material to after the link-text.
+ id="dx1-25198"></a> style but defers the parenthetical material to after the link-text.
      This means that you don’t have such a long hyperlink (which can cause
      problems for the DVI <span class="LATEX">L<span class="A">A</span><span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span></span>&#x00A0;format) and it also means that the user supplied
      material can include a hyperlink to another location. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24196"></a> key is obtained
+ id="dx1-25199"></a> key is obtained
      from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongname</span>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10036,16 +10345,16 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-postlong-user-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-postlong-user-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24197"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25200"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style was introduced in version 1.12. It’s like the
      above <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postlong-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postlong-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24198"></a> style but the <span 
+ id="dx1-25201"></a> style but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24199"></a> must be specified. The <span 
+ id="dx1-25202"></a> must be specified. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24200"></a>
+ id="dx1-25203"></a>
      is obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlonguserdescname</span>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10052,31 +10361,31 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-postshort-user"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-postshort-user</span><a 
- id="dx1-24201"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25204"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style was introduced in version 1.12. It’s like the
      above <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-postlong-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-postlong-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24202"></a> style but the long form is shown first and
+ id="dx1-25205"></a> style but the long form is shown first and
      the short form is in the parenthetical material (as for <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24203"></a>)
+ id="dx1-25206"></a>)
      style.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-postshort-user-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-postshort-user-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24204"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25207"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style was introduced in version 1.12. It’s like the
      above <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-postshort-user"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-postshort-user</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24205"></a> style but the <span 
+ id="dx1-25208"></a> style but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-24206"></a> must be specified. The <span 
+ id="dx1-25209"></a> must be specified. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24207"></a>
+ id="dx1-25210"></a>
      is obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortuserdescname</span>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10083,17 +10392,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24208"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25211"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style (new to v1.17) is designed to work
      with the <a 
 href="#catattr.markwords"><span 
 class="cmss-10">markwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24209"></a> category attribute. The full form is formatted
+ id="dx1-25212"></a> category attribute. The full form is formatted
      using
-     <!--l. 4787--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 4971--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlonghyphenshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24210"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25213"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlonghyphenshort{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10108,7 +10417,7 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     </p><!--l. 4789--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 4973--><p class="noindent" >
      where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; is the inserted material provided in the final optional argument of
      commands like <span 
@@ -10116,26 +10425,26 @@
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; start with a hyphen, then this locally
      redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep</span><a 
- id="dx1-24211"></a> to a hyphen, which means that if the <a 
+ id="dx1-25214"></a> to a hyphen, which means that if the <a 
 href="#catattr.markwords"><span 
 class="cmss-10">markwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24212"></a>
+ id="dx1-25215"></a>
      attribute is set then the long form will become hyphenated. (If this attribute
      isn’t set, there’s no alteration to the way the long form is displayed.) The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24213"></a>
+ id="dx1-25216"></a>
      key is obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortname</span>.
-     </p><!--l. 4799--><p class="noindent" >Unlike the other &#x27E8;<span 
+     </p><!--l. 4983--><p class="noindent" >Unlike the other &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;) type of styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24214"></a>, this style also
+ id="dx1-25217"></a>, this style also
      repeats the insertion in the parenthetical part, so that the first use form
      is:
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4804--><p class="noindent" ><span 
+         <!--l. 4988--><p class="noindent" ><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlonghyphenfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10145,7 +10454,7 @@
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4807--><p class="noindent" >The space before the parenthetical material is actually given by
+     <!--l. 4991--><p class="noindent" >The space before the parenthetical material is actually given by
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullsep{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -10154,41 +10463,41 @@
      moved into the formatting commands according to the conditional
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsxtrinsertinside</span>.
-     </p><!--l. 4812--><p class="noindent" >For example, if <span 
+     </p><!--l. 4996--><p class="noindent" >For example, if <span 
 class="cmtt-10">ip </span>is defined using:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-118">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-128">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{english}{markwords}{true}
      &#x00A0;<br />\setabbreviationstyle[english]{long-hyphen-short-hyphen}
      &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation[category=english]{ip}{IP}{Internet&#x00A0;Protocol}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4817--><p class="nopar" > then
+     <!--l. 5001--><p class="nopar" > then
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-119">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-129">
      \gls{ip}[-Adressen]
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4821--><p class="nopar" > will do
+     <!--l. 5005--><p class="nopar" > will do
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4824--><p class="noindent" >Internet-Protocol-Adressen (IP-Adressen)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4826--><p class="noindent" >on first use, whereas
+         <!--l. 5008--><p class="noindent" >Internet-Protocol-Adressen (IP-Adressen)</p></div>
+     <!--l. 5010--><p class="noindent" >on first use, whereas
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-120">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-130">
      \gls{ip}[&#x00A0;Address]
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4829--><p class="nopar" > will do
+     <!--l. 5013--><p class="nopar" > will do
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4832--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol Address (IP Address)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4834--><p class="noindent" >on first use.
-     </p><!--l. 4836--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Note that the hyphenation isn’t applied when using commands like
+         <!--l. 5016--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol Address (IP Address)</p></div>
+     <!--l. 5018--><p class="noindent" >on first use.
+     </p><!--l. 5020--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Note that the hyphenation isn’t applied when using commands like
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span>. This means that
                                                                   
@@ -10195,39 +10504,39 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-121">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-131">
      \glsxtrlong{ip}[-Adressen]
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4841--><p class="nopar" > will do
+     <!--l. 5025--><p class="nopar" > will do
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4844--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol-Adressen</p></div>
+         <!--l. 5028--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol-Adressen</p></div>
      </div>
-     <!--l. 4846--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4848--><p class="noindent" >If the <a 
+     <!--l. 5030--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5032--><p class="noindent" >If the <a 
 href="#catattr.markwords"><span 
 class="cmss-10">markwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24215"></a> attribute hadn’t been set, then the first use of
+ id="dx1-25218"></a> attribute hadn’t been set, then the first use of
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-122">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-132">
      \gls{ip}[-Adressen]
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4852--><p class="nopar" > would do
+     <!--l. 5036--><p class="nopar" > would do
          </p><div class="quote">
-         <!--l. 4855--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol-Adressen (IP-Adressen)</p></div>
-     <!--l. 4857--><p class="noindent" >instead.
-     </p><!--l. 4859--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If the inserted material &#x27E8;<span 
+         <!--l. 5039--><p class="noindent" >Internet Protocol-Adressen (IP-Adressen)</p></div>
+     <!--l. 5041--><p class="noindent" >instead.
+     </p><!--l. 5043--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If the inserted material &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; is likely to contain commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>,
      then use <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24216"></a> instead to avoid nested links.
+ id="dx1-25219"></a> instead to avoid nested links.
      </div>
-     </p><!--l. 4863--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4865--><p class="noindent" >If you want the short version in small-caps, you can just redefine
+     </p><!--l. 5047--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5049--><p class="noindent" >If you want the short version in small-caps, you can just redefine
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvhyphenfont </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrhyphensuffix </span>to use the small-caps
@@ -10236,21 +10545,21 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-123">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-133">
      \renewcommand{\glsabbrvhyphenfont}{\glsabbrvscfont}
      &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand{\glsxtrhyphensuffix}{\glsxtrscsuffix}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 4871--><p class="nopar" > Similarly for other font-changing variations.
+     <!--l. 5055--><p class="nopar" > Similarly for other font-changing variations.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24217"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25220"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style is like
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24218"></a> except that the parenthetical part is omitted and
+ id="dx1-25221"></a> except that the parenthetical part is omitted and
      the long form is displayed on subsequent use. The short form can be accessed
      with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>but just uses the default abbreviation font. There’s
@@ -10257,7 +10566,7 @@
      no regular version of this style as the regular form doesn’t have the
      flexibility to deal with the hyphen switch. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24219"></a> is obtained from
+ id="dx1-25222"></a> is obtained from
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongnoshortdescname</span>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10264,37 +10573,37 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-noshort-noreg"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-noshort-noreg</span><a 
- id="dx1-24220"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25223"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">New to version 1.17, this style is like
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-noshort-desc-noreg</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24221"></a> but the name is set to the short form and the
+ id="dx1-25224"></a> but the name is set to the short form and the
      description is set to the long form.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24222"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25225"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">
-     <!--l. 4892--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
+     <!--l. 5076--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24223"></a> but the user
+ id="dx1-25226"></a> but the user
      supplies the description. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24224"></a> is obtained from <span 
+ id="dx1-25227"></a> is obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortdescname</span>.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24225"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25228"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">
-     <!--l. 4899--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
+     <!--l. 5083--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24226"></a> but the
+ id="dx1-25229"></a> but the
      inserted and parenthetical material are moved to the post-link hook. On first
      use, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10317,16 +10626,16 @@
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;
      <br /><spacer type=vertical size=10></span>
      where
-     </p><!--l. 4907--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 5091--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrposthyphenshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24227"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25230"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrposthyphenshort{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;
      </div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4909--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5093--><p class="noindent" >
      is in the post-link hook. This uses the format: <spacer type=vertical size=10><span class="obeylines-h">
      <br />&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; (<span 
@@ -10338,18 +10647,18 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     </p><!--l. 4915--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> The singular short form is always used here, even with <span 
+     </p><!--l. 5099--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> The singular short form is always used here, even with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspl</span>. (Unlike
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-long-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-long-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24228"></a>.) </div>
-     </p><!--l. 4918--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4920--><p class="noindent" >The part in the link-text on first use:
-     </p><!--l. 4921--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-25231"></a>.) </div>
+     </p><!--l. 5102--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5104--><p class="noindent" >The part in the link-text on first use:
+     </p><!--l. 5105--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrlonghyphen</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24229"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25232"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlonghyphen{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">long</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10358,7 +10667,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
      </div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4923--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5107--><p class="noindent" >
      checks if &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; starts with a hyphen. If it does, then <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep </span>is locally
@@ -10371,7 +10680,7 @@
      this style without causing nested hyperlinks, but only for commands like
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.
-     </p><!--l. 4932--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Don’t use <span 
+     </p><!--l. 5116--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Don’t use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>in the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; part for commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span>,
@@ -10378,8 +10687,8 @@
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span>. </div>
-     </p><!--l. 4935--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4937--><p class="noindent" >The inline full display format used by commands like <span 
+     </p><!--l. 5119--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5121--><p class="noindent" >The inline full display format used by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span>
      behaves differently to the first use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>with this style. It’s better
@@ -10394,15 +10703,15 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24230"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25233"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">
-     <!--l. 4944--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
+     <!--l. 5128--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24231"></a>
+ id="dx1-25234"></a>
      but the user supplies the description. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24232"></a> is obtained from
+ id="dx1-25235"></a> is obtained from
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlongshortdescname</span>.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10409,17 +10718,17 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-hyphen-long-hyphen"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-hyphen-long-hyphen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24233"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25236"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style (new to v1.17) is like <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24234"></a>,
+ id="dx1-25237"></a>,
      except that the short form is displayed first followed by the long form in
      parentheses. The full form is formatted using
-     <!--l. 4954--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 5138--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrshorthyphenlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24235"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25238"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshorthyphenlong{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10431,11 +10740,11 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4956--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5140--><p class="noindent" >
      which behaves in an analogous way to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlonghyphenshort</span>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24236"></a> is
+ id="dx1-25239"></a> is
      obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongname</span>.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
@@ -10442,15 +10751,15 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-hyphen-long-hyphen-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24237"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25240"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">
-     <!--l. 4962--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
+     <!--l. 5146--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-hyphen-long-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-hyphen-long-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24238"></a> but the user
+ id="dx1-25241"></a> but the user
      supplies the description. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24239"></a> is obtained from <span 
+ id="dx1-25242"></a> is obtained from <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongdescname</span>.
                                                                   
 
@@ -10459,12 +10768,12 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen</span><a 
- id="dx1-24240"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25243"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This style (new to v1.17) is like
      <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24241"></a>, but the short form is displayed first followed by
+ id="dx1-25244"></a>, but the short form is displayed first followed by
      the long form in parentheses. On first use, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -10487,26 +10796,26 @@
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;
      <br /><spacer type=vertical size=10></span>
      where
-     <!--l. 4977--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 5161--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrposthyphenlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-24242"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-25245"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrposthyphenlong{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;
      </div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 4979--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5163--><p class="noindent" >
      is in the post-link hook. These commands behave in an analogous manner to
      those used with <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-postshort-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24243"></a>. The <span 
+ id="dx1-25246"></a>. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24244"></a> is obtained from
+ id="dx1-25247"></a> is obtained from
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongname</span>.
-     </p><!--l. 4984--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Don’t use <span 
+     </p><!--l. 5168--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> Don’t use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>in the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">insert</span>&#x27E9; part for commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span>,
@@ -10513,8 +10822,8 @@
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong</span>. </div>
-     </p><!--l. 4987--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 4989--><p class="noindent" >The inline full display format used by commands like <span 
+     </p><!--l. 5171--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5173--><p class="noindent" >The inline full display format used by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span>
      behaves differently to the first use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>with this style. It’s better
@@ -10529,29 +10838,29 @@
 <a 
  id="abbrstyle.short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen-desc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen-desc</span><a 
- id="dx1-24245"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-25248"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">
-     <!--l. 4996--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
+     <!--l. 5180--><p class="noindent" >New to version 1.17. This is similar to <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-hyphen-postlong-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-24246"></a>
+ id="dx1-25249"></a>
      but the user supplies the description. The <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-24247"></a> is obtained from
+ id="dx1-25250"></a> is obtained from
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshortlongdescname</span>.
 </p>
      </dd></dl>
-<!--l. 5003--><p class="noindent" >
+<!--l. 5187--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 5003--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 5187--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">3.5   </span> <a 
  id="sec:newabbrvstyle"></a>Defining New Abbreviation Styles</h3>
-<!--l. 5006--><p class="noindent" >New abbreviation styles may be defined using:
-</p><!--l. 5007--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 5190--><p class="noindent" >New abbreviation styles may be defined using:
+</p><!--l. 5191--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\newabbreviationstyle</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25001"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26001"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviationstyle{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10560,76 +10869,76 @@
 class="cmitt-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5009--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5193--><p class="noindent" >
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 5010--><p class="noindent" >where &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 5194--><p class="noindent" >where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; is the name of the new style (as used in the mandatory argument of
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\setabbreviationstyle</span><a 
- id="dx1-25002"></a>). This is similar but not identical to the <span 
+ id="dx1-26002"></a>). This is similar but not identical to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package’s
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronymstyle</span><a 
- id="dx1-25003"></a> command.
-</p><!--l. 5017--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> You can’t use styles defined by <span 
+ id="dx1-26003"></a> command.
+</p><!--l. 5201--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> You can’t use styles defined by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronymstyle </span>with <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>
 unless you have reverted <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-25004"></a> back to its generic definition from
+ id="dx1-26004"></a> back to its generic definition from
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>(using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\RestoreAcronyms</span><a 
- id="dx1-25005"></a>). The acronym styles from the <span 
+ id="dx1-26005"></a>). The acronym styles from the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>
 package can’t be used with abbreviations defined with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span>.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 5024--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5026--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 5208--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5210--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">setup</span>&#x27E9; argument deals with the way the entry is defined and may
 set attributes for the given abbreviation category. This argument should
 redefine
-</p><!--l. 5029--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5213--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\CustomAbbreviationFields</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25006"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26006"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\CustomAbbreviationFields </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5031--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5215--><p class="noindent" >
 to set the entry fields including the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-25007"></a> (defaults to the short form if omitted),
+ id="dx1-26007"></a> (defaults to the short form if omitted),
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-25008"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-26008"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-25009"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-26009"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25010"></a>. Other fields may also be set, such as <span 
+ id="dx1-26010"></a>. Other fields may also be set, such as <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-25011"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-26011"></a>, <span 
 class="cmss-10">plural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25012"></a> and
+ id="dx1-26012"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">description</span><a 
- id="dx1-25013"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 5038--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> <span 
+ id="dx1-26013"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 5222--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\CustomAbbreviationFields </span>is expanded by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>so take care to
 protect commands that shouldn’t be expanded. </div>
-</p><!--l. 5041--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5043--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
+</p><!--l. 5225--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5227--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25014"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-26014"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">setup</span>&#x27E9;:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-124">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-134">
 &#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\CustomAbbreviationFields}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;name={\protect\glsabbrvfont{\the\glsshorttok}},
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;sort={\the\glsshorttok},
@@ -10642,17 +10951,17 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;plural={\protect\glsabbrvfont{\the\glsshortpltok}},%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;description={\the\glslongtok}}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 5057--><p class="nopar" > Note that the <span 
+<!--l. 5241--><p class="nopar" > Note that the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-25015"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-26015"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">firstplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25016"></a> are set even though they’re not used by
+ id="dx1-26016"></a> are set even though they’re not used by
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5061--><p class="indent" >   The basic styles, such as <a 
+</p><!--l. 5245--><p class="indent" >   The basic styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25017"></a>, use commands like <span 
+ id="dx1-26017"></a>, use commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>(which are
 redefined whenever the style formatting is set) within <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\CustomAbbreviationFields</span>.
@@ -10659,7 +10968,7 @@
 Other styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-em-short-em"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-em-short-em</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25018"></a> directly use their own custom commands, such
+ id="dx1-26018"></a> directly use their own custom commands, such
 as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span>. With these styles, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>still need to
@@ -10667,26 +10976,26 @@
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9; argument even if they’re not used within
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\CustomAbbreviationFields</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5070--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 5254--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">setup</span>&#x27E9; argument may also redefine
-</p><!--l. 5071--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5255--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25019"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26019"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5073--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5257--><p class="noindent" >
 which can be used to assign attributes. (This will automatically be initialised to do
 nothing.)
-</p><!--l. 5077--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
+</p><!--l. 5261--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-footnote"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-footnote</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25020"></a> includes the following in &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-26020"></a> includes the following in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">setup</span>&#x27E9;:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-125">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-135">
 &#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation}{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glssetattribute{\the\glslabeltok}{nohyperfirst}{true}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glshasattribute{\the\glslabeltok}{regular}%
@@ -10696,252 +11005,252 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;{}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 5088--><p class="nopar" > This sets the <a 
+<!--l. 5272--><p class="nopar" > This sets the <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyperfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyperfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25021"></a> attribute to “true”. It also unsets the <a 
+ id="dx1-26021"></a> attribute to “true”. It also unsets the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25022"></a> attribute if it
+ id="dx1-26022"></a> attribute if it
 has previously been set. Note that the <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyperfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyperfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25023"></a> attribute doesn’t get unset by
+ id="dx1-26023"></a> attribute doesn’t get unset by
 other styles, so take care not to switch styles for the same category.
-</p><!--l. 5095--><p class="indent" >   You can access the short, long, short plural and long plural values through the
+</p><!--l. 5279--><p class="indent" >   You can access the short, long, short plural and long plural values through the
 following token registers.
-</p><!--l. 5098--><p class="indent" >   Short value (defined by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5282--><p class="indent" >   Short value (defined by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>):
-</p><!--l. 5099--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5283--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsshorttok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25024"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsshorttok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5101--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5103--><p class="indent" >   Short plural value (defined by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5285--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5287--><p class="indent" >   Short plural value (defined by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>):
-</p><!--l. 5104--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5288--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsshortpltok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25025"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26025"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsshortpltok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5106--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5290--><p class="noindent" >
 (This may be the default value or, if provided, the value provided by the user
 through the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25026"></a> key in the optional argument of <span 
+ id="dx1-26026"></a> key in the optional argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-25027"></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 5111--><p class="indent" >   Long value (defined by <span 
+ id="dx1-26027"></a>.)
+</p><!--l. 5295--><p class="indent" >   Long value (defined by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>):
-</p><!--l. 5112--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5296--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongtok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25028"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26028"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongtok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5114--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5116--><p class="indent" >   Long plural value (defined by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5298--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5300--><p class="indent" >   Long plural value (defined by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>):
-</p><!--l. 5117--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5301--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongpltok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26029"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongpltok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5119--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5303--><p class="noindent" >
 (This may be the default value or, if provided, the value provided by the user
 through the <span 
 class="cmss-10">longplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25030"></a> key in the optional argument of <span 
+ id="dx1-26030"></a> key in the optional argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-25031"></a>.)
-</p><!--l. 5124--><p class="indent" >   The short or long values may be modified by attributes (such as <a 
+ id="dx1-26031"></a>.)
+</p><!--l. 5308--><p class="indent" >   The short or long values may be modified by attributes (such as <a 
 href="#catattr.markwords"><span 
 class="cmss-10">markwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25032"></a>). The
+ id="dx1-26032"></a>). The
 above registers reflect the modification. If you want to access the original
 (unmodified) short or long form (as provided in the final two arguments of
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span>), then use the commands:
-</p><!--l. 5129--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5313--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrorgshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrorgshort </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5131--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5315--><p class="noindent" >
 for the short form and
-</p><!--l. 5133--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5317--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrorglong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25034"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26034"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrorglong </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5135--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5319--><p class="noindent" >
 for the long form. (These may be useful for the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-25035"></a> key to avoid any formatting that
+ id="dx1-26035"></a> key to avoid any formatting that
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 may be added by the attribute setting.)
-</p><!--l. 5139--><p class="indent" >   There are two other registers available that are defined by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5323--><p class="indent" >   There are two other registers available that are defined by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>:
-</p><!--l. 5142--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5326--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslabeltok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25036"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26036"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabeltok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5144--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5328--><p class="noindent" >
 which contains the entry’s label and
-</p><!--l. 5146--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5330--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glskeylisttok</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glskeylisttok </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5148--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5332--><p class="noindent" >
 which contains the values provided in the optional argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-25038"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 5152--><p class="indent" >   Remember put <span 
+ id="dx1-26038"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 5336--><p class="indent" >   Remember put <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\the </span>in front of the register command as in the examples above.
 The category label can be access through the command (not a register):
-</p><!--l. 5155--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5339--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glscategorylabel</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25039"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26039"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glscategorylabel </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5157--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5341--><p class="noindent" >
 This may be used inside the definition of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrPostNewAbbreviation</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5161--><p class="indent" >   If you want to base a style on an existing style, you can use
-</p><!--l. 5162--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5345--><p class="indent" >   If you want to base a style on an existing style, you can use
+</p><!--l. 5346--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleSetup</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25040"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26040"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleSetup{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5164--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5348--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; is the name of the existing style. For example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-noshort-sc-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-noshort-sc-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25041"></a>
+ id="dx1-26041"></a>
 style simply does
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-126">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-136">
 \GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleSetup{long-noshort-desc}
 </div>
-<!--l. 5169--><p class="nopar" > within &#x27E8;<span 
+<!--l. 5353--><p class="nopar" > within &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">setup</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 5172--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 5356--><p class="indent" >   The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9; argument deals with the way the entry is displayed in the document.
 This argument should redefine the following commands.
-</p><!--l. 5176--><p class="indent" >   The default suffix for the plural short form (if not overridden by the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5360--><p class="indent" >   The default suffix for the plural short form (if not overridden by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-25042"></a>
+ id="dx1-26042"></a>
 key):
-</p><!--l. 5178--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5362--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\abbrvpluralsuffix</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25043"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26043"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\abbrvpluralsuffix </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5180--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5364--><p class="noindent" >
 (Note that this isn’t used for the plural long form, which just uses the regular
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspluralsuffix</span>.)
-</p><!--l. 5184--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the short form on <a 
- id="dx1-25044"></a><a 
+</p><!--l. 5368--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the short form on <a 
+ id="dx1-26044"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> or in the full forms:
-</p><!--l. 5185--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5369--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstabbrvfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25045"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstabbrvfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5187--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5189--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the short form on subsequent use or through commands like
+</p><!--l. 5371--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5373--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the short form on subsequent use or through commands like
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-25046"></a>:
-</p><!--l. 5191--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26046"></a>:
+</p><!--l. 5375--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsabbrvfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25047"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26047"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5193--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5195--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the long form on <a 
- id="dx1-25048"></a>first use or in the full forms:
-</p><!--l. 5196--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5377--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5379--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the long form on <a 
+ id="dx1-26048"></a>first use or in the full forms:
+</p><!--l. 5380--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfirstlongfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25049"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26049"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirstlongfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5198--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5200--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the long form in commands like <span 
+</p><!--l. 5382--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5384--><p class="indent" >   The font used for the long form in commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrlong </span>use:
-</p><!--l. 5202--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5386--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslongfont</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25050"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26050"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslongfont{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5204--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5206--><p class="indent" >   Display full form singular no case-change (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5388--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5390--><p class="indent" >   Display full form singular no case-change (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-25051"></a> on <a 
- id="dx1-25052"></a>first use for
+ id="dx1-26051"></a> on <a 
+ id="dx1-26052"></a>first use for
 abbreviations without the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25053"></a> attribute set):
-</p><!--l. 5209--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26053"></a> attribute set):
+</p><!--l. 5393--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfullformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25054"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26054"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5211--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5213--><p class="indent" >   Display full form singular first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5395--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5397--><p class="indent" >   Display full form singular first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-25055"></a> on
+ id="dx1-26055"></a> on
 <a 
- id="dx1-25056"></a>first use for abbreviations without the <a 
+ id="dx1-26056"></a>first use for abbreviations without the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25057"></a> attribute set):
-</p><!--l. 5216--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26057"></a> attribute set):
+</p><!--l. 5400--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrfullformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25058"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26058"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfullformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5218--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5220--><p class="indent" >   Display full form plural no case-change (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5402--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5404--><p class="indent" >   Display full form plural no case-change (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25059"></a> on <a 
- id="dx1-25060"></a>first use for
+ id="dx1-26059"></a> on <a 
+ id="dx1-26060"></a>first use for
 abbreviations without the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25061"></a> attribute set):
-</p><!--l. 5223--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26061"></a> attribute set):
+</p><!--l. 5407--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfullplformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25062"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26062"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullplformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10950,42 +11259,42 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 5225--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5227--><p class="indent" >   Display full form plural first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5409--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5411--><p class="indent" >   Display full form plural first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glspl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25063"></a> on
+ id="dx1-26063"></a> on
 <a 
- id="dx1-25064"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-26064"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> for abbreviations without the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25065"></a> attribute set):
-</p><!--l. 5230--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26065"></a> attribute set):
+</p><!--l. 5414--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrfullplformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25066"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26066"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfullplformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5232--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5234--><p class="indent" >   In addition &#x27E8;<span 
+</p><!--l. 5416--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5418--><p class="indent" >   In addition &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9; may also redefine the following commands that govern the inline
 full formats. If the style doesn’t redefine them, they will default to the same as the
 display full forms.
-</p><!--l. 5238--><p class="indent" >   Inline singular no case-change (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5422--><p class="indent" >   Inline singular no case-change (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-25067"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-26067"></a>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-25068"></a> and
+ id="dx1-26068"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-25069"></a>):
-</p><!--l. 5240--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26069"></a>):
+</p><!--l. 5424--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrinlinefullformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25070"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26070"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinlinefullformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -10992,17 +11301,17 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5242--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5244--><p class="indent" >   Inline singular first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5426--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5428--><p class="indent" >   Inline singular first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsentryfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-25071"></a> and
+ id="dx1-26071"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfull</span><a 
- id="dx1-25072"></a>):
-</p><!--l. 5246--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26072"></a>):
+</p><!--l. 5430--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrinlinefullformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25073"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26073"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrinlinefullformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11009,19 +11318,19 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5248--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5250--><p class="indent" >   Inline plural no case-change (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5432--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5434--><p class="indent" >   Inline plural no case-change (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25074"></a>, <span 
+ id="dx1-26074"></a>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25075"></a> and
+ id="dx1-26075"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25076"></a>):
-</p><!--l. 5252--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26076"></a>):
+</p><!--l. 5436--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrinlinefullplformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25077"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26077"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinlinefullplformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11028,17 +11337,17 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5254--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5256--><p class="indent" >   Inline plural first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5438--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5440--><p class="indent" >   Inline plural first letter converted to upper case (used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsentryfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25078"></a> and
+ id="dx1-26078"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrfullpl</span><a 
- id="dx1-25079"></a>):
-</p><!--l. 5258--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-26079"></a>):
+</p><!--l. 5442--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrinlinefullplformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25080"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26080"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrinlinefullplformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11045,44 +11354,44 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5260--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5262--><p class="indent" >   (New to version 1.17.) You can also modify the way the subsequent use is
+</p><!--l. 5444--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5446--><p class="indent" >   (New to version 1.17.) You can also modify the way the subsequent use is
 formatted by redefining the following four commands, but these won’t be used for
 abbreviations with the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25081"></a> attribute set. If the style doesn’t redefine these
+ id="dx1-26081"></a> attribute set. If the style doesn’t redefine these
 commands, the default values are used.
-</p><!--l. 5268--><p class="indent" >   Singular with no case-change:
-</p><!--l. 5269--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5452--><p class="indent" >   Singular with no case-change:
+</p><!--l. 5453--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsubsequentfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25082"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26082"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsubsequentfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5271--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5273--><p class="indent" >   Singular with first letter upper case:
-</p><!--l. 5274--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5455--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5457--><p class="indent" >   Singular with first letter upper case:
+</p><!--l. 5458--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrsubsequentfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25083"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26083"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrsubsequentfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5276--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5460--><p class="noindent" >
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 5278--><p class="indent" >   Plural with no case-change:
-</p><!--l. 5279--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5462--><p class="indent" >   Plural with no case-change:
+</p><!--l. 5463--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsubsequentplfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25084"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26084"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsubsequentplfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11089,12 +11398,12 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5281--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5283--><p class="indent" >   Plural with first letter upper case:
-</p><!--l. 5284--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5465--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5467--><p class="indent" >   Plural with first letter upper case:
+</p><!--l. 5468--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsxtrsubsequentplfmt</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25085"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26085"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsxtrsubsequentplfmt{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11101,10 +11410,10 @@
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5286--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5288--><p class="indent" >   If you want to provide support for <span 
+</p><!--l. 5470--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5472--><p class="indent" >   If you want to provide support for <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-accsupp</span><a 
- id="dx1-25086"></a> use the following
+ id="dx1-26086"></a> use the following
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsaccess</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">xxx</span>&#x27E9; commands (<a 
@@ -11117,20 +11426,20 @@
 class="cmti-10">xxx</span>&#x27E9; commands. (If you
 don’t use <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-accsupp</span><a 
- id="dx1-25087"></a>, they will just do the corresponding <span 
+ id="dx1-26087"></a>, they will just do the corresponding <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentry</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">xxx</span>&#x27E9;
 command.)
-</p><!--l. 5296--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
+</p><!--l. 5480--><p class="indent" >   For example, the <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25088"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-26088"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9;:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-127">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-137">
 &#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\abbrvpluralsuffix}{\glsxtrabbrvpluralsuffix}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\glsabbrvfont}[1]{\glsabbrvdefaultfont{##1}}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\glsfirstabbrvfont}[1]{\glsfirstabbrvdefaultfont{##1}}%
@@ -11159,17 +11468,17 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsxtrparen{\glsfirstlongfont{\glsaccesslongpl{##1}}}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 5326--><p class="nopar" > Since the inline full commands aren’t redefined, they default to the same as the
+<!--l. 5510--><p class="nopar" > Since the inline full commands aren’t redefined, they default to the same as the
 display versions.
-</p><!--l. 5330--><p class="indent" >   If you want to base a style on an existing style, you can use
-</p><!--l. 5331--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5514--><p class="indent" >   If you want to base a style on an existing style, you can use
+</p><!--l. 5515--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleFmts</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-25089"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-26089"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleFmts{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5333--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5517--><p class="noindent" >
 within &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9;, where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; is the name of the existing style. For example, the
@@ -11176,20 +11485,20 @@
 <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short-desc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short-desc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25090"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-26090"></a> style has the following in &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">fmts</span>&#x27E9;:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-128">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-138">
 &#x00A0;&#x00A0;\GlsXtrUseAbbrStyleFmts{long-short}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 5339--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 5341--><p class="indent" >   Here’s an example of an abbreviation style that’s based on <a 
+<!--l. 5523--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 5525--><p class="indent" >   Here’s an example of an abbreviation style that’s based on <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-short"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-short</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25091"></a> that displays
+ id="dx1-26091"></a> that displays
 the short form within <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsf</span>:
                                                                   
@@ -11196,7 +11505,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-129">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-139">
 \newabbreviationstyle
 &#x00A0;<br />{custom-sf}%&#x00A0;label
 &#x00A0;<br />{%&#x00A0;setup
@@ -11207,20 +11516,20 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\renewcommand*{\glsabbrvfont}[1]{\textsf{##1}}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 5354--><p class="nopar" > Note that this wouldn’t work if it was instead based on one of the modified versions
+<!--l. 5538--><p class="nopar" > Note that this wouldn’t work if it was instead based on one of the modified versions
 such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-sc-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-sc-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25092"></a> as they explicitly use their own formatting commands, such as
+ id="dx1-26092"></a> as they explicitly use their own formatting commands, such as
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvemfont</span>. The base styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.short-long"><span 
 class="cmss-10">short-long</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-25093"></a>, use the more generic
+ id="dx1-26093"></a>, use the more generic
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont </span>etc which makes them easier to adapt than the modified
 styles.
-</p><!--l. 5362--><p class="indent" >   For further details, see the “Abbreviations” section in the documented code
+</p><!--l. 5546--><p class="indent" >   For further details, see the “Abbreviations” section in the documented code
 (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">glossaries-extra-code.pdf</span>).
                                                                   
@@ -11227,17 +11536,17 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 5365--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 5365--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 5549--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 5549--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">4. <a 
  id="sec:headtitle"></a>Entries in Sectioning Titles, Headers, Captions and Contents</h2>
-</p><!--l. 5368--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 5552--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>user manual cautions against using commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>in chapter
 or section titles. The principle problems are: </p>
      <ul class="itemize1">
      <li class="itemize">if you have a table of contents, the <a 
- id="dx1-26001"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-27001"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuseflag">first use flag</a> will be unset in the contents
      rather than later in the document;
      </li>
@@ -11254,27 +11563,27 @@
      </li>
      <li class="itemize">if you use <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-26002"></a>, commands like <span 
+ id="dx1-27002"></a>, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>can’t be expanded to a simple
      string and only the label will appear in the PDF bookmark (with a warning
      from <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-26003"></a>);
+ id="dx1-27003"></a>);
      </li>
      <li class="itemize">if you use <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-26004"></a>, you will end up with nested hyperlinks in the table of
+ id="dx1-27004"></a>, you will end up with nested hyperlinks in the table of
      contents.</li></ul>
-<!--l. 5389--><p class="noindent" >Similar problems can also occur with captions (except for the page header and bookmark
+<!--l. 5573--><p class="noindent" >Similar problems can also occur with captions (except for the page header and bookmark
 issues).
-</p><!--l. 5392--><p class="indent" >   To get around all these problems, the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5576--><p class="indent" >   To get around all these problems, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>user manual recommends
 using the expandable non-hyperlink commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrytext</span><a 
- id="dx1-26005"></a>
+ id="dx1-27005"></a>
 (for regular entries) or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-26006"></a> (for abbreviations). This is the
+ id="dx1-27006"></a> (for abbreviations). This is the
 simplest solution, but doesn’t allow for special formatting that’s applied to
 the entry through commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext </span>or <span 
@@ -11282,7 +11591,7 @@
 that if, for example, you are using one of the abbreviation styles that uses
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span><a 
- id="dx1-26007"></a> then the short form displayed with <span 
+ id="dx1-27007"></a> then the short form displayed with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryshort </span>won’t use
 small caps. If you only have one abbreviation style in use, you can explicitly
 enclose <span 
@@ -11295,22 +11604,22 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-130">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-140">
 \chapter{A&#x00A0;Chapter&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\glsabbrvfont{\glsentryshort{html}}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 5405--><p class="nopar" > Or, if you are using <span 
+<!--l. 5589--><p class="nopar" > Or, if you are using <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-26008"></a>:
+ id="dx1-27008"></a>:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-131">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-141">
 \chapter{A&#x00A0;Chapter&#x00A0;about
 &#x00A0;<br />\texorpdfstring{\glsabbrvfont{\glsentryshort{html}}}{\glsentryshort{html}}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 5410--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 5412--><p class="indent" >   Since this is a bit cumbersome, you might want to define a new command to do
+<!--l. 5594--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 5596--><p class="indent" >   Since this is a bit cumbersome, you might want to define a new command to do
 this for you. However, if you have mixed styles this won’t work as commands like
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and <span 
@@ -11323,22 +11632,22 @@
 used by the standard page styles that display the chapter or section title in the page
 header using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\MakeUppercase</span><a 
- id="dx1-26009"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 5423--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+ id="dx1-27009"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 5607--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>package tries to resolve this by modifying <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\markright</span><a 
- id="dx1-26010"></a> and
+ id="dx1-27010"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\markboth</span><a 
- id="dx1-26011"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-27011"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\@starttoc</span>. If you don’t like this change, you can restore their
 former definitions using
-</p><!--l. 5426--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5610--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrRevertMarks</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26012"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27012"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrRevertMarks </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5428--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5612--><p class="noindent" >
 In this case, you’ll have to use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>manual’s recommendations of either
 simply using <span 
@@ -11349,10 +11658,10 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-132">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-142">
 \chapter[A&#x00A0;Chapter&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\glsentryshort{html}]{A&#x00A0;Chapter&#x00A0;about&#x00A0;\gls{html}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 5435--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively, you need to find a way to insert <span 
+<!--l. 5619--><p class="nopar" > Alternatively, you need to find a way to insert <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrmarkhook </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\@glsxtrinmark</span>
 at the start of the header or table of contents either scoped or afterwards cancelled
@@ -11359,36 +11668,36 @@
 with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\@glsxtrnotinmark </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrrestoremarkhook</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5441--><p class="indent" >   If you don’t revert the mark commands back with <span 
+</p><!--l. 5625--><p class="indent" >   If you don’t revert the mark commands back with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrRevertMarks</span>, you can
 use the commands described below in the argument of sectioning commands. You can
 still use them even if the mark commands have been reverted, but only where they
 don’t conflict with the page style.
-</p><!--l. 5447--><p class="indent" >   The commands listed below all use <span 
+</p><!--l. 5631--><p class="indent" >   The commands listed below all use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\texorpdfstring</span><a 
- id="dx1-26013"></a> if <span 
+ id="dx1-27013"></a> if <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-26014"></a> has been
+ id="dx1-27014"></a> has been
 loaded so that the expandable non-formatted version is added to the PDF
 bookmarks. Note that since the commands that convert the first letter to
 upper case aren’t expandable, the non-case-changing version is used for the
 bookmarks.
-</p><!--l. 5453--><p class="indent" >   These commands essentially behave as though you have used <span 
+</p><!--l. 5637--><p class="indent" >   These commands essentially behave as though you have used <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrshort </span>(or
 equivalent) with the options <span 
 class="cmss-10">noindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-26015"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-27015"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyper=false</span><a 
- id="dx1-26016"></a>. The text produced won’t be
+ id="dx1-27016"></a>. The text produced won’t be
 converted to upper case in the page headings by default. If you want the text
 converted to upper case you need to set the <a 
 href="#catattr.headuc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">headuc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-26017"></a> attribute to “true” for the
+ id="dx1-27017"></a> attribute to “true” for the
 appropriate category.
-</p><!--l. 5461--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use one of the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5645--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you use one of the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\textsc</span><a 
- id="dx1-26018"></a> styles, be aware that the default fonts don’t
+ id="dx1-27018"></a> styles, be aware that the default fonts don’t
 provide bold small-caps or italic small-caps. This means that if the chapter
 or section title style uses bold, this may override the small-caps setting,
 in which case the abbreviation will just appear as lower case bold. If the
@@ -11397,322 +11706,322 @@
 class="cmti-10">even if you have set the </span><a 
 href="#catattr.headuc"><span 
 class="cmssi-10">headuc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-26019"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27019"></a> <span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute </span>since the all-capitals form still uses
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsabbrvfont</span>. You may want to consider using the <span 
 class="cmss-10">slantsc</span><a 
- id="dx1-26020"></a> package in this case.
+ id="dx1-27020"></a> package in this case.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 5472--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5474--><p class="indent" >   Display the short form:
-</p><!--l. 5475--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5656--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5658--><p class="indent" >   Display the short form:
+</p><!--l. 5659--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26021"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27021"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtshort{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5477--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5479--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural short form:
-</p><!--l. 5480--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5661--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5663--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural short form:
+</p><!--l. 5664--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtshortpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26022"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27022"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtshortpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5482--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5484--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular short form:
-</p><!--l. 5485--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5666--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5668--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular short form:
+</p><!--l. 5669--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtshort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26023"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27023"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtshort{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5487--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5671--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5490--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural short form:
+</p><!--l. 5674--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural short form:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 5491--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5675--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtshortpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26024"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtshortpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5493--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5677--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5496--><p class="indent" >   Display the long form:
-</p><!--l. 5497--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5680--><p class="indent" >   Display the long form:
+</p><!--l. 5681--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26025"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27025"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtlong{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5499--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5501--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural long form:
-</p><!--l. 5502--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5683--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5685--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural long form:
+</p><!--l. 5686--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtlongpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26026"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27026"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtlongpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5504--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5506--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular long form:
-</p><!--l. 5507--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5688--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5690--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular long form:
+</p><!--l. 5691--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtlong</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtlong{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5509--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5693--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5512--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural long form:
-</p><!--l. 5513--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5696--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural long form:
+</p><!--l. 5697--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtlongpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26028"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27028"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtlongpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5515--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5699--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5518--><p class="indent" >   There are similar commands for the full form, but note that these use the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5702--><p class="indent" >   There are similar commands for the full form, but note that these use the <span 
 class="cmti-10">inline</span>
 full form, which may be different from the full form used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5522--><p class="indent" >   Display the full form:
-</p><!--l. 5523--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5706--><p class="indent" >   Display the full form:
+</p><!--l. 5707--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtfull</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26029"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27029"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtfull{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5525--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5527--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural full form:
-</p><!--l. 5528--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5709--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5711--><p class="indent" >   Display the plural full form:
+</p><!--l. 5712--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtfullpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtfullpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5530--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5532--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular full form:
-</p><!--l. 5533--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5714--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5716--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case singular full form:
+</p><!--l. 5717--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtfull</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26031"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27031"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtfull{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5535--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5719--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5538--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural full form:
-</p><!--l. 5539--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5722--><p class="indent" >   First letter upper case plural full form:
+</p><!--l. 5723--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtfullpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26032"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27032"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtfullpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5541--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5725--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5544--><p class="indent" >   There are also equivalent commands for the value of the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5728--><p class="indent" >   There are also equivalent commands for the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">text</span><a 
- id="dx1-26033"></a> field:
-</p><!--l. 5546--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-27033"></a> field:
+</p><!--l. 5730--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmttext</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26034"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27034"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmttext{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5548--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5550--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
-</p><!--l. 5551--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5732--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5734--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
+</p><!--l. 5735--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmttext</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26035"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27035"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmttext{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5553--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5737--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5556--><p class="indent" >   The plural equivalents:
+</p><!--l. 5740--><p class="indent" >   The plural equivalents:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 5557--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5741--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtplural</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26036"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27036"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtplural{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5559--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5743--><p class="noindent" >
 and
-</p><!--l. 5561--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5745--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtplural</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtplural{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5563--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5565--><p class="indent" >   Likewise for the value of the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5747--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5749--><p class="indent" >   Likewise for the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-26038"></a> field:
-</p><!--l. 5567--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-27038"></a> field:
+</p><!--l. 5751--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26039"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27039"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5569--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5571--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
-</p><!--l. 5572--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5753--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5755--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
+</p><!--l. 5756--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26040"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27040"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5574--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5758--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5577--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the value of the <span 
+</p><!--l. 5761--><p class="indent" >   Similarly for the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-26041"></a> field:
-</p><!--l. 5579--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-27041"></a> field:
+</p><!--l. 5763--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtfirst</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26042"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27042"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtfirst{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5581--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 5583--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
-</p><!--l. 5584--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5765--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5767--><p class="indent" >   First letter converted to upper case:
+</p><!--l. 5768--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtfirst</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26043"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27043"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtfirst{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5586--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5770--><p class="noindent" >
 (No case-change applied to PDF bookmarks.)
-</p><!--l. 5589--><p class="indent" >   The plural equivalents:
-</p><!--l. 5590--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5773--><p class="indent" >   The plural equivalents:
+</p><!--l. 5774--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsfmtfirstpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26044"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27044"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtfirstpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5592--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5776--><p class="noindent" >
 and
-</p><!--l. 5594--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5778--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\Glsfmtfirstpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-26045"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-27045"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfmtfirstpl{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5596--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5780--><p class="noindent" >
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 5598--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 5598--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 5782--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 5782--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">5. <a 
  id="sec:categories"></a>Categories</h2>
-</p><!--l. 5601--><p class="indent" >   Each entry defined by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5785--><p class="indent" >   Each entry defined by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry</span><a 
- id="dx1-27001"></a> (or commands that internally use it
+ id="dx1-28001"></a> (or commands that internally use it
 such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27002"></a>) is assigned a category through the <span 
+ id="dx1-28002"></a>) is assigned a category through the <span 
 class="cmss-10">category</span><a 
- id="dx1-27003"></a> key. You may
+ id="dx1-28003"></a> key. You may
 add any category that you like, but since the category is a label used in the creation
 of some control sequences, avoid problematic characters within the category label.
 (So take care if you have <span 
 class="cmss-10">babel</span><a 
- id="dx1-27004"></a> shorthands on that make some characters
+ id="dx1-28004"></a> shorthands on that make some characters
 active.)
-</p><!--l. 5610--><p class="indent" >   The use of categories can give you more control over the way entries are displayed
+</p><!--l. 5794--><p class="indent" >   The use of categories can give you more control over the way entries are displayed
 in the text or glossary. Note that an entry’s category is independent of the glossary
 type. Be careful not to confuse <span 
 class="cmss-10">category</span><a 
- id="dx1-27005"></a> with <span 
+ id="dx1-28005"></a> with <span 
 class="cmss-10">type</span><a 
- id="dx1-27006"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 5615--><p class="indent" >   The default category assumed by <span 
+ id="dx1-28006"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 5799--><p class="indent" >   The default category assumed by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newglossaryentry </span>is labelled <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-27007"></a>.
+ id="dx1-28007"></a>.
 Abbreviations defined with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation </span>have the category set to <span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27008"></a>
+ id="dx1-28008"></a>
 by default. Abbreviations defined with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newacronym </span>have the category set to
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-27009"></a> by default.
-</p><!--l. 5622--><p class="indent" >   Additionally, if you have enabled <span 
+ id="dx1-28009"></a> by default.
+</p><!--l. 5806--><p class="indent" >   Additionally, if you have enabled <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newterm</span><a 
- id="dx1-27010"></a> with the <a 
+ id="dx1-28010"></a> with the <a 
 href="#styopt.index"><span 
 class="cmss-10">index</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27011"></a> package option
+ id="dx1-28011"></a> package option
 that command will set the category to <span 
 class="cmss-10">index</span><a 
- id="dx1-27012"></a> by default. If you have enabled
+ id="dx1-28012"></a> by default. If you have enabled
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewsymbol</span><a 
- id="dx1-27013"></a> with the <a 
+ id="dx1-28013"></a> with the <a 
 href="#styopt.symbols"><span 
 class="cmss-10">symbols</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27014"></a> package option, that command will set the
+ id="dx1-28014"></a> package option, that command will set the
 category to <span 
 class="cmss-10">symbol</span><a 
- id="dx1-27015"></a>. If you have enabled <span 
+ id="dx1-28015"></a>. If you have enabled <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrnewnumber</span><a 
- id="dx1-27016"></a> with the <a 
+ id="dx1-28016"></a> with the <a 
 href="#styopt.numbers"><span 
 class="cmss-10">numbers</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27017"></a> package
+ id="dx1-28017"></a> package
 option, that command will set the category to <span 
 class="cmss-10">number</span><a 
- id="dx1-27018"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 5630--><p class="indent" >   You can obtain the category label for a given entry using
-</p><!--l. 5631--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-28018"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 5814--><p class="indent" >   You can obtain the category label for a given entry using
+</p><!--l. 5815--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glscategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27019"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28019"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glscategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5633--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5817--><p class="noindent" >
 This is equivalent to commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryname </span>and so may be used in an
 expandable context. No error is generated if the entry doesn’t exist.
-</p><!--l. 5638--><p class="indent" >   You can test the category for a given entry using
-</p><!--l. 5639--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 5822--><p class="indent" >   You can test the category for a given entry using
+</p><!--l. 5823--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifcategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27020"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28020"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifcategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -11724,12 +12033,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 5642--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 5826--><p class="noindent" >
 This is equivalent to </p><div class="alltt">
 <div class="obeylines-v">
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsfieldeq</span><a 
- id="dx1-27021"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-28021"></a><span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span><span 
@@ -11750,15 +12059,15 @@
 </div> so any restrictions that apply to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifglsfieldeq </span>also apply to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifcategory</span>.
-<!--l. 5651--><p class="indent" >   Each category may have a set of attributes. For example, the <span 
+<!--l. 5835--><p class="indent" >   Each category may have a set of attributes. For example, the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-27022"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-28022"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">acronym</span><a 
- id="dx1-27023"></a>
+ id="dx1-28023"></a>
 categories have the attribute <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27024"></a> set to “true” to indicate that all entries with
+ id="dx1-28024"></a> set to “true” to indicate that all entries with
 either of those categories are regular entries (as opposed to abbreviations).
 This attribute is accessed by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryfmt </span>to determine whether to use
@@ -11765,25 +12074,25 @@
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgenentryfmt </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrgenabbrvfmt</span>.
-</p><!--l. 5659--><p class="indent" >   Other attributes recognised by <span 
+</p><!--l. 5843--><p class="indent" >   Other attributes recognised by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>are:
      </p><dl class="description"><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.nohyperfirst"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nohyperfirst</span><a 
- id="dx1-27025"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28025"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">When using commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27026"></a> this will automatically suppress the
+ id="dx1-28026"></a> this will automatically suppress the
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
      hyperlink on <a 
- id="dx1-27027"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-28027"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> for entries with a category that has this attribute set to
      “true”. (This settings can be overridden by explicitly setting the <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyper</span><a 
- id="dx1-27028"></a> key on
+ id="dx1-28028"></a> key on
      or off in the optional argument of commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.) As from version 1.07,
      <span 
@@ -11791,7 +12100,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsfirst</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GLSfirst </span>and their plural versions (which should
      ideally behave in a similar way to the <a 
- id="dx1-27029"></a>first use of <span 
+ id="dx1-28029"></a>first use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspl</span>) now honour
      this attribute (but not the package-wide <a 
@@ -11798,37 +12107,37 @@
 href="#styopt.hyperfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperfirst</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=false</span><a 
- id="dx1-27030"></a> option, which
+ id="dx1-28030"></a> option, which
      matches the behaviour of <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span><a 
- id="dx1-27031"></a>). If you want commands these
+ id="dx1-28031"></a>). If you want commands these
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfirst </span>etc commands to ignore the <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyperfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyperfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27032"></a> attribute then just
+ id="dx1-28032"></a> attribute then just
      redefine
-     <!--l. 5676--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 5860--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrchecknohyperfirst</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27033"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28033"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrchecknohyperfirst{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 5678--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5862--><p class="noindent" >
      to do nothing.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.nohyper"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">nohyper</span><a 
- id="dx1-27034"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28034"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">When using commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27035"></a> this will automatically suppress the
+ id="dx1-28035"></a> this will automatically suppress the
      hyperlink for entries with a category that has this attribute set to “true”. (This
      settings can be overridden by explicitly setting the <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyper</span><a 
- id="dx1-27036"></a> key on or off in the
+ id="dx1-28036"></a> key on or off in the
      optional argument of commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
@@ -11835,31 +12144,31 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.indexonlyfirst"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">indexonlyfirst</span><a 
- id="dx1-27037"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28037"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is similar to the <a 
 href="#styopt.indexonlyfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexonlyfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27038"></a> package option but only for entries
+ id="dx1-28038"></a> package option but only for entries
      that have a category with this attribute set to “true”.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.wrgloss"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">wrgloss</span><a 
- id="dx1-27039"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28039"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">When using commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27040"></a>, if this attribute is set to “after”, it will
+ id="dx1-28040"></a>, if this attribute is set to “after”, it will
      automatically implement <span 
 class="cmss-10">wrgloss</span><a 
- id="dx1-27041"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-28041"></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=after</span>. (New to v1.14.)
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.discardperiod"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">discardperiod</span><a 
- id="dx1-27042"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28042"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If set to “true”, the post-<a 
- id="dx1-27043"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-28043"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> hook will discard a&#x00A0;full stop
      (period) that follows <span 
 class="cmti-10">non-plural </span>commands like <span 
@@ -11866,25 +12175,25 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>or <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>. (Provided
      for entries such as abbreviations that end with a full stop.)
-     <!--l. 5701--><p class="noindent" >Note that this can cause a problem if you access a field that doesn’t end with a
+     <!--l. 5885--><p class="noindent" >Note that this can cause a problem if you access a field that doesn’t end with a
      full stop. For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-133">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-143">
      \newabbreviation
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;[user1={German&#x00A0;Speaking&#x00A0;\TeX\&#x00A0;User&#x00A0;Group}]
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{dante}{DANTE&#x00A0;e.V.}{Deutschsprachige&#x00A0;Anwendervereinigung&#x00A0;\TeX\
      &#x00A0;<br />e.V.}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5708--><p class="nopar" > Here the <span 
+     <!--l. 5892--><p class="nopar" > Here the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-27044"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-28044"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-27045"></a> fields end with a full stop, but the <span 
+ id="dx1-28045"></a> fields end with a full stop, but the <span 
 class="cmss-10">user1</span><a 
- id="dx1-27046"></a> field doesn’t.
+ id="dx1-28046"></a> field doesn’t.
      The simplest solution in this situation is to put the sentence terminator in the
      final optional argument. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -11891,11 +12200,11 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-134">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-144">
      \glsuseri{dante}[.]
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5715--><p class="nopar" > This will bring the punctuation character inside the <a 
- id="dx1-27047"></a><a 
+     <!--l. 5899--><p class="nopar" > This will bring the punctuation character inside the <a 
+ id="dx1-28047"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a> and it won’t be
      discarded.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
@@ -11902,12 +12211,12 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.pluraldiscardperiod"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">pluraldiscardperiod</span><a 
- id="dx1-27048"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28048"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true” <span 
 class="cmti-10">and </span>the <a 
 href="#catattr.discardperiod"><span 
 class="cmss-10">discardperiod</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27049"></a> attribute is
+ id="dx1-28049"></a> attribute is
      set to “true”, this will behave as above for the plural commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspl </span>or
      <span 
@@ -11916,17 +12225,17 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.retainfirstuseperiod"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">retainfirstuseperiod</span><a 
- id="dx1-27050"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28050"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true” then the full stop won’t be
      discarded for <a 
- id="dx1-27051"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-28051"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a> instances, even if <a 
 href="#catattr.discardperiod"><span 
 class="cmss-10">discardperiod</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27052"></a> or <a 
+ id="dx1-28052"></a> or <a 
 href="#catattr.pluraldiscardperiod"><span 
 class="cmss-10">pluraldiscardperiod</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27053"></a> are
+ id="dx1-28053"></a> are
      set. This is useful for &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">short</span>&#x27E9; (&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">long</span>&#x27E9;) abbreviation styles where only the short form
@@ -11935,52 +12244,52 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.markwords"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">markwords</span><a 
- id="dx1-27054"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28054"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true” any entry defined using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27055"></a>
+ id="dx1-28055"></a>
      will automatically have spaces in the long form replaced with
-     <!--l. 5734--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     <!--l. 5918--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrwordsep</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27056"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28056"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 5736--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5920--><p class="noindent" >
      and each word is encapsulated with
-     </p><!--l. 5738--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+     </p><!--l. 5922--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrword</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27057"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28057"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrword{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">word</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-     </p><!--l. 5740--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5924--><p class="noindent" >
      For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-135">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-145">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{abbreviation}{markwords}{true}
      &#x00A0;<br />\newabbreviation{ip}{IP}{Internet&#x00A0;Protocol}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5745--><p class="nopar" > is essentially the same as
+     <!--l. 5929--><p class="nopar" > is essentially the same as
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-136">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-146">
      \newabbreviation{ip}{IP}
      &#x00A0;<br />{\glsxtrword{Internet}\glsxtrwordsep\glsxtrword{Protocol}}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5750--><p class="nopar" > The “hyphen” styles, such as <a 
+     <!--l. 5934--><p class="nopar" > The “hyphen” styles, such as <a 
 href="#abbrstyle.long-hyphen-short-hyphen"><span 
 class="cmss-10">long-hyphen-short-hyphen</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27058"></a>, take advantage of this
+ id="dx1-28058"></a>, take advantage of this
      markup. If the inserted material (provided in the final argument of commands
      like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27059"></a>) starts with a hyphen then <span 
+ id="dx1-28059"></a>) starts with a hyphen then <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep </span>is locally redefined to a
      hyphen. (The default value is a space). Note that this only applies to
      commands like <span 
@@ -11991,51 +12300,51 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-137">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-147">
      \newcommand{\hyplong}[2][]{%
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{\def\glsxtrwordsep{-}\glsxtrlong[#1]{#2}}}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5762--><p class="nopar" >
-     </p><!--l. 5764--><p class="noindent" >This setting will also adjust the long plural.
-     </p><!--l. 5766--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> This setting may result in the <span 
+     <!--l. 5946--><p class="nopar" >
+     </p><!--l. 5948--><p class="noindent" >This setting will also adjust the long plural.
+     </p><!--l. 5950--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> This setting may result in the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrword </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep </span>markup
      ending up in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-27060"></a> field, depending on the style in use. </div>
-     </p><!--l. 5770--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="dx1-28060"></a> field, depending on the style in use. </div>
+     </p><!--l. 5954--><p class="noindent" >
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.markshortwords"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">markshortwords</span><a 
- id="dx1-27061"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28061"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This is similar to <a 
 href="#catattr.markwords"><span 
 class="cmss-10">markwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27062"></a> but applies to the short form. (Only
+ id="dx1-28062"></a> but applies to the short form. (Only
      useful for abbreviations that contain spaces.)
-     <!--l. 5776--><p class="noindent" >This setting will only adjust the short plural if the <span 
+     <!--l. 5960--><p class="noindent" >This setting will only adjust the short plural if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27063"></a> key isn’t used.
+ id="dx1-28063"></a> key isn’t used.
      This setting will take precedence over <a 
 href="#catattr.insertdots"><span 
 class="cmss-10">insertdots</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27064"></a>.
-     </p><!--l. 5780--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> This setting may result in the <span 
+ id="dx1-28064"></a>.
+     </p><!--l. 5964--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> This setting may result in the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrword </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrwordsep </span>markup
      ending up in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-27065"></a> field, depending on the style in use. </div>
-     </p><!--l. 5784--><p class="noindent" >
+ id="dx1-28065"></a> field, depending on the style in use. </div>
+     </p><!--l. 5968--><p class="noindent" >
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.insertdots"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">insertdots</span><a 
- id="dx1-27066"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28066"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true” any entry defined using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27067"></a>
+ id="dx1-28067"></a>
      will automatically have full stops (periods) inserted after each letter. The entry
      will be defined with those dots present as though they had been present in the
      &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12049,27 +12358,27 @@
 class="cmti-10">incompatible with </span><a 
 href="#catattr.markshortwords"><span 
 class="cmssi-10">markshortwords</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27068"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-28068"></a><span 
 class="cmti-10">.</span>
-     <!--l. 5796--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you explicitly override the short plural using the <span 
+     <!--l. 5980--><p class="noindent" ><div class="important" title="Important Note"> If you explicitly override the short plural using the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27069"></a> key, you must
+ id="dx1-28069"></a> key, you must
      explicitly insert the dots yourself (since there’s no way for the code to
      determine if the plural has a suffix that shouldn’t be followed by a dot).
      </div>
-     </p><!--l. 5802--><p class="noindent" >
-     </p><!--l. 5804--><p class="noindent" >This attribute is best used with the <a 
+     </p><!--l. 5986--><p class="noindent" >
+     </p><!--l. 5988--><p class="noindent" >This attribute is best used with the <a 
 href="#catattr.discardperiod"><span 
 class="cmss-10">discardperiod</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27070"></a> attribute set to “true”.
+ id="dx1-28070"></a> attribute set to “true”.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.aposplural"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">aposplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27071"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28071"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true”, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27072"></a> will insert an
+ id="dx1-28072"></a> will insert an
      apostrophe (’) before the plural suffix for the <span 
 class="cmti-10">short </span>plural form (unless
                                                                   
@@ -12077,24 +12386,24 @@
                                                                   
      explicitly overridden with the <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27073"></a> key). The long plural form is
+ id="dx1-28073"></a> key). The long plural form is
      unaffected by this setting. This setting overrides <a 
 href="#catattr.noshortplural"><span 
 class="cmss-10">noshortplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27074"></a>.
+ id="dx1-28074"></a>.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.noshortplural"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">noshortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27075"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28075"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true”, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newabbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-27076"></a> won’t append the
+ id="dx1-28076"></a> won’t append the
      plural suffix for the short plural form. This means the <span 
 class="cmss-10">short</span><a 
- id="dx1-27077"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-28077"></a> and <span 
 class="cmss-10">shortplural</span><a 
- id="dx1-27078"></a>
+ id="dx1-28078"></a>
      values will be the same unless explicitly overridden. <span 
 class="cmti-10">This setting is incompatible</span>
      <span 
@@ -12101,28 +12410,28 @@
 class="cmti-10">with </span><a 
 href="#catattr.aposplural"><span 
 class="cmssi-10">aposplural</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27079"></a><span 
+ id="dx1-28079"></a><span 
 class="cmti-10">.</span>
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.headuc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">headuc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27080"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28080"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true”, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfmtshort</span><a 
- id="dx1-27081"></a> will use the
+ id="dx1-28081"></a> will use the
      upper case version in the page headers.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.tagging"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">tagging</span><a 
- id="dx1-27082"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28082"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If this attribute is set to “true”, the tagging command defined by
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableInitialTagging</span><a 
- id="dx1-27083"></a> will be activated to use <span 
+ id="dx1-28083"></a> will be activated to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrtagfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-27084"></a> in
+ id="dx1-28084"></a> in
      the glossary (see <a 
 href="#sec:tagging"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>3.1 </a><a 
@@ -12131,11 +12440,11 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.entrycount"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">entrycount</span><a 
- id="dx1-27085"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28085"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">Unlike the above attributes, this attribute isn’t boolean but instead must
      be an integer value and is used in combination with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span><a 
- id="dx1-27086"></a>
+ id="dx1-28086"></a>
      (see <a 
 href="#sec:entrycountmods"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.4 </a><a 
@@ -12143,11 +12452,11 @@
      categories that shouldn’t have this facility enabled. The value of this attribute
      is used by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifcounttrigger</span><a 
- id="dx1-27087"></a> to determine how commands such as <span 
+ id="dx1-28087"></a> to determine how commands such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27088"></a>
+ id="dx1-28088"></a>
      should behave.
-     <!--l. 5837--><p class="noindent" >With <span 
+     <!--l. 6021--><p class="noindent" >With <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls </span>use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglsformat </span>only if the previous
@@ -12156,7 +12465,7 @@
      for entries that have the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27089"></a> attribute set and where the previous
+ id="dx1-28089"></a> attribute set and where the previous
      usage count for that entry is less than or equal to the value of that
      attribute.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
@@ -12163,11 +12472,11 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.linkcount"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">linkcount</span><a 
- id="dx1-27090"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28090"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This attribute is set to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true </span>by <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting</span><a 
- id="dx1-27091"></a> (see <a 
+ id="dx1-28091"></a> (see <a 
 href="#sec:linkcount"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>6.2
      </a><a 
@@ -12176,11 +12485,11 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.linkcountmaster"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">linkcountmaster</span><a 
- id="dx1-27092"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28092"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">This attribute is set to the name of the master counter by
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting</span><a 
- id="dx1-27093"></a> if the optional argument is provided (see <a 
+ id="dx1-28093"></a> if the optional argument is provided (see <a 
 href="#sec:linkcount"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>6.2
      </a><a 
@@ -12189,10 +12498,10 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.glossdesc"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">glossdesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27094"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28094"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentrydesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27095"></a> command (used in the predefined glossary styles) is
+ id="dx1-28095"></a> command (used in the predefined glossary styles) is
      modified by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>to check for this attribute. The attribute may have
      one of the following values:
@@ -12201,7 +12510,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">firstuc</span>: the first letter of the description will be converted to upper
          case (using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glsentrydesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27096"></a>).
+ id="dx1-28096"></a>).
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -12210,28 +12519,28 @@
 class="cmtt-10">title</span>: the description will be used in the argument of the title casing
          command <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\capitalisewords</span><a 
- id="dx1-27097"></a> (provided by <span 
+ id="dx1-28097"></a> (provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">mfirstuc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27098"></a>). If you want to use a
+ id="dx1-28098"></a>). If you want to use a
          different command you can redefine:
-         <!--l. 5865--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+         <!--l. 6049--><p class="noindent" ><hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27099"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28099"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">phrase cs</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
          </div><hr>
-         </p><!--l. 5867--><p class="noindent" >
+         </p><!--l. 6051--><p class="noindent" >
          For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-         <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-138">
+         <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-148">
          \newcommand*{\glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs}[1]{\xcapitalisefmtwords*{#1}}
 </div>
-         <!--l. 5871--><p class="nopar" > (Note that the argument to <span 
+         <!--l. 6055--><p class="nopar" > (Note that the argument to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrfieldtitlecasecs </span>will be a control
          sequence whose replacement text is the entry’s description, which is why
          <span 
@@ -12239,20 +12548,20 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\capitalisefmtwords</span>.)
 </p>
          </li></ul>
-     <!--l. 5878--><p class="noindent" >Any other values of this attribute are ignored. Remember that there are design
+     <!--l. 6062--><p class="noindent" >Any other values of this attribute are ignored. Remember that there are design
      limitations for both the first letter uppercasing and the title casing commands.
      See the <span 
 class="cmss-10">mfirstuc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27100"></a> user manual for further details.
+ id="dx1-28100"></a> user manual for further details.
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.glossdescfont"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">glossdescfont</span><a 
- id="dx1-27101"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28101"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">(New to version 1.04) In addition to the above, the modified
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentrydesc</span><a 
- id="dx1-27102"></a> command also checks this attribute. If set, it should be the
+ id="dx1-28102"></a> command also checks this attribute. If set, it should be the
      name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash) that takes one
      argument. This control sequence will be applied to the description text. For
      example:
@@ -12259,34 +12568,34 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-139">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-149">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{glossdescfont}{emph}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5891--><p class="nopar" >
+     <!--l. 6075--><p class="nopar" >
      </p></dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.glossname"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">glossname</span><a 
- id="dx1-27103"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28103"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">As <a 
 href="#catattr.glossdesc"><span 
 class="cmss-10">glossdesc</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27104"></a> but applies to <span 
+ id="dx1-28104"></a> but applies to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-27105"></a>. Additionally, if this
+ id="dx1-28105"></a>. Additionally, if this
      attribute is set to “uc” the name is converted to all capitals.
      </dd><dt class="description">
 <a 
  id="catattr.indexname"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">indexname</span><a 
- id="dx1-27106"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28106"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If set, the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostnamehook </span>hook used at the end of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-27107"></a>
+ id="dx1-28107"></a>
      will index the entry using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\index</span><a 
- id="dx1-27108"></a>. See <a 
+ id="dx1-28108"></a>. See <a 
 href="#sec:autoindex"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:autoindex">Auto-Indexing<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:autoindex --></a> for further
@@ -12295,11 +12604,11 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.glossnamefont"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">glossnamefont</span><a 
- id="dx1-27109"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28109"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">(New to version 1.04) In addition to the above, the modified
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-27110"></a> command also checks this attribute. If set, it should be the
+ id="dx1-28110"></a> command also checks this attribute. If set, it should be the
      name of a control sequence (without the leading backslash) that takes one
      argument. This control sequence will be applied to the name text. For
      example:
@@ -12306,13 +12615,13 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-140">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-150">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{glossnamefont}{emph}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5911--><p class="nopar" > Note that this overrides <span 
+     <!--l. 6095--><p class="nopar" > Note that this overrides <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsnamefont </span>which will only be used if this attribute
      hasn’t been set.
-     </p><!--l. 5915--><p class="noindent" >Remember that glossary styles may additionally apply a font change,
+     </p><!--l. 6099--><p class="noindent" >Remember that glossary styles may additionally apply a font change,
      such as the list styles which put the name in the optional argument of
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\item</span>.
@@ -12320,7 +12629,7 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.textformat"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">textformat</span><a 
- id="dx1-27111"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28111"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">(New to version 1.21.) Commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext </span>have the link
@@ -12335,7 +12644,7 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.hyperoutside"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">hyperoutside</span><a 
- id="dx1-27112"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28112"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">(New to v1.21.) The attribute value may be <span 
 class="cmtt-10">false</span>, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true </span>or unset. If
@@ -12342,7 +12651,7 @@
      unset, <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true </span>is assumed. This indicates the default setting of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperoutside</span><a 
- id="dx1-27113"></a>
+ id="dx1-28113"></a>
      key, described in <a 
 href="#sec:wrglossary"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.1 </a><a 
@@ -12351,16 +12660,16 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.dualindex"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">dualindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-27114"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28114"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If set, whenever a glossary entry has information written to the external
      glossary file through commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-27115"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-28115"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsadd</span><a 
- id="dx1-27116"></a>, a&#x00A0;corresponding line
+ id="dx1-28116"></a>, a&#x00A0;corresponding line
      will be written to the indexing file using <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\index</span><a 
- id="dx1-27117"></a>. See <a 
+ id="dx1-28117"></a>. See <a 
 href="#sec:autoindex"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>7 </a><a 
 href="#sec:autoindex">Auto-Indexing<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:autoindex --></a> for
@@ -12369,7 +12678,7 @@
 <a 
  id="catattr.targeturl"></a><span 
 class="cmssbx-10">targeturl</span><a 
- id="dx1-27118"></a> </dt><dd 
+ id="dx1-28118"></a> </dt><dd 
 class="description">If set, the hyperlink generated by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>will be set to the
      URL provided by this attributes value. For example:
@@ -12376,10 +12685,10 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-141">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-151">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targeturl}{master-doc.pdf}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5945--><p class="nopar" > (See also the accompanying sample file <span 
+     <!--l. 6129--><p class="nopar" > (See also the accompanying sample file <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample-external.tex</span>.) If the URL
      contains awkward characters (such as <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">%</span></span></span> or <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
@@ -12387,16 +12696,16 @@
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>
      package provides commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glspercentchar</span><a 
- id="dx1-27119"></a> and <span 
+ id="dx1-28119"></a> and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstildechar </span>that
      expand to literal characters.
-     </p><!--l. 5953--><p class="noindent" >If you want to a named anchor within the target URL (notionally adding
+     </p><!--l. 6137--><p class="noindent" >If you want to a named anchor within the target URL (notionally adding
      <span 
 class="cmtt-10">#</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; to the URL), then you also need to set <a 
 href="#catattr.targetname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">targetname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27120"></a> to the anchor &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-28120"></a> to the anchor &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9;.
      You may use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslabel </span>within &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12403,7 +12712,7 @@
 class="cmti-10">name</span>&#x27E9; which is set by commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>to
      the entry’s label.
-     </p><!--l. 5959--><p class="noindent" >All the predefined glossary styles start each entry listing with <span 
+     </p><!--l. 6143--><p class="noindent" >All the predefined glossary styles start each entry listing with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstarget</span>
      which sets the anchor to <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glolinkprefix\glslabel</span></span></span>, so if you want
@@ -12410,56 +12719,56 @@
      entries to link to glossaries in the URL given by <a 
 href="#catattr.targeturl"><span 
 class="cmss-10">targeturl</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27121"></a>, you can just
+ id="dx1-28121"></a>, you can just
      do:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-142">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-152">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targetname}{\glolinkprefix\glslabel}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5966--><p class="nopar" > (If the target document changed <span 
+     <!--l. 6150--><p class="nopar" > (If the target document changed <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glolinkprefix </span>then you will need to adjust
      the above as appropriate.)
-     </p><!--l. 5970--><p class="noindent" >If the anchor is in the form &#x27E8;<span 
+     </p><!--l. 6154--><p class="noindent" >If the anchor is in the form &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name1</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">.</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name2</span>&#x27E9; then use <a 
 href="#catattr.targetname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">targetname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27122"></a> for the &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-28122"></a> for the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name2</span>&#x27E9;
      part and <a 
 href="#catattr.targetcategory"><span 
 class="cmss-10">targetcategory</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27123"></a> for the &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-28123"></a> for the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">name1</span>&#x27E9; part.
-     </p><!--l. 5974--><p class="noindent" >For example:
+     </p><!--l. 6158--><p class="noindent" >For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-143">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-153">
      \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targeturl}{master-doc.pdf}
      &#x00A0;<br />\glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targetcategory}{page}
      &#x00A0;<br />\glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targetname}{7}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5979--><p class="nopar" > will cause all link text for <span 
+     <!--l. 6163--><p class="nopar" > will cause all link text for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">general </span>entries to link to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">master-doc.pdf#page.7</span>
      (page 7 of that PDF).
-     </p><!--l. 5983--><p class="noindent" >If you want a mixture in your document of entries that link to an internal
+     </p><!--l. 6167--><p class="noindent" >If you want a mixture in your document of entries that link to an internal
      glossary and entries that link to an external URL then you can use
      the starred form of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\newignoredglossary</span><a 
- id="dx1-27124"></a> for the external list. For
+ id="dx1-28124"></a> for the external list. For
      example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-144">
+     <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-154">
      \newignoredglossary*{external}
      &#x00A0;<br />\glssetcategoryattribute{external}{targeturl}{master-doc.pdf}
      &#x00A0;<br />\glssetcategoryattribute{general}{targetname}{\glolinkprefix\glslabel}
@@ -12469,14 +12778,14 @@
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;category=external,
      &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;description={external&#x00A0;example}}
 </div>
-     <!--l. 5999--><p class="nopar" >
+     <!--l. 6183--><p class="nopar" >
 </p>
      </dd></dl>
-<!--l. 6004--><p class="indent" >   An attribute can be set using:
-</p><!--l. 6005--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 6188--><p class="indent" >   An attribute can be set using:
+</p><!--l. 6189--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glssetcategoryattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27125"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28125"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetcategoryattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12486,31 +12795,31 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">value</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6007--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6191--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9; is the category label, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9; is the attribute label and
 &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9; is the new value for the attribute.
-</p><!--l. 6012--><p class="indent" >   There is a shortcut version to set the <a 
+</p><!--l. 6196--><p class="indent" >   There is a shortcut version to set the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27126"></a> attribute to “true”:
-</p><!--l. 6014--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-28126"></a> attribute to “true”:
+</p><!--l. 6198--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glssetregularcategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27127"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28127"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetregularcategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6016--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6018--><p class="indent" >   If you need to lookup the category label for a particular entry, you can use the
+</p><!--l. 6200--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6202--><p class="indent" >   If you need to lookup the category label for a particular entry, you can use the
 shortcut command:
-</p><!--l. 6020--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6204--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glssetattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27128"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28128"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12520,16 +12829,16 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">value</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6022--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6206--><p class="noindent" >
 This uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glssetcategoryattribute </span>with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glscategory </span>to set the attribute. Note
 that this will affect all other entries that share this entry’s category.
-</p><!--l. 6027--><p class="indent" >   You can fetch the value of an attribute for a particular category using:
-</p><!--l. 6029--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6211--><p class="indent" >   You can fetch the value of an attribute for a particular category using:
+</p><!--l. 6213--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsgetcategoryattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27129"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28129"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgetcategoryattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12537,13 +12846,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6031--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6215--><p class="noindent" >
 Again there is a shortcut if you need to lookup the category label for a given
 entry:
-</p><!--l. 6034--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6218--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsgetattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27130"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28130"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsgetattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12553,12 +12862,12 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 6036--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6038--><p class="indent" >   You can test if an attribute has been assigned to a given category using:
-</p><!--l. 6040--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6220--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6222--><p class="indent" >   You can test if an attribute has been assigned to a given category using:
+</p><!--l. 6224--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glshascategoryattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27131"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28131"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glshascategoryattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12570,19 +12879,19 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false code</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6043--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6227--><p class="noindent" >
 This uses <span 
 class="cmss-10">etoolbox</span><a 
- id="dx1-27132"></a>’s <span 
+ id="dx1-28132"></a>’s <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ifcsvoid </span>and does &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">true code</span>&#x27E9; if the attribute has been set and
 isn’t blank and isn’t <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\relax</span>. The shortcut if you need to lookup the category label
 from an entry is:
-</p><!--l. 6048--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6232--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glshasattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27133"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28133"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glshasattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12594,12 +12903,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false code</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6051--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6053--><p class="indent" >   You can test the value of an attribute for a particular category using:
-</p><!--l. 6055--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6235--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6237--><p class="indent" >   You can test the value of an attribute for a particular category using:
+</p><!--l. 6239--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifcategoryattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27134"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28134"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifcategoryattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12613,7 +12922,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6057--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6241--><p class="noindent" >
 This tests if the attribute (given by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9;) for the category (given by
 &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12623,35 +12932,35 @@
 isn’t set or is set but isn’t equal to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9;, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">false part</span>&#x27E9; is done.
-</p><!--l. 6064--><p class="indent" >   For example:
+</p><!--l. 6248--><p class="indent" >   For example:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-145">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-155">
 \glsifcategoryattribute{general}{nohyper}{true}{NO&#x00A0;HYPER}{HYPER}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6067--><p class="nopar" > This does “NO HYPER” if the <span 
+<!--l. 6251--><p class="nopar" > This does “NO HYPER” if the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-27135"></a> category has the <a 
+ id="dx1-28135"></a> category has the <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyper"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyper</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27136"></a> attribute set to
+ id="dx1-28136"></a> attribute set to
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true </span>otherwise if does “HYPER”.
-</p><!--l. 6072--><p class="indent" >   With boolean-style attributes like <a 
+</p><!--l. 6256--><p class="indent" >   With boolean-style attributes like <a 
 href="#catattr.nohyper"><span 
 class="cmss-10">nohyper</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27137"></a>, make sure you always test for <span 
+ id="dx1-28137"></a>, make sure you always test for <span 
 class="cmtt-10">true</span>
 not <span 
 class="cmtt-10">false </span>in case the attribute hasn’t been set.
-</p><!--l. 6075--><p class="indent" >   Again there’s a shortcut if you need to lookup the category label from a particular
+</p><!--l. 6259--><p class="indent" >   Again there’s a shortcut if you need to lookup the category label from a particular
 entry:
-</p><!--l. 6077--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6261--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27138"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28138"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifattribute{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12665,16 +12974,16 @@
 class="cmtt-10">} {</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6079--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6081--><p class="indent" >   There’s also a shortcut to determine if a particular category has the <a 
+</p><!--l. 6263--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6265--><p class="indent" >   There’s also a shortcut to determine if a particular category has the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27139"></a>
+ id="dx1-28139"></a>
 attribute set to “true”:
-</p><!--l. 6083--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6267--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifregularcategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27140"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28140"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifregularcategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12684,12 +12993,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6085--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6269--><p class="noindent" >
 Alternatively, if you need to lookup the category for a particular entry:
-</p><!--l. 6088--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6272--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifregular</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27141"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28141"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifregular{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12698,21 +13007,21 @@
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6090--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6274--><p class="noindent" >
 Note that if the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27142"></a> attribute hasn’t be set, the above do &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-28142"></a> attribute hasn’t be set, the above do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;. There
 are also reverse commands that test if the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27143"></a> attribute has been set to
+ id="dx1-28143"></a> attribute has been set to
 “false”:
-</p><!--l. 6094--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6278--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifnotregularcategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27144"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28144"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifnotregularcategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12722,12 +13031,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6096--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6280--><p class="noindent" >
 or for a particular entry:
-</p><!--l. 6098--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6282--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsifnotregular</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27145"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28145"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsifnotregular{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12736,15 +13045,15 @@
 class="cmitt-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6100--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6284--><p class="noindent" >
 Again, if the <a 
 href="#catattr.regular"><span 
 class="cmss-10">regular</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-27146"></a> attribute hasn’t been set, the above do &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-28146"></a> attribute hasn’t been set, the above do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">false-part</span>&#x27E9;, so these
 reverse commands aren’t logically opposite in the strict sense.
-</p><!--l. 6105--><p class="indent" >   You can iterate through all entries with a given category using:
-</p><!--l. 6107--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6289--><p class="indent" >   You can iterate through all entries with a given category using:
+</p><!--l. 6291--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsforeachincategory[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary-labels</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12758,7 +13067,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">body</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6108--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6292--><p class="noindent" >
 This iterates through all entries in the glossaries identified by the comma-separated
 list &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">glossary-labels</span>&#x27E9; that have the category given by &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12774,12 +13083,12 @@
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 6118--><p class="indent" >   Similarly, you can iterate through all entries that have a category with a given
+</p><!--l. 6302--><p class="indent" >   Similarly, you can iterate through all entries that have a category with a given
 attribute using:
-</p><!--l. 6120--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6304--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsforeachwithattribute</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27147"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28147"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsforeachwithattribute[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary-labels</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
@@ -12796,21 +13105,21 @@
 class="cmitt-10">body</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6122--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6306--><p class="noindent" >
 This will do &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">body</span>&#x27E9; for each entry that has a category with the attribute &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9;
 set to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute-value</span>&#x27E9;. The remaining arguments are as the previous command.
-</p><!--l. 6127--><p class="indent" >   You can change the category for a particular entry using the standard glossary
+</p><!--l. 6311--><p class="indent" >   You can change the category for a particular entry using the standard glossary
 field changing commands, such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfielddef</span><a 
- id="dx1-27148"></a>. Alternatively, you can
+ id="dx1-28148"></a>. Alternatively, you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 6130--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6314--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsetcategory</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27149"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28149"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsetcategory{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">entry-labels</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12817,21 +13126,21 @@
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6132--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6316--><p class="noindent" >
 This will change the category to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9; for each entry listed in the
 comma-separated list &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">entry-labels</span>&#x27E9;. This command uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsfieldxdef</span><a 
- id="dx1-27150"></a> so it will
+ id="dx1-28150"></a> so it will
 expand &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9; and make the change global.
-</p><!--l. 6138--><p class="indent" >   You can also change the category for all entries with a glossary or glossaries
+</p><!--l. 6322--><p class="indent" >   You can also change the category for all entries with a glossary or glossaries
 using:
-</p><!--l. 6140--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6324--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrsetcategoryforall</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-27151"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-28151"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrsetcategoryforall{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">glossary-labels</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -12839,7 +13148,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">category-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6142--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6326--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">glossary-labels</span>&#x27E9; is a comma-separated list of glossary labels.
                                                                   
@@ -12846,14 +13155,14 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 6146--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 6146--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 6330--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 6330--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">6. <a 
  id="sec:countref"></a>Counting References</h2>
-</p><!--l. 6149--><p class="indent" >   There are three basic ways of counting entry references:
+</p><!--l. 6333--><p class="indent" >   There are three basic ways of counting entry references:
      </p><ol  class="enumerate1" >
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-28002x1">Counting the total number of times <span 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-29002x1">Counting the total number of times <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsunset </span>is used (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsreset </span>resets
      the count and is best avoided). This is provided by the base <span 
@@ -12864,7 +13173,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">.aux </span>file  so  that  it’s  available  on  the  next
      <span class="LATEX">L<span class="A">A</span><span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span></span>&#x00A0;run.
-     <!--l. 6159--><p class="noindent" >This method is extended by <span 
+     <!--l. 6343--><p class="noindent" >This method is extended by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>and is described in <a 
 href="#sec:entrycount"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>6.1 </a><a 
@@ -12872,12 +13181,12 @@
      Counting (First Use Flag)<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:entrycount --></a>.
      </p></li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-28004x2">Counting the total number of records. This method is only available with
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-29004x2">Counting the total number of records. This method is only available with
      <a 
- id="dx1-28005"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-29005"></a><a 
 href="#glo:bib2gls"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">bib2gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-28006"></a></a> and is intended for documents where the term should be displayed
+ id="dx1-29006"></a></a> and is intended for documents where the term should be displayed
      differently if it’s only been recorded (indexed) a certain number of times.
      See <a 
 href="#sec:recordcount"><span 
@@ -12885,7 +13194,7 @@
 href="#sec:recordcount">Record Counting<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:recordcount --></a> for further details.
      </li>
      <li 
-  class="enumerate" id="x1-28008x3">Counting   the   number   of   times   the   <span 
+  class="enumerate" id="x1-29008x3">Counting   the   number   of   times   the   <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>-like   or   <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>-like
      commands  are  used.  (That  is,  those  commands  that  internally  use
@@ -12902,10 +13211,10 @@
 href="#sec:linkcount"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>6.2 </a><a 
 href="#sec:linkcount">Link Counting<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:linkcount --></a> for further details.</li></ol>
-<!--l. 6178--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 6362--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.1   </span> <a 
  id="sec:entrycount"></a>Entry Counting (First Use Flag)</h3>
-<!--l. 6181--><p class="noindent" >As mentioned in <a 
+<!--l. 6365--><p class="noindent" >As mentioned in <a 
 href="#sec:entrycountmods"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>2.4 </a><a 
 href="#sec:entrycountmods">Entry Counting Modifications<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:entrycountmods --></a>, <span 
@@ -12912,40 +13221,40 @@
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>modifies the
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span><a 
- id="dx1-29001"></a> command to allow for the <a 
+ id="dx1-30001"></a> command to allow for the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29002"></a> attribute. This means
+ id="dx1-30002"></a> attribute. This means
 that you not only need to enable entry counting with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span><a 
- id="dx1-29003"></a>, but
+ id="dx1-30003"></a>, but
 you also need to set the appropriate attribute (see <a 
 href="#sec:categories"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>5 </a><a 
 href="#sec:categories">Categories<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:categories --></a>).
-</p><!--l. 6188--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Remember that entry counting only counts the number of times an entry is used
+</p><!--l. 6372--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Remember that entry counting only counts the number of times an entry is used
 by commands that change the <a 
- id="dx1-29004"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-30004"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuseflag">first use flag</a>. (That is, all those commands
 that mark the entry as having been used.) There are many commands that
 don’t modify this flag and they won’t contribute to the entry use count.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 6194--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6196--><p class="indent" >   With <span 
+</p><!--l. 6378--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6380--><p class="indent" >   With <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra</span>, you may use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29005"></a> instead of <span 
+ id="dx1-30005"></a> instead of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29006"></a> even if you haven’t enabled
+ id="dx1-30006"></a> even if you haven’t enabled
 entry counting. You will only get a warning if you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span>
 without setting the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29007"></a> attribute. (With <span 
+ id="dx1-30007"></a> attribute. (With <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29008"></a>
+ id="dx1-30008"></a>
 will generate a warning if <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount </span>hasn’t been used.) The
                                                                   
@@ -12953,7 +13262,7 @@
                                                                   
 abbreviation shortcut <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ab</span><a 
- id="dx1-29009"></a> uses <span 
+ id="dx1-30009"></a> uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls </span>(see <a 
 href="#sec:abbrshortcuts"><span 
 class="cmsy-10">§</span>3.3 </a><a 
@@ -12960,33 +13269,33 @@
 href="#sec:abbrshortcuts">Shortcut Commands<!--tex4ht:ref: sec:abbrshortcuts --></a>). The
 acronym shortcut <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-29010"></a> uses <span 
+ id="dx1-30010"></a> uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls </span>if it’s been defined with <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=ac</span><a 
- id="dx1-29011"></a> (or
+ id="dx1-30011"></a> (or
 <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=all</span><a 
- id="dx1-29012"></a>) but uses <span 
+ id="dx1-30012"></a>) but uses <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>if it’s been defined with <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=acronyms</span><a 
- id="dx1-29013"></a> (or
+ id="dx1-30013"></a> (or
 <a 
 href="#styopt.shortcuts"><span 
 class="cmss-10">shortcuts</span></a><span 
 class="cmss-10">=acro</span><a 
- id="dx1-29014"></a>).
-</p><!--l. 6209--><p class="indent" >   All upper case versions (not provided by <span 
+ id="dx1-30014"></a>).
+</p><!--l. 6393--><p class="indent" >   All upper case versions (not provided by <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>) are also available:
-</p><!--l. 6211--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6395--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\cGLS</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29015"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30015"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLS[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -12994,12 +13303,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6213--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6397--><p class="noindent" >
 and
-</p><!--l. 6215--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6399--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\cGLSpl</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29016"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30016"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLSpl[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">options</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13007,42 +13316,42 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">] </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6217--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6401--><p class="noindent" >
 These are analogous to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglspl </span>but they use
-</p><!--l. 6220--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6404--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\cGLSformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29017"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30017"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLSformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6222--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6406--><p class="noindent" >
 and
-</p><!--l. 6224--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6408--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\cGLSplformat</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29018"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30018"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cGLSplformat{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">insert</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6226--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6410--><p class="noindent" >
 which convert the analogous <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglsformat </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglsplformat </span>to upper
 case.
-</p><!--l. 6230--><p class="indent" >   Just using <span 
+</p><!--l. 6414--><p class="indent" >   Just using <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries</span>:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-146">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-156">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -13055,17 +13364,17 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6252--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6254--><p class="indent" >   If you switch to <span 
+<!--l. 6436--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6438--><p class="indent" >   If you switch to <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries-extra </span>you must set the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29019"></a> attribute:
+ id="dx1-30019"></a> attribute:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-147">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-157">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -13079,16 +13388,16 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6279--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6281--><p class="indent" >   When activated with <span 
+<!--l. 6463--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6465--><p class="indent" >   When activated with <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsenableentrycount</span>, commands such as <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29020"></a> now
+ id="dx1-30020"></a> now
 use
-</p><!--l. 6283--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6467--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrifcounttrigger</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29021"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30021"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrifcounttrigger{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13098,12 +13407,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">normal code</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6286--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6470--><p class="noindent" >
 to determine if the entry trips the entry count trigger. The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">trigger code</span>&#x27E9; uses
 commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cglsformat </span>and unsets the <a 
- id="dx1-29022"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-30022"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuseflag">first use flag</a>. The &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">normal code</span>&#x27E9; is the
 code that would ordinarily be performed by whatever the equivalent command is (for
@@ -13114,12 +13423,12 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>behaviour in
 &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">normal code</span>&#x27E9;).
-</p><!--l. 6295--><p class="indent" >   The default definition is:
+</p><!--l. 6479--><p class="indent" >   The default definition is:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-148">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-158">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrifcounttrigger}[3]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\glshasattribute{#1}{entrycount}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{%
@@ -13132,37 +13441,37 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{#3}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6308--><p class="nopar" > This means that if an entry is assigned to a category that has the <a 
+<!--l. 6492--><p class="nopar" > This means that if an entry is assigned to a category that has the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29023"></a>
+ id="dx1-30023"></a>
 attribute then the &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">trigger code</span>&#x27E9; will be used if the previous count value (the number of
 times the entry was used on the last run) is greater than the value of the
 attribute.
-</p><!--l. 6315--><p class="indent" >   For example, to trigger normal use if the previous count value is greater than
+</p><!--l. 6499--><p class="indent" >   For example, to trigger normal use if the previous count value is greater than
 four:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-149">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-159">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{abbreviation}{entrycount}{4}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6319--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6321--><p class="indent" >   There is a convenient command provided to enable entry counting, set the
+<!--l. 6503--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6505--><p class="indent" >   There is a convenient command provided to enable entry counting, set the
 <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29024"></a> attribute and redefine <span 
+ id="dx1-30024"></a> attribute and redefine <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29025"></a>, etc to use <span 
+ id="dx1-30025"></a>, etc to use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\cgls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29026"></a> etc:
-</p><!--l. 6324--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-30026"></a> etc:
+</p><!--l. 6508--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29027"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30027"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">categories</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
@@ -13170,19 +13479,19 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">value</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6326--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6510--><p class="noindent" >
 The first argument &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">categories</span>&#x27E9; is a comma-separated list of categories. For each
 category, the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29028"></a> attribute is set to &#x27E8;<span 
+ id="dx1-30028"></a> attribute is set to &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9;. In addition, this does:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-150">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-160">
 \renewcommand*{\gls}{\cgls}%
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\Gls}{\cGls}%
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\glspl}{\cglspl}%
@@ -13190,19 +13499,19 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\GLS}{\cGLS}%
 &#x00A0;<br />\renewcommand*{\GLSpl}{\cGLSpl}%
 </div>
-<!--l. 6337--><p class="nopar" > This makes it easier to enable entry-counting on existing documents.
-</p><!--l. 6341--><p class="indent" >   If you use <span 
+<!--l. 6521--><p class="nopar" > This makes it easier to enable entry-counting on existing documents.
+</p><!--l. 6525--><p class="indent" >   If you use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableEntryCounting </span>more than once, subsequent uses will
 just set the <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29029"></a> attribute for each listed category.
-</p><!--l. 6345--><p class="indent" >   The above example document can then become:
+ id="dx1-30029"></a> attribute for each listed category.
+</p><!--l. 6529--><p class="indent" >   The above example document can then become:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-151">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-161">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\makeglossaries
@@ -13215,15 +13524,15 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6367--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6369--><p class="indent" >   The standard entry-counting function describe above counts the number of times
+<!--l. 6551--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6553--><p class="indent" >   The standard entry-counting function describe above counts the number of times
 an entry has been marked as used throughout the document. (The reset commands
 will reset the total back to zero.) If you prefer to count per sectional-unit, you can
 use
-</p><!--l. 6374--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6558--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29030"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30030"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting</span>
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13233,7 +13542,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6376--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6560--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">categories</span>&#x27E9; is a comma-separated list of categories to which this feature should
 be applied, &#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13240,20 +13549,20 @@
 class="cmti-10">value</span>&#x27E9; is the trigger value and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9; is the name of the counter
 used by the sectional unit.
-</p><!--l. 6382--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Due to the asynchronous nature of <span class="TEX">T<span 
+</p><!--l. 6566--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> Due to the asynchronous nature of <span class="TEX">T<span 
 class="E">E</span>X</span>’s output routine, discrepancies will
 occur in page spanning paragraphs if you use the <span 
 class="cmss-10">page</span><a 
- id="dx1-29031"></a> counter. </div>
-</p><!--l. 6386--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6388--><p class="indent" >   Note that you can’t use both the document-wide counting and the per-unit
+ id="dx1-30031"></a> counter. </div>
+</p><!--l. 6570--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6572--><p class="indent" >   Note that you can’t use both the document-wide counting and the per-unit
 counting in the same document.
-</p><!--l. 6391--><p class="indent" >   The counter value is used as part of a label, which means that <span 
+</p><!--l. 6575--><p class="indent" >   The counter value is used as part of a label, which means that <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\the</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9;
 needs to be expandable. Since <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-29032"></a> also has a similar requirement and provides
+ id="dx1-30032"></a> also has a similar requirement and provides
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\theH</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9; as an expandable alternative, <span 
@@ -13263,10 +13572,10 @@
 class="cmti-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9; if it exists otherwise it will use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\the</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter-name</span>&#x27E9;.
-</p><!--l. 6398--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit counting function uses two attributes: <a 
+</p><!--l. 6582--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit counting function uses two attributes: <a 
 href="#catattr.entrycount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">entrycount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29033"></a> (as before) and
+ id="dx1-30033"></a> (as before) and
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -13273,59 +13582,59 @@
 <a 
 href="#catattr.unitcount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">unitcount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-29034"></a> (the name of the counter).
-</p><!--l. 6401--><p class="indent" >   Both the original document-wide counting mechanism and the per-unit counting
+ id="dx1-30034"></a> (the name of the counter).
+</p><!--l. 6585--><p class="indent" >   Both the original document-wide counting mechanism and the per-unit counting
 mechanism provide a command that can be used to access the current count value for
 this run:
-</p><!--l. 6404--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6588--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsentrycurrcount</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29035"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30035"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentrycurrcount{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6406--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6590--><p class="noindent" >
 and the final value from the previous run:
-</p><!--l. 6408--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6592--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsentryprevcount</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29036"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30036"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryprevcount{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6410--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6594--><p class="noindent" >
 In the case of the per-unit counting, this is the final value <span 
 class="cmti-10">for the current unit</span>. In
 both commands &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label.
-</p><!--l. 6415--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit counting mechanism additionally provides:
-</p><!--l. 6416--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6599--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit counting mechanism additionally provides:
+</p><!--l. 6600--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsentryprevtotalcount</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29037"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30037"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryprevtotalcount{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6418--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6602--><p class="noindent" >
 which gives the sum of all the per-unit totals from the previous run for the entry
 given by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;, and
-</p><!--l. 6421--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6605--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsentryprevmaxcount</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29038"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30038"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryprevmaxcount{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6423--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6607--><p class="noindent" >
 which gives the maximum per-unit total from the previous run.
-</p><!--l. 6426--><p class="indent" >   The above two commands are unavailable for the document-wide counting.
-</p><!--l. 6428--><p class="indent" >   Example of per-unit counting, where the unit is the chapter:
+</p><!--l. 6610--><p class="indent" >   The above two commands are unavailable for the document-wide counting.
+</p><!--l. 6612--><p class="indent" >   Example of per-unit counting, where the unit is the chapter:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-152">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-162">
 \documentclass{report}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
 &#x00A0;<br />\GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting{abbreviation}{2}{chapter}
@@ -13344,11 +13653,11 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6459--><p class="nopar" > In this document, the <span 
+<!--l. 6643--><p class="nopar" > In this document, the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">css </span>entry is used three times in the first chapter. This is
 more than the trigger value of 2, so <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{css}</span></span></span> is expanded on <a 
- id="dx1-29039"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-30039"></a><a 
 href="#glo:firstuse">first use</a>
 with the short form used on subsequent use, and the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">css </span>entries in that
@@ -13358,33 +13667,33 @@
 long form is used and <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{css}</span></span></span> doesn’t get a line added to the glossary
 file.
-</p><!--l. 6470--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 6654--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">html </span>is used a total of three times, but the expansion and indexing
 suppression trigger is tripped in both chapters because the per-unit total (1 for the
 first chapter and 2 for the second chapter) is less than or equal to the trigger
 value.
-</p><!--l. 6476--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 6660--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">sample </span>entry has only been used once, but it doesn’t trip the indexing
 suppression because it’s in the <span 
 class="cmss-10">general</span><a 
- id="dx1-29040"></a> category, which hasn’t been listed in
+ id="dx1-30040"></a> category, which hasn’t been listed in
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableEntryUnitCounting</span>.
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
-</p><!--l. 6481--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit entry counting can be used for other purposes. In the following
+</p><!--l. 6665--><p class="indent" >   The per-unit entry counting can be used for other purposes. In the following
 example document the trigger value is set to zero, which means the index suppression
 won’t be triggered, but the unit entry count is used to automatically suppress the
 hyperlink for commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span><a 
- id="dx1-29041"></a> by modifying the hook
-</p><!--l. 6487--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-30041"></a> by modifying the hook
+</p><!--l. 6671--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-29042"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-30042"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkcheckfirsthyperhook </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6489--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6673--><p class="noindent" >
 which is used at the end of the macro the determines whether or not to suppress the
 hyperlink.
                                                                   
@@ -13391,7 +13700,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-153">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-163">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
@@ -13412,22 +13721,22 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6524--><p class="nopar" > This only produces a hyperlink for the first instance of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
+<!--l. 6708--><p class="nopar" > This only produces a hyperlink for the first instance of <span class="obeylines-h"><span class="verb"><span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls{sample}</span></span></span> on each
 page.
-</p><!--l. 6528--><p class="indent" >   The earlier warning about using the <span 
+</p><!--l. 6712--><p class="indent" >   The earlier warning about using the <span 
 class="cmss-10">page</span><a 
- id="dx1-29043"></a> counter still applies. If the
+ id="dx1-30043"></a> counter still applies. If the
 first instance of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>occurs at the top of the page within a paragraph that
 started on the previous page, then the count will continue from the previous
 page.
-</p><!--l. 6533--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6717--><p class="noindent" >
 </p>
-<!--l. 6533--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 6717--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><h3 class="sectionHead"></p><h3 class="sectionHead"><span class="titlemark">6.2   </span> <a 
  id="sec:linkcount"></a>Link Counting</h3>
-<!--l. 6536--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.26, an alternative method of entry counting is to count the number
+<!--l. 6720--><p class="noindent" >As from version 1.26, an alternative method of entry counting is to count the number
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
@@ -13441,13 +13750,13 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\@gls at link </span>may use <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\hyperlink </span>when displaying the
 <a 
- id="dx1-30001"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-31001"></a><a 
 href="#glo:linktext">link-text</a>.)
-</p><!--l. 6543--><p class="indent" >   To enable link counting use the preamble-only command:
-</p><!--l. 6544--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6727--><p class="indent" >   To enable link counting use the preamble-only command:
+</p><!--l. 6728--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30002"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31002"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting[</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">master counter</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">]</span>
@@ -13455,7 +13764,7 @@
 class="cmtt-10">{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">categories</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6546--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6730--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">categories</span>&#x27E9; is a list of category labels. The optional argument &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">master</span>
@@ -13465,24 +13774,24 @@
 incremented. This command automatically sets the <a 
 href="#catattr.linkcount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">linkcount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-30003"></a> attribute for the given
+ id="dx1-31003"></a> attribute for the given
 categories. If the optional argument is present, it also sets the <a 
 href="#catattr.linkcountmaster"><span 
 class="cmss-10">linkcountmaster</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-30004"></a>
+ id="dx1-31004"></a>
 attribute.
-</p><!--l. 6555--><p class="indent" >   When enabled, commands like <span 
+</p><!--l. 6739--><p class="indent" >   When enabled, commands like <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls </span>and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext </span>increment the associated
 counter using
-</p><!--l. 6557--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6741--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrinclinkcounter</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30005"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31005"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrinclinkcounter{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">counter name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6559--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6743--><p class="noindent" >
 This just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\stepcounter{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">counter name</span>&#x27E9;<span 
@@ -13493,44 +13802,44 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-154">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-164">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrinclinkcounter}[1]{\refstepcounter{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6565--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6567--><p class="indent" >   You can access the internal count register using
-</p><!--l. 6568--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+<!--l. 6749--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6751--><p class="indent" >   You can access the internal count register using
+</p><!--l. 6752--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrLinkCounterValue</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30006"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31006"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrLinkCounterValue{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6570--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6754--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label. This will expand to 0 if the counter hasn’t been
 defined.
-</p><!--l. 6574--><p class="indent" >   It’s also possible to access the display value (<span 
+</p><!--l. 6758--><p class="indent" >   It’s also possible to access the display value (<span 
 class="cmtt-10">\the</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter</span>&#x27E9;) using
-</p><!--l. 6576--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6760--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrTheLinkCounter</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30007"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31007"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrTheLinkCounter{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">counter</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6578--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6762--><p class="noindent" >
 (This will expand to 0 if the counter hasn’t been defined.)
-</p><!--l. 6581--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> In order to conserve resources, the counter is only defined when it first
+</p><!--l. 6765--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> In order to conserve resources, the counter is only defined when it first
 needs to be incremented so terms that have been defined but haven’t been
 used in the document won’t have the associated count register allocated.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 6586--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6588--><p class="indent" >   You can test if the counter has been defined using:
-</p><!--l. 6589--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6770--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6772--><p class="indent" >   You can test if the counter has been defined using:
+</p><!--l. 6773--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30008"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31008"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13539,18 +13848,18 @@
 class="cmitt-10">false</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6591--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6775--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label.
-</p><!--l. 6594--><p class="indent" >   The counter name can be obtained using
-</p><!--l. 6595--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6778--><p class="indent" >   The counter name can be obtained using
+</p><!--l. 6779--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrLinkCounterName</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-30009"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-31009"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrLinkCounterName{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6597--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6781--><p class="noindent" >
 This simply expands to the counter name associated with the entry given by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;
 without any check for existence. For example, to change the display command
@@ -13558,15 +13867,15 @@
 class="cmtt-10">\the</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">counter</span>&#x27E9;) using <span 
 class="cmss-10">etoolbox</span><a 
- id="dx1-30010"></a>:
+ id="dx1-31010"></a>:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-155">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-165">
 \csdef{the\GlsXtrLinkCounterName{duck}}{\Roman{\GlsXtrLinkCounterName{duck}}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6604--><p class="nopar" > This is useful if you just want to change the display for specific entries but isn’t
+<!--l. 6788--><p class="nopar" > This is useful if you just want to change the display for specific entries but isn’t
 convenient if you want to change the display for all entries. Instead, it’s simpler to
 redefine <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrTheLinkCounter</span>. For example:
@@ -13574,7 +13883,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-156">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-166">
 \renewcommand*{\GlsXtrTheLinkCounter}[1]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\GlsXtrIfLinkCounterDef{#1}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{\Roman{\GlsXtrLinkCounterName{#1}}}%
@@ -13581,12 +13890,12 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;{0}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6615--><p class="nopar" > In both cases, the redefinition should be implemented after <span 
+<!--l. 6799--><p class="nopar" > In both cases, the redefinition should be implemented after <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting</span>.
-</p><!--l. 6619--><p class="indent" >   Here’s an example document that uses link counting to disable the hyperlink after
+</p><!--l. 6803--><p class="indent" >   Here’s an example document that uses link counting to disable the hyperlink after
 the first reference. This redefines <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpresetkeys</span><a 
- id="dx1-30011"></a> (which is used by both <span 
+ id="dx1-31011"></a> (which is used by both <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\gls</span>
 and <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glstext</span>) instead of <span 
@@ -13598,7 +13907,7 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-157">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-167">
 \documentclass{article}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage[colorlinks]{hyperref}
 &#x00A0;<br />\usepackage{glossaries-extra}
@@ -13621,32 +13930,32 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />\printglossaries
 &#x00A0;<br />\end{document}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6661--><p class="nopar" > The use of <span 
+<!--l. 6845--><p class="nopar" > The use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpresetkeys</span><a 
- id="dx1-30012"></a> means that the options can override this. For
+ id="dx1-31012"></a> means that the options can override this. For
 example
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-158">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-168">
 \gls[hyper=true]{sample1}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6666--><p class="nopar" > will override the <span 
+<!--l. 6850--><p class="nopar" > will override the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">hyper=false </span>setting in <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpresetkeys</span><a 
- id="dx1-30013"></a>. If <span 
+ id="dx1-31013"></a>. If <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glslinkpostsetkeys</span><a 
- id="dx1-30014"></a>
+ id="dx1-31014"></a>
 is used instead, the <span 
 class="cmtt-10">hyper=false </span>setting will override the setting provided in the
 optional argument.
-</p><!--l. 6672--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+</p><!--l. 6856--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmss-10">abbreviation</span><a 
- id="dx1-30015"></a> category doesn’t have the <a 
+ id="dx1-31015"></a> category doesn’t have the <a 
 href="#catattr.linkcount"><span 
 class="cmss-10">linkcount</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-30016"></a> attribute set (since it’s not
+ id="dx1-31016"></a> attribute set (since it’s not
 listed in the argument of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting</span>). This means that
 <span 
@@ -13657,10 +13966,10 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-159">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-169">
 \ifnum\GlsXtrLinkCounterValue{\glslabel}&#x003E;1
 </div>
-<!--l. 6680--><p class="nopar" > will always be false. This means that the abbreviation won’t have <span 
+<!--l. 6864--><p class="nopar" > will always be false. This means that the abbreviation won’t have <span 
 class="cmtt-10">hyper=false</span>
 applied. If the test is changed to
                                                                   
@@ -13667,71 +13976,71 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-160">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-170">
 \ifnum\GlsXtrLinkCounterValue{\glslabel}=1
 &#x00A0;<br />\else
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;\setkeys{glslink}{hyper=false}%
 &#x00A0;<br />\fi
 </div>
-<!--l. 6688--><p class="nopar" > Then the abbreviation will always have <span 
+<!--l. 6872--><p class="nopar" > Then the abbreviation will always have <span 
 class="cmtt-10">hyper=false </span>applied.
-</p><!--l. 6692--><p class="indent" >   To reset the counter every section use the optional argument to set the master
+</p><!--l. 6876--><p class="indent" >   To reset the counter every section use the optional argument to set the master
 counter:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-161">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-171">
 \GlsXtrEnableLinkCounting[section]{general}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6696--><p class="nopar" >
+<!--l. 6880--><p class="nopar" >
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-<!--l. 6698--><p class="indent" >   </div>
-</p><!--l. 6698--><p class="noindent" ><a 
+<!--l. 6882--><p class="indent" >   </div>
+</p><!--l. 6882--><p class="noindent" ><a 
 href="#top">Top</a><div class="chapter"><h2 class="chapterHead">7. <a 
  id="sec:autoindex"></a>Auto-Indexing</h2>
-</p><!--l. 6701--><p class="indent" >   It’s possible that you may also want a normal index as well as the glossary,
+</p><!--l. 6885--><p class="indent" >   It’s possible that you may also want a normal index as well as the glossary,
 and you may want entries to automatically be added to the index (as in
 this document). There are two attributes that govern this: <a 
 href="#catattr.indexname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31001"></a> and
+ id="dx1-32001"></a> and
 <a 
 href="#catattr.dualindex"><span 
 class="cmss-10">dualindex</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31002"></a>.
-</p><!--l. 6708--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
+ id="dx1-32002"></a>.
+</p><!--l. 6892--><p class="indent" >   The <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrpostnamehook</span><a 
- id="dx1-31003"></a> macro, used at the end of <span 
+ id="dx1-32003"></a> macro, used at the end of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-31004"></a> and
+ id="dx1-32004"></a> and
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\Glossentryname</span><a 
- id="dx1-31005"></a>, checks the <a 
+ id="dx1-32005"></a>, checks the <a 
 href="#catattr.indexname"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexname</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31006"></a> attribute for the category associated with
+ id="dx1-32006"></a> attribute for the category associated with
 that entry. Since <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glossentryname </span>is used in the default glossary styles, this
 makes a convenient way of automatically indexing each entry name at its
 location in the glossary without fiddling around with the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-31007"></a>
+ id="dx1-32007"></a>
 key.
-</p><!--l. 6718--><p class="indent" >   The internal macro used by the <span 
+</p><!--l. 6902--><p class="indent" >   The internal macro used by the <span 
 class="cmss-10">glossaries </span>package to write the information to the
 external glossary file is modified to check for the <a 
 href="#catattr.dualindex"><span 
 class="cmss-10">dualindex</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31008"></a> attribute.
-</p><!--l. 6722--><p class="indent" >   In both cases, the indexing is done through
-</p><!--l. 6723--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+ id="dx1-32008"></a> attribute.
+</p><!--l. 6906--><p class="indent" >   In both cases, the indexing is done through
+</p><!--l. 6907--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrdoautoindexname</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-31009"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-32009"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrdoautoindexname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13738,27 +14047,27 @@
 class="cmitt-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6725--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6909--><p class="noindent" >
 This uses the standard <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\index</span><a 
- id="dx1-31010"></a> command with the sort value taken from the entry’s
+ id="dx1-32010"></a> command with the sort value taken from the entry’s
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-31011"></a> key and the actual value set to <span 
+ id="dx1-32011"></a> key and the actual value set to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryname{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>. As from v1.16, there are
 user-level commands available to change the sort and actual value used by the
 automated index.
-</p><!--l. 6732--><p class="indent" >   The actual value is given by
-</p><!--l. 6733--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6916--><p class="indent" >   The actual value is given by
+</p><!--l. 6917--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrautoindexentry</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-31012"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-32012"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrautoindexentry{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6735--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6919--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry’s label. The default definition is:
                                                                   
@@ -13765,18 +14074,18 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-162">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-172">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrautoindexentry}[1]{\string\glsentryname{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6740--><p class="nopar" > Note the use of <span 
+<!--l. 6924--><p class="nopar" > Note the use of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\string </span>to prevent <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsentryname </span>from being expanded as it’s
 written to the index file.
-</p><!--l. 6744--><p class="indent" >   The sort value is assigned using:
-</p><!--l. 6745--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6928--><p class="indent" >   The sort value is assigned using:
+</p><!--l. 6929--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrautoindexassignsort</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-31013"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-32013"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrautoindexassignsort{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">cs</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
@@ -13783,7 +14092,7 @@
 class="cmitt-10">label</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">}</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6747--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6931--><p class="noindent" >
 where &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">label</span>&#x27E9; is the entry label and &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">cs</span>&#x27E9; is the command which needs to be set to the
@@ -13792,58 +14101,58 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-163">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-173">
 \newcommand*{\glsxtrautoindexassignsort}[2]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\glsletentryfield{#1}{#2}{sort}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6754--><p class="nopar" > After this macro is called, &#x27E8;<span 
+<!--l. 6938--><p class="nopar" > After this macro is called, &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">cs</span>&#x27E9; is then processed to escape any of <span 
 class="cmtt-10">makeindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-31014"></a>’s special
+ id="dx1-32014"></a>’s special
 characters. Note that this escaping is only performed on the sort not on the actual
 value.
-</p><!--l. 6759--><p class="indent" >   The command used to perform the actual indexing is:
-</p><!--l. 6760--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6943--><p class="indent" >   The command used to perform the actual indexing is:
+</p><!--l. 6944--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\glsxtrautoindex</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-31015"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-32015"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glsxtrautoindex{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmitt-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span></div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6762--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6946--><p class="noindent" >
 This just does <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\index{</span>&#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">text</span>&#x27E9;<span 
 class="cmtt-10">} </span>by default.
-</p><!--l. 6765--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The entry’s <span 
+</p><!--l. 6949--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The entry’s <span 
 class="cmss-10">parent</span><a 
- id="dx1-31016"></a> field isn’t referenced in this automated indexing.
+ id="dx1-32016"></a> field isn’t referenced in this automated indexing.
 </div>
-</p><!--l. 6768--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6770--><p class="indent" >   For example, to index the value of the <span 
+</p><!--l. 6952--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6954--><p class="indent" >   For example, to index the value of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">first</span><a 
- id="dx1-31017"></a> key, instead of the <span 
+ id="dx1-32017"></a> key, instead of the <span 
 class="cmss-10">name</span><a 
- id="dx1-31018"></a> key:
+ id="dx1-32018"></a> key:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-164">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-174">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrautoindexentry}[1]{\string\glsentryfirst{#1}}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6774--><p class="nopar" > and if the sort value also needs to be set to the <span 
+<!--l. 6958--><p class="nopar" > and if the sort value also needs to be set to the <span 
 class="cmss-10">long</span><a 
- id="dx1-31019"></a> field, if present, otherwise the
+ id="dx1-32019"></a> field, if present, otherwise the
 <span 
 class="cmss-10">sort</span><a 
- id="dx1-31020"></a> field:
+ id="dx1-32020"></a> field:
                                                                   
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-165">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-175">
 \renewcommand*{\glsxtrautoindexassignsort}[2]{%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;\ifglshaslong{#2}%
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;{\glsletentryfield{#1}{#2}{long}}%
@@ -13850,8 +14159,8 @@
 &#x00A0;<br />&#x00A0;&#x00A0;{\glsletentryfield{#1}{#2}{sort}}%
 &#x00A0;<br />}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6783--><p class="nopar" >
-</p><!--l. 6785--><p class="indent" >   If the value of the attribute given by &#x27E8;<span 
+<!--l. 6967--><p class="nopar" >
+</p><!--l. 6969--><p class="indent" >   If the value of the attribute given by &#x27E8;<span 
 class="cmti-10">attribute-label</span>&#x27E9; is “true”, no encap will be
 added, otherwise the encap will be the attribute value. For example:
                                                                   
@@ -13858,10 +14167,10 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-166">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-176">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{indexname}{textbf}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6791--><p class="nopar" > will set the encap to <span 
+<!--l. 6975--><p class="nopar" > will set the encap to <span 
 class="cmtt-10">textbf </span>which will display the relevant page number in bold
 whereas
                                                                   
@@ -13868,118 +14177,118 @@
 
                                                                   
 </p>
-   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-167">
+   <div class="verbatim" id="verbatim-177">
 \glssetcategoryattribute{general}{dualindex}{true}
 </div>
-<!--l. 6796--><p class="nopar" > won’t apply any formatting to the page number in the index.
-</p><!--l. 6799--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The location used in the index will always be the page number not the counter
+<!--l. 6980--><p class="nopar" > won’t apply any formatting to the page number in the index.
+</p><!--l. 6983--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The location used in the index will always be the page number not the counter
 used in the glossary. (Unless some other loaded package has modified the definition of
 <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\index </span>to use some thing else.) </div>
-</p><!--l. 6804--><p class="noindent" >
-</p><!--l. 6806--><p class="indent" >   By default the <span 
+</p><!--l. 6988--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6990--><p class="indent" >   By default the <span 
 class="cmss-10">format</span><a 
- id="dx1-31021"></a> key won’t be used with the <a 
+ id="dx1-32021"></a> key won’t be used with the <a 
 href="#catattr.dualindex"><span 
 class="cmss-10">dualindex</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31022"></a> attribute. You can
+ id="dx1-32022"></a> attribute. You can
 allow the <span 
 class="cmss-10">format</span><a 
- id="dx1-31023"></a> key to override the attribute value by using the preamble-only
+ id="dx1-32023"></a> key to override the attribute value by using the preamble-only
 command:
-</p><!--l. 6810--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
+</p><!--l. 6994--><p class="indent" >   <hr><div title="Definition"><span class="marginpar"><span 
 class="cmtt-9">\GlsXtrEnableIndexFormatOverride</span><span 
 class="cmtt-9">&#x00A0;</span></span><a 
- id="dx1-31024"></a> <span 
+ id="dx1-32024"></a> <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\GlsXtrEnableIndexFormatOverride</span>
 </div><hr>
-</p><!--l. 6812--><p class="noindent" >
+</p><!--l. 6996--><p class="noindent" >
 If you use this command and <span 
 class="cmss-10">hyperref</span><a 
- id="dx1-31025"></a> has been loaded, then the <span 
+ id="dx1-32025"></a> has been loaded, then the <span 
 class="cmss-10">theindex</span><a 
- id="dx1-31026"></a><a 
- id="dx1-31027"></a>
+ id="dx1-32026"></a><a 
+ id="dx1-32027"></a>
 environment will be modified to redefine <span 
 class="cmtt-10">\glshypernumber</span><a 
- id="dx1-31028"></a> to allow formats that use
+ id="dx1-32028"></a> to allow formats that use
 that command.
-</p><!--l. 6817--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The <a 
+</p><!--l. 7001--><p class="indent" >   <div class="important" title="Important Note"> The <a 
 href="#catattr.dualindex"><span 
 class="cmss-10">dualindex</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31029"></a> attribute will still be used on subsequent use even if the
+ id="dx1-32029"></a> attribute will still be used on subsequent use even if the
 <a 
 href="#catattr.indexonlyfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexonlyfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31030"></a> attribute (or <a 
+ id="dx1-32030"></a> attribute (or <a 
 href="#styopt.indexonlyfirst"><span 
 class="cmss-10">indexonlyfirst</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-31031"></a> package option) is set. However, the <a 
+ id="dx1-32031"></a> package option) is set. However, the <a 
 href="#catattr.dualindex"><span 
 class="cmss-10">dualindex</span></a><a 
- id="dx1-310